Quarterlytics / Real Estate / Real Estate - Development / Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI

Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI

lre · LSE Real Estate
Claim this profile
Ticker lre
Exchange LSE
Sector Real Estate
Industry Real Estate - Development
Employees 201-500
← All annual reports
FY2014 Annual Report · Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Adapting

to
advance

Economies wax and wane. Markets ebb 
and flow. Opportunities emerge and 
evolve. It’s the nature of our business:  
we adapt to advance. 
The challenges of changing markets  
are not unique to Lancashire, but our 
strategies and strengths are. Our business 
is based upon managing the insurance 
cycle and adapting to our environment, 
so that today’s challenges become 
tomorrow’s progress.

The market has undoubtedly been challenging this year, but thanks  
to our foresight in 2013, when we broadened the operating base by 
acquiring Cathedral and setting up a permanent third-party capital 
management business in Kinesis, we enabled ourselves to adapt to  
our environment.

Despite the softening market of 2014, our Group is progressing well and 
has again enabled us to compete effectively in a challenging environment. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

1

 
Highlights

RETURN ON EQUITY

13.9%

(2013: 18.9%)

COMBINED RATIO

68.7%

(2013: 70.2%)

PROFIT AFTER TAX

$229.3m

(2013: $222.5m)

DIVIDEND YIELD

17.8%

(2013: 12.3%)

TOTAL INVESTMENT RETURN

1.0%

(2013: 0.3%)

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN

-24.2%

(2013: 21.3%)

KPI

KPI

KPI

KPI

In this report

STRATEGIC REPORT
OVERVIEW
02  Lancashire Group at a glance
04  Chairman’s statement
06  Our business model

STRATEGY
10  Chief Executive’s review
14 

Strategy

PERFORMANCE
18  Financial review
20  Key performance indicators 
22  Underwriting review
24  Business review
31  Cathedral
32  Kinesis and third-party capital
33  Enterprise risk management
36  Principal risks
38  Corporate responsibility

GOVERNANCE
44  Chairman’s introduction
46  Board of Directors
49  Corporate governance report
52  Committee reports
61  Directors’ remuneration report
79  Directors’ report
83 

 Statement of Directors’ responsibilities

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
86 
Independent auditors’ report
90  Consolidated financial statements
94  Accounting policies
100  Risk disclosures
127  Notes to the accounts

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
159  Shareholder information
160  Glossary
164  Contact information

Visit our corporate website for more information: 
http://www.lancashiregroup.com 

LANCASHIRE GROUP AT A GLANCE

A STRONG INVESTMENT PROPOSITION

Despite changes in market conditions, Lancashire has a consistent record  
of out-performance, delivering sustainable returns. Our stated goal is  
to provide an attractive risk-adjusted return to shareholders over the long 
term. We do this by maintaining an unswerving focus on underwriting 
and managing our capital to fit the opportunities in the market.

A

D

Gross  
premiums  
written
$623.3m

B

C

F

A

CATHEDRAL

KINESIS

B

Gross  
premiums  
written
$284.3m

E

D

C

Limits 
deployed
$340.0m

LANCASHIRE 
Two operating companies covering the London 
and Bermuda markets with strong core business 
portfolios, recognised leadership capability  
and the ability to deploy capacity nimbly in  
a changing market across four classes.

A: Aviation: 8.5%

B: Marine: 10.9%

C: Property: 42.2%

D: Energy: 38.4%

Page 24
Read about Lancashire

CATHEDRAL 
Two Syndicates in Lloyd’s with mature 
portfolios of short-tail business in the same 
classes as Lancashire, but separate niches, 
allowing further diversification of the business 
and client base. Access to Lloyd’s unique 
capital structure and world-wide licenses.

A: Aviation: 9.7%

B: Marine: 13.2%

D: Energy: 9.1%

E. Property D&F: 28.4%

C: Property Re: 36.7%

F. Other: 2.9%

Page 31
Read about Cathedral

KINESIS 
A third-party capital and underwriting 
manager in Bermuda, leveraging Lancashire’s 
expertise and track record to offer unique 
multi-class products to clients and investors, 
with scope to develop more products as the 
market evolves.

Page 32
Read about Kinesis

OPERATING HIGHLIGHTS
•  The established portfolios of Lancashire Bermuda  
and London, and Syndicate 2010, continued to  
offer significant capacity and leadership expertise.

•  Full year contribution from Cathedral with strong  

underwriting performance.

•  Continued integration of Cathedral and building  
out of Syndicate 3010 with new terrorism, energy  
and aviation lines.

2 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

•  Hiring of new aviation teams for Syndicate 3010.

•  Kinesis advanced its operations with an expansion of  
its strong investor club and a blue-chip client roster.

•  Continued development across all entities and the  

Group for compliance with Solvency II.

LANCASHIREUNDERWRITING  AND CAPITAL  MANAGEMENT 
 
 
 
LANCASHIRE GROUP 
Lancashire has been a top-performing  
specialty short-tail insurer and reinsurer since 
its foundation in 2005. It has successfully 
weathered significant tests such as Hurricane 
Ike and Storm Sandy, earthquakes in Japan, 
New Zealand and Chile, floods in Thailand 
and the UK, and non-elemental losses like 
Deepwater Horizon and Costa Concordia,  
as well as the financial markets shock of 2008.

Through all these events, Lancashire has 
consistently produced leading combined 
ratios and return on equity through an 
unremitting focus on profitable underwriting 
and active capital management.

The ability to navigate hard and soft markets 
has been demonstrated, and our strategy has 
proved to be fit for purpose across all phases 
of the market cycle.

Performance incentives for management  
and staff are aligned to shareholders’ interests, 
so Lancashire will continue to focus on 
maintaining profitability and optimising 
capital usage.

Lancashire’s commitment: to focus on the 
drivers of profitability in the business, and  
to ensure that the Company provides a  
secure and stable counterparty for clients  
and brokers, whilst generating strong returns  
for shareholders.

FIVE YEAR COMPOUND ANNUAL ROE 

 17.7%

20

15

10

5

0

Lancashire

Beazley

Ren Re

Hiscox

M ontpelier

Axis

Validus

Catlin

A mlin

Endurance

Aspen

Argo

(1) Peer group as defined by the Board of Directors.

(2)  RoE calculated as the internal rate of return of the change in FCBVS in the period plus dividends accrued. For Amlin, Argo, Beazley, 

Catlin, Hiscox and Ren Re basic book value per share is used as FCBVS is not reported by these companies. Compound annual returns 
for LHL and sector are from 1 January 2010 through 31 December 2014. Data source: Company records.

Lancashire’s commitment: to focus on the optimum capital levels in each of its three business 
units to ensure the best returns for the shareholders, whilst providing meaningful capacity to 
clients and brokers across the cycle.

FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
•  Combined ratio of 68.7 per cent, yet again one of the  
leading combined ratios in the peer group, reflecting  
solid underwriting and expense control.

•  Loss ratio for 2014 of 31.7 per cent, another strong  

performance in a year with a number of medium-sized  
risk and catastrophe losses.

•  Gross premiums written of $907.6 million with a  

contribution of $284.3 million from Cathedral in its  
first full year as part of the Group.

•  Kinesis deployment of $340.0 million of limits with  
capital raised on three occasions during the year.

•  Investment return of 1.0 per cent reflecting emphasis  

on limiting risk in volatile markets.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

3

OVERVIEW 
CHAIRMAN’S STATEMENT

ADAPTING TO ADVANCE

 “This has been a year of  
evolutionary change for our  
Board and management team.  
We enter 2015 with a business  
which is fit to deliver our  
strategic priorities. ” 

at LUK. It is a tribute to the bench strength of our team, 
and the work which had been put in place to ensure that 
a longer term strategic succession plan was implemented, 
that the transition to the new management team was 
completed so smoothly. It has given me great pleasure 
across the last year to see Alex grow into his new role 
with such assurance and discretion. He has proven 
himself to be the right man at the right time. 

John Bishop, Neil McConachie and Ralf Oelssner also 
stepped down from the Board at the 2014 AGM. I would 
like to thank John, Neil and Richard for their contributions 
to the success of Lancashire over many years. It is with 
sadness that we mark the death of Ralf, shortly after his 
departure from our Board. 

Q |  HOW HAS THE BOARD EVOLVED  

DURING THE YEAR?

A | There comes a time in any organisation where  
“the old order changeth, yielding place to new”: in my 
introduction to last year’s Annual Report I talked about 
the “generational change in Board membership” to be 
implemented during 2014. We have been as good as our 
word. Both William Spiegel and Bob Spass stepped down 
from the Board with effect from 1 January 2015, each 
having completed nine years’ service from the date  
of their first election. They have stepped down from  
the Board in keeping with governance good practice. 
William and Bob leave us with our thanks for their many 
years of insightful wisdom, leadership and service on our 
Board and its Committees. Their departure marks the 
passing of the baton from the original founders of our 
business to a new generation, and I am delighted to 
welcome Peter Clarke and Tom Milligan (see biographies 
on pages 47 and 48) to our Board who, together with our 
other Board members, bring an appropriate range and 
depth  of knowledge and skills to provide support, 
challenge and strategic insights for the business.

Q&A

with Non-Executive Chairman,  
Martin Thomas

Q |  WHAT HAVE BEEN THE STRATEGIC 

CHALLENGES DURING 2014 AND HOW  
HAS THE BUSINESS ADAPTED TO THEM?

A | The Group faced the challenge of a year which was 
marked both by change and continuity. During April  
the Board had oversight of the most significant change 
in the management team since Lancashire’s foundation 
in 2005. In April, the prime founder of our business, 
Richard Brindle, decided to retire from Lancashire. 
Most shareholders have been with us long enough to 
appreciate the high level of success the Company enjoyed 
under his leadership. Fortunately, he left the business  
in robustly good shape and with a body of staff whose 
skills and experience allowed for a seamless transition. 
Alex Maloney was appointed the Group Chief Executive 
Officer with effect from 30 April 2014. Alex has been with 
the Group since its earliest days when he joined to lead 
and shape its Energy underwriting strategy – one of the 
Group’s most profitable lines of business. Since 2010, Alex 
has been a member of the Board and the Group’s Chief 
Underwriting Officer. He has a detailed knowledge  
of the Group’s business and has demonstrated a practical, 
hands-on approach to management and cultivated a quiet 
authority in his leadership of the senior management 
team and as a member of our Board. The appointment  
of Alex also saw the promotion of two other members  
of the management team. Paul Gregory has assumed the 
role of Group Chief Underwriting Officer and Hayley 
Johnston has become the Chief Underwriting Officer  

4 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Q |  HAVE THE 2014 RESULTS  
MET EXPECTATIONS?

A | Insurance is a cyclical business and surplus 
underwriting capacity has meant that results for all  
our peers in the sector have been subdued. Lancashire 
delivered a solid performance during 2014, when the 
strategic priorities were to maintain a core book of 
business and to focus on the fundamentals of good 
underwriting. RoE for 2014, was 13.9 per cent.  
2014 was the first full year for the inclusion of the 
Cathedral platform and the Group’s move into Lloyd’s 
has expanded the premium base for the Group  
as a whole and has performed in line with expectations. 
The combined ratio of 68.7 per cent is an excellent 
result, although slightly above our recent five year 
average. This is in part a reflection of the softer market 
in pricing and coverage terms and Cathedral’s higher 
attritional loss ratio. Another bright spot for 2014 was 
the rapid establishment and recognition of the Kinesis 
underwriting platform. Kinesis has now completed its 
first full year cycle and has made progress in establishing 
relations with both investors and reinsured clients which 
we expect will help position it well to expand if and 
when improved underwriting conditions should arrive. 

Q |  HAS THE GROUP’S CAPITAL MANAGEMENT 

STRATEGY CHANGED IN 2014?

A | As a business Lancashire has always tailored its 
capital requirements to its underwriting and business 
strategy and effective capital management remains at 
the heart of that strategy. At what is considered to be  
a low point in the insurance cycle, the Board was pleased 
to declare ordinary and special dividends in respect  
of 2014 amounting in total to $1.85 per common share 
(see page 79 for further details). This equated  
to a return of $381.2 million, more than the Group’s 
profit after tax for the year of $229.3 million.

Once again I would like to thank our shareholders  
for affording the Company flexibility in its capital 
management capabilities. At the AGM held on 30 April 
2014 we asked for and received shareholder support  
to issue up to 15 per cent of shares on a non pre-emptive 
basis. In an insurance market that rewards the fastest to 
react, following a market moving loss event, those who 
can deploy capital quickly, so as to play a leading role  
in establishing an adjusted pricing regime and meeting 
brokers’ and clients’ needs for immediate capacity,  
will have the advantage. The first movers make the  
new market. For this reason a nimble capital management 
strategy remains at the heart of Lancashire’s business 
model and the Company is seeking shareholder 
support for a similar resolution at the 2015 AGM.

NEW TALENT ADDED TO THE BOARD

We welcome Peter Clarke (left) and Tom Milligan  
(right) as new members of our Board

Page 47
Read about our Board of Directors

Q |  HOW HAS THE GOVERNANCE OF THE 
BUSINESS EVOLVED DURING 2014?

A | In the 2012 Annual Report I stated that the business 
placed great importance on good governance, not  
for its own sake, but because when it is done well it  
can enhance the effective oversight of the Group and 
the accomplishment of its strategic objectives. This last 
year has illustrated the importance of the work carried  
out by the Board and the management of the Group  
in ensuring a smooth transition to a new Group CEO 
and management regime. A fuller account of our 
governance arrangements and the work of the Board 
and its Committees can be found at page 44.

Q |  WHAT IS THE OUTLOOK FOR 2015?

A | 2015 will see the 10th anniversary of the foundation 
of the Company. Although market conditions are  
likely to remain challenging the Board expects to see 
the Group maintain its core book of business across  
all of our current classes and to see progress in the 
build-out of Syndicate 3010 and Kinesis. 

I would like to thank all employees for the hard work 
performed in 2014, which has positioned us well to 
meet the challenges of 2015.

MARTIN THOMAS
NON-EXECUTIVE CHAIRMAN

www.lancashiregroup.com 

5

OVERVIEW 
OUR BUSINESS MODEL

THREE PLATFORMS, ONE ETHOS

We leverage top-tier underwriting 
expertise with efficient management  
of capital and resources across three 
balance sheet options to provide our 
clients and brokers with excellent 
solutions for their insurance and 
reinsurance needs. We always focus  
on the risk-adjusted return.

Key Strengths

LANCASHIRE

•  Strong brand with clients and brokers. Recognised  
for significant capacity and strong leadership ability  
in well-defined business sectors

•  Proven track record of supplying capacity across the cycle 

with sector-leading profitable results

•  Excellent culture of co-operation with collegiate 

underwriting, risk selection, multi-disciplinary business 
review and cross-selling to clients

•  Strong record of capital management actions to right-size 

capital and navigate market cycles

•  Experienced and cohesive management team  

with proven ability

LANCASHIRE

CATHEDRAL

•  Strong brand with core clients and brokers recognised for 
very long-term consistency of relationships and leadership

•  Efficient Lloyd’s capital model allowing greater premium 

leverage than for rated companies

•  Worldwide licensing maintained by Lloyd’s allows Cathedral 
to write business worldwide with limited regulatory overhead

•  Use of world’s oldest insurance third-party capital –  
the Names – who pay underwriting fees, costs and  
profit commission

•  Experienced management team that built the business 

together over 14 years with a great track record

KINESIS

•  Ability to leverage Lancashire data, relationships  

and reputation with investors and clients

•  Experienced management with strong relationships 

amongst clients, brokers and investors

•  Highly specialised multi-class product with strong barriers 

to entry in terms of data and modeling expertise

•  Ability to raise capital very quickly, as demonstrated  

in 2014, to respond to market dislocation

UNDERWRITING  
AND CAPITAL  
MANAGEMENT

CATHEDRAL

KINESIS

Clients and ma r k e t s

OUR RESPONSIBILITY
We recognise that our responsibility as a company and as 
individuals reaches wider than our shareholders and our clients. 
We strive to be a good employer, a good corporate citizen and  
a responsible preserver of resources. Through our Foundation,  
we make concrete financial contributions and provide human 
support to a number of causes in the places we operate and  
around the world (for further details see pages 38 to 41).

Visit our corporate website for more information: 
http://www.lancashiregroup.com

6 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

RESPONSIBILITYRETURNRISKGoals

Risk

Return

•  Maintain key client, broker and reinsurer 
relationships to ensure continued flow  
of business and maintenance of capabilities

•  Continue to improve use of reinsurance and 
retrocession to uphold risk-adjusted balance  
in softening markets

•  Continued influx of new capacity from naïve  
or inexperienced capital and development  
of broker facilities without proper  
underwriting controls

•  Depressed oil price leading to weakening 

demand for key energy products

•  Retain “underwriting comes first” culture  
and discipline without being tempted into 
innovation or diversification for its own sake

•  Widening terms and conditions being  

accepted by the markets without adequate 
pricing or exclusions

•  Failure to attain Solvency II equivalence  

by Bermuda to allow smooth continuation  
of quota share arrangements for the Group

5 YEAR COMPOUND ROE

17.7%

Page 24 to 30
To find out more information

COMBINED RATIO

•  Maintain core portfolios in Syndicate 2010  

in climate of increased competition

•  Develop new lines including energy, terrorism, 
aviation war and general aviation in Syndicate 
3010 and continue to look for new opportunities 
for bolt on business lines

•  Leverage Lancashire’s balance sheet and  

cross sell where opportunities arise

•  Pressure on signings and participation given 
relatively small line sizes counterbalanced  
by strength of broker and client relationships

85.1%

•  Expanded burden of regulatory oversight  
or overlapping regulation from Lloyd’s,  
PRA and FCA

•  Ensure product is correctly calibrated to meet 
client need in terms of responding to events  
and capital relief

•  Deliver returns in line with expectations for 

•  Increased competition from traditional and 
collateralised markets, being displaced from 
property retrocession, with attempts to replicate 
the Kinesis product

modeled ranges given market losses and pricing

•  Waning of investor interest in insurance 

•  Increase investor club members 

•  Increase limits deployed 

allocations if interest rates begin to increase  
and yield returns to capital markets

•  Client resistance to complex products, given 
cheap availability of traditional products

Page 31
To find out more information

LIMITS DEPLOYED

$340.0m

Page 32
To find out more information

www.lancashiregroup.com 

7

OVERVIEW 
STRATEGY

Economies

wax & wane

but here at Lancashire, our core strategic  
focus on underwriting comes first, effectively 
balancing risk and return and operating  
nimbly through the cycle, ensuring that we  
have the right strategy to fit the different  
micro- and macro-economic conditions.

8 

aLancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Economies

STRATEGY

COMBINED RATIO
As a Company that focuses on 
underwriting and underwriting 
profitability, the combined ratio  
is a key performance indicator.  
Over time, there is a strong correlation 
between combined ratio and the 
growth in fully converted book value 
plus dividends. So combined ratio  
is a good metric to monitor the 
underlying health of our portfolio.

68.7%

80

60

40

20

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

5 Year average

64.2%

www.lancashiregroup.com 

9

 
CHIEF EXECUTIVE’S REVIEW

Q&A

with Group Chief 
Executive Officer, 
Alex Maloney

WE HAVE NOT CHANGED FUNDAMENTALLY… 
we’ve simply adapted  
to today’s market

In 2013, we laid the foundations  
to make Lancashire a more durable 
cross-cycle vehicle; and in 2014,  
we have executed by adapting  
our business to a soft market  
and continuing our capital  
management discipline.

10 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Q |  HOW WOULD YOU SUM UP THE MARKET IN 2014?

A | In some ways 2014 has seen significant changes at Lancashire, but if you look at what we’ve 
done it has actually been a case of applying our business philosophy to the world in which  
we find ourselves. From the beginning, Lancashire, as a group, has emphasised the need to  
be nimble. And what that means is making sure our resources, our structures and our people  
are fit for all possible market scenarios. We then engage in a constant process of challenging 
our assumptions and fine-tuning our tactics, but our strategy and our goals remain the same.

The key element driving our market at present is capital. Although we have seen some 
significant risk losses, we haven’t seen any devastating catastrophe losses in the last two years. 
Without the galvanising effect of capital-eroding losses, many insurers have been building 
capital through retained earnings. As always, this leads to attempts to build market share  
or enter new business lines. That is a cyclical change and one that has been well understood, 
and well managed by Lancashire during its history.

COMBINED RATIO

68.7%

LOSS RATIO

31.7%

RETURN ON EQUITY

13.9%

But in addition to this cyclical change we are now seeing a secular change, which is the 
decision by capital markets to treat insurance risk as an investable asset class like any other. 
We can debate how much of the allocation by some participants reflects a permanent decision 
versus a short-term reaction to a prolonged period of low interest rates. But in our judgement, 
if we’re seeing the current levels of capital coming in to a soft market, we expect there to  
be plenty more capital ready for a post-loss market. At present most of the capital markets’ 
money is being attracted to catastrophe risk, where the use of industry-standard stochastic 
models like RMS and AIR allows investors to see a scientifically-based projected range  
of outcomes. Again, we can debate how accurate those 
modeled outcomes are, but investors are used to this 
method of assessing a return. 

Q |  HOW HAS LANCASHIRE ADAPTED TO CHANGES 

IN THE MARKET IN 2014?

A | We have to adapt on two levels; at a cyclical level and  
at a secular level. 

“
I have a clear vision of how I want  
Lancashire to develop and continue  
“
to advance.

At the cyclical level, Lancashire has long shown its ability to maintain discipline in softening 
markets. And we are reacting nimbly by taking advantage of some attractive catastrophe and 
risk reinsurance pricing to buy more coverage and reduce our retentions, both at Lancashire 
UK and Bermuda and at Cathedral. This allows us to focus on the risk-adjusted return for our 
business, weighing the retained net risk against the retained net premium. But we recognise 
that more reinsurance cannot always be the answer to declining pricing or broadening terms 
and conditions. So we are prepared to walk away from business if it is no longer economic. 
The low attritional component of our loss ratio means that Lancashire is less susceptible  
to pricing pressures than some of our peers, and our consistently strong combined ratio, 
including 68.7 per cent in the calendar year 2014, bears this out.

At a secular level, Lancashire is executing on the strategic plans laid in 2013. We recognised 
the need for Lancashire to develop a broader business base and to get closer to its clients,  
to maintain its “relevance” in a more competitive market with more options for the insurance 
and reinsurance buyer. We’ve done this in several ways, but a good example is the development 
of more capacity for our energy and terrorism clients through building out these lines of 
business at Syndicate 3010. By cross-selling from both our rated-paper and Lloyd’s capital 
bases, we are able to offer our clients and brokers significant capacity. Similarly, we have 
continued to build out our excess energy liability product with key clients to enhance our 
client offering, whilst remaining within our area of expertise. Within Syndicate 3010, we have 
added market-leading teams for Aviation War and General Aviation, with encouraging  
early support. Again, these niche lines broaden our base whilst remaining within classes  
we already know.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

11

STRATEGY 
Paul Gregory,
Group Chief Underwriting Officer 
Chief Executive Officer, LUK

Elaine Whelan,
Group Chief Financial Officer 
Chief Executive Officer, LICL

Peter Scales,
Chief Executive Officer, Cathedral

Darren Redhead,
Chief Executive Officer, Kinesis

CHIEF EXECUTIVE’S REVIEW CONTINUED

Q |  HOW IS THE WIDER GROUP  

INTEGRATION PROGRESSING?

A | We continue to work on optimising the integration 
of Cathedral on the underwriting side, with cross-
selling and, for example, leveraging the expertise  
of Mark Wilson of Cathedral as a reinsurance buyer, 
working for the whole Group. So Cathedral is meeting 
our expectations, and not just in a financial sense.  
And at Kinesis we’ve seen solid development of the 
client and investor base, as Kinesis has leveraged the 
Lancashire risk expertise and data to create highly 
specialised products. The take up, in terms of both 
investors and limits sold, has met our expectations  
for 2014; and subject to market conditions, we will 
build on this in 2015.

On the investment side 2014 has seen continuing 
short-term volatility in markets, and an expectation  
that the low interest rate environment may start to  
turn in 2015. Lancashire has always felt its first task  
on the asset side is to protect the liquidity required  
for our clients and to preserve the balance sheet  
to be able to engage in market opportunities when  
they arise. As such we focus on trying to stay market 
neutral in the current environment, and given our 
heavy weighting to short duration fixed income 
instruments to match our liabilities, we have increased 
our allocation to certain risk assets in 2014 to mitigate  
some of our interest rate risk. We currently have  
more of a risk-on bias and this is likely to continue  
for the immediate future.

Q |  HOW ARE YOU ADAPTING TO  
YOUR NEW ROLE AS CEO?

A | I took on the role of Group CEO in 2014 after more 
than nine years with Lancashire. I’d like to pay tribute  
to Richard Brindle who handed the reins on to me 
following the 2014 AGM, and who created a company 
with a keen understanding of its role and a real depth of 
management talent. It’s a great help to me to have people 
like Elaine Whelan and Paul Gregory, who have been with 
Lancashire since the early days, Peter Scales and John 
Hamblin who started Cathedral and Darren Redhead who 
is building Kinesis. They all have many years of experience, 
and know how to weather all phases of the cycle. 

I have a clear vision of how I want Lancashire to develop, 
and continue to advance. This encompasses continued 
focus on underwriting profitability as the engine of our 
success, combined with adherence to right-sizing capital 
on the most efficient balance sheet for the opportunities 
in front of us. We cannot control the market, no  
(re)insurer can, but we can ensure that we are the  
most nimble at reacting to, and preparing for, it.  

12 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

As such I will continue to focus on the combined ratio 
as a measure both of our underwriting success and 
our control of overheads, and on the RoE as a 
yardstick of both our profitability and right-sizing  
of capital. During my time with Lancashire I have seen 
us become a key partner to our clients and brokers –  
to whom we are very thankful – and deliver market 
leading returns to our shareholders. We have achieved 
this on the back of great people, great structures  
and systems and great focus on the fundamentals.  
We all at Lancashire UK and Bermuda, Cathedral  
and Kinesis and at the Group level, intend to build  
on this for the future by continuing to adapt, but not 
forsaking our principles.

“Lancashire was established with a clear strategy  
that recognises the cyclical nature of the insurance 
and reinsurance markets and enshrines underwriting 
and capital discipline at the heart of our strategic 
approach to our business.”

Q |  HOW HAS THE STRATEGY  

DELIVERED IN 2014?

A | We can see the Lancashire strategy in action right 
across the Group in 2014. To take a key example,  
we can look at how Lancashire deploys property 
reinsurance capacity across the Group. In 2013, 
Lancashire wrote most of its catastrophe exposures 
through LICL, writing both property retrocession  
and property catastrophe excess of loss, and used  
the Accordion and the Saltire sidecars to distribute  
risk it had underwritten to third-party capital. In 2014, 
with the additions of Cathedral and Kinesis, and the 
availability of additional outwards retrocession, the 
shape of the Group’s property reinsurance portfolio 
has undergone significant change.

The amount of property retrocession written has been 
significantly reduced from $80.8 million in 2013 to 
$18.1 million in 2014. This reflects Lancashire’s 
judgement that as the most commoditised product we 
sell, and with a secular change from the commitment 
of third-party capital to this space, that the risk-adjusted 
return was declining steeply. We have maintained core 
relationships in property retrocession in LICL, but  
with much less capital allocated than in previous years. 
Instead LICL has continued to develop its previously 
underweight property catastrophe excess of loss book. 

Cathedral’s own property catastrophe excess of loss 
portfolio of small U.S. regional business, which is very 
stable due to the buying habits of the clients, now forms 
23.3 per cent of the Group’s property reinsurance 
income. In addition, on the non-U.S. side, LICL has 
been able to cross-sell its larger capacity on higher 
layers with Cathedral, who have a more mature 
portfolio of smaller capacity on lower layers.

At the same time Kinesis has leveraged Lancashire’s 
expertise in risk lines and modeling to sell retrocession 
products to address a real need for multi-class protection, 
including property, that affords excellent balance sheet 
relief to clients. So Lancashire’s reinsurance profile  
has adapted to the cycle, protecting and developing a 
strong core portfolio, by using multiple balance sheets 
to match the client’s needs. As we look forward, we can 
see additional opportunities to increase the amount  
of retrocession cover that we buy to protect these 
exposures, again strategically using the cyclical glut  
of capacity to optimise risk-adjusted returns.

That additional flexibility on our outwards reinsurance 
and retrocession purchases has helped in our capital 
management for 2014 and beyond. Whilst we originally 
planned on making a single special dividend payment 
in December 2014 to right-size capital for 2015, we 
actually made some very capital-efficient changes to our 
outwards programmes using both reinstatements and 
quota share capacity. These have allowed us to make  
a further special distribution with the final dividend  
for 2014, whilst maintaining our prudent surplus 
capital position which will allow us to take advantage  
of any opportunities.

Q |  SO DESPITE THE SOFT MARKET  
THE STRATEGY IS UNCHANGED?

A | The original Lancashire strategy was specifically 
designed to be durable across the cycle, so there is no 
need for a strategic change. The whole point of having 
a lean operating structure, with exposures concentrated 
in short-tail markets, is to be able to right-size our 
underwriting and capital to the market in front of us. 
We added Kinesis and Cathedral to the Lancashire 
Group to improve our ability to trade across the cycle 
with both core and opportunistic portfolios.

ALEX MALONEY
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER

www.lancashiregroup.com 

13

STRATEGY 
STRATEGY

CONSISTENCY IN STRATEGIC DIRECTION

Our strategy

We have three strategic aims that enable us to meet our goal of providing an attractive risk-
adjusted return to our shareholders. We put underwriting at the forefront of all we do, we focus 
on getting the right balance between risk and return and we ensure that we can react nimbly  
to an ever-changing market. This enables us to serve our clients and brokers with significant 
capacity across the cycle, not just in the core business we aim to renew every year, but also in 
times or in areas where capacity is scarce: the opportunistic part of our portfolio. We keep our 
structure lean and overheads under strict control so that we can refocus our resources quickly. 
And we test our assumptions and performance constantly through our structure using daily 
underwriting calls or exception reporting to management, a fortnightly Risk and Return 
Committee meeting with all disciplines within the Group represented, and a series of supporting 
underwriting, operational, compliance, investment and finance committees. Around this  
our risk function and internal audit supply challenge and assurance to management and  
the Boards through a simple and continuous reporting process.

Description

UNDERWRITING ALWAYS 
COMES FIRST
We employ 33 underwriters 
across the Group, many of them 
with decades of experience,  
and supply them with analytical 
tools to assess which business 
best fits our portfolios. We look 
for new opportunities that will 
improve our overall returns and 
ensure that we remain relevant 
to our brokers and clients.

Shareholder 
return

Cross-cycle return of risk-free plus 13%
Profitable 4 years out of 5
Peak-zone PML limits  of 25% of capital

Effectively balance 
risk and return

Operate nimbly 
through the cycle

Underwriting always 
comes first

OUR CULTURE – THE BEDROCK OF OUR STRATEGY

Lancashire encourages a culture of co-operation and respect based on open challenge.  
This can be seen clearly in the LICL and LUK daily underwriting call where senior and junior 
underwriters debate the risks they want to write and their fit to the portfolio and market.  
It also characterises the Group-wide Risk and Return Committee which brings together 
underwriting, actuarial, finance and investments, operations and risk to challenge the 
assumptions used in all areas of our planning and measuring the business.

EFFECTIVELY BALANCE 
RISK AND RETURN
By bringing together all our 
disciplines – underwriting, 
actuarial, modeling, finance, 
investment, risk and 
operational – at our fortnightly 
RRC meetings, we are able  
to look at how different parts  
of our operations are working 
together. We stress test our 
business plans and gauge  
where we can be most effective 
without undue volatility.

OPERATE NIMBLY 
THROUGH THE CYCLE 
As capital continues to surge 
into the (re)insurance market, 
the need to be nimble is more 
important than ever. This means 
being ready to deploy capital 
quickly when it is needed, and 
having the discipline to return 
it when it is not.

14 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Achievements in 2014

Performance

We have added energy and 
terrorism lines to our Lloyd’s 
offering in Syndicate 3010, 
expanding the Group’s capacity, 
licensing and balance sheet 
options for these classes. We have 
also added new Aviation classes 
with two new teams for 
Syndicate 3010, both with long 
experience and good track 
records. We have built out 
Kinesis deploying $340.0 million 
of limits with seven investors.

Combined Ratio

68.7%

KPI

Gross premiums written

$907.6m

Still a leading combined ratio, 
even in difficult markets, 
evidencing the continued  
focus on underwriting and 
portfolio construction.

Significant contribution  
from Cathedral in 2014 as we 
focused on protecting our  
core portfolios, but maintained 
the discipline to decline or 
re-structure our participation 
on under-priced or poorly 
performing business.

Associated strategic risks

The key risk in the current 
market phase is the loss of 
relevance to brokers and 
clients; with so much surplus 
capacity insurers need to  
have a unique selling point.  
For Lancashire that is found  
in its mixture of capacity, 
leadership capability, significant 
reinsurance expenditure and 
multiple balance sheet options. 
New business lines and additional 
reinsurance purchases help  
us in this respect.

We have had to reduce income 
in some areas of our business  
in response to market weakening. 
But we have been able to find 
substantial outwards reinsurance 
opportunities that allow us to 
mitigate some of the effects  
of price reductions, and reduce 
our net exposures until the 
time is right for us to retain 
more risk.

Return on Equity

13.9%

KPI

Probable Maximum Loss

$235.2m*

A solid result despite a difficult 
market and the incidence  
of risk losses, helped by  
our improved outwards 
reinsurance programme.

We continued to reduce our 
exposure to key catastrophe 
perils as the market has  
become more competitive, 
demonstrating our discipline 
and nimbleness.

The key issue is for Lancashire 
to continue to serve its clients 
and brokers with significant 
capacity, whilst ensuring  
that the portfolio is not 
unbalanced. This means 
constantly re-assessing our 
business mix, and testing  
key risk assumptions. 

Kinesis demonstrated its speed 
in identifying an opportunity 
outside its usual bi-annual 
capital raising and then 
deploying $37.5 million  
of limits within one week.  
In addition, Lancashire 
renewed its 15 per cent 
disapplication of pre-emption 
rights to smooth potential 
future capital raises.

*  1 in 100 year Gulf of Mexico Hurricane 
expected net loss at 1 January 2015.

KPI

Dividend Yield

17.8%

Whilst buying back shares  
can be a part of right-sizing 
capital, special dividends  
allow Lancashire to make 
substantial capital returns 
quickly when justified.

Percentage of profit  
returned to shareholders

152.3%

Lancashire continues to 
exercise the discipline of giving 
back capital it cannot profitably 
deploy, but remains open to 
new opportunities such as those 
in developing Syndicate 3010.

Page 20
KPIs

Lancashire has developed  
an expectation among its 
stakeholders that it will produce 
a consistent return and pay 
ordinary and special dividends. 
Lancashire has to ensure that 
all stakeholders understand that 
in hard markets Lancashire  
will want to retain and even raise 
capital to take full advantage  
of underwriting opportunities.

Page 33
Enterprise Risk Management

www.lancashiregroup.com 

15

STRATEGY 
PERFORMANCE

Markets

ebb & flow

but here at Lancashire, we remain nimble  
so as to respond to challenges whilst 
maintaining a strong balance sheet.  
Being agile to seize upon opportunities  
as they arise is a cornerstone  
of our business.

16 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

PERFORMANCE

RETURN ON EQUITY
We set a cross-cycle target for return 
on equity because we recognise  
that in a cyclical market the returns 
we earn can be impacted by available 
capacity, premium rating and losses 
amongst other factors. So even 
though the cycle is currently 
depressed, we expect to meet  
our targets over time.

13.9%

25

20

15

10

5

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

5 Year compound annual 

17.7%

www.lancashiregroup.com 

17

 
FINANCIAL REVIEW

MAINTAINING STRONG FINANCIALS

“Despite a challenging market, Lancashire 
has remained committed to doing what 
we’ve always said we’d do: we have 
continued to demonstrate both discipline 
in our underwriting and an unrelenting   
 focus on capital management in order  
to produce the best risk-adjusted return  
we can for our shareholders.”

Q&A

with Group Chief Financial  
Officer, Elaine Whelan

Q |  HOW WOULD YOU SUM UP 2014  

GROUP FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE?

A | In a year where there has been much doom and 
gloom in discussions around market conditions, it’s not  
all bad. Lancashire produced an RoE of 13.9 per cent and 
a combined ratio of 68.7 per cent for the year. With our 
first full year of incorporating Cathedral into our results, 
they added 1.6 per cent to our RoE, after acquisition 
adjustments. While there were no major loss events 
impacting the industry, we did see an increased frequency 
of attritional losses. To put that in context, our loss ratio 
for the year was 31.7 per cent. We produced a profit  
after tax of $229.3 million and comprehensive income  
of $227.2 million. Our inception-to-date compound 
annual RoE is 18.9 per cent. 

Q |  HOW HAS THE SOFT MARKET AFFECTED 

PREMIUMS AND WHAT HAS CATHEDRAL’S 
CONTRIBUTION BEEN?

A | Our gross premiums written were $907.6 million,  
an increase of $227.9 million or 33.5 per cent compared 
to 2013. The increase in premiums is derived primarily 
from the new Lloyd’s segment following the acquisition 
of Cathedral in the fourth quarter of 2013. Cathedral 
contributed $284.3 million of premiums for the year. 
Otherwise, in the original Lancashire lines of business, 
we saw a further reduction in property retrocession as 

terms and conditions and pricing continued to worsen. 
This was offset to a degree by redeploying capital to  
the property catastrophe excess of loss book, including 
some business on a multi-year basis. We also wrote  
a number of new and renewing multi-year deals in  
the energy Gulf of Mexico book. 

Q |  WITH NO MAJOR LOSSES IN 2014 WHAT EFFECT 
HAS THIS HAD ON LANCASHIRE’S LOSS RATIO?

A | The Group’s loss ratio for the year was 31.7 per cent 
with an accident year ratio of 35.9 per cent. As noted 
above, there were no major insured loss events this year, 
although we did see a higher number of smaller losses. 
The most notable impact was in Lancashire’s satellite book 
and Cathedral’s aviation book with a total of $42.4 million 
reported across a number of losses. Prior year losses 
developed favourably, albeit modestly so.

Q |  HOW HAS THE EVOLVING INVESTMENT 

MARKET AFFECTED LANCASHIRE?

A | We produced a total return for the year of 1.0 per cent. 
Investment markets remained challenging – although 
somewhat less so than in 2013 – with global growth  
still slow and geopolitical risk heightened. We increased 
duration during the year, increased our allocation to 
floating rate securities and added a small hedge fund 
portfolio. While that helped us generate a better return 
on our portfolio, the additional asset allocations were 
primarily with a view to managing our interest rate 
exposure in anticipation of Federal Reserve rate increases 
in 2015. The hedge fund portfolio has returned 1.8 per 
cent since our initial investment in April 2014. 

18 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

2014 FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE
FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

Gross premiums written
Net premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net insurance losses
Net underwriting income
Net investment income
Net realised gains (losses) and impairments
Net operating profit
Profit after tax
Change in net unrealised gains/losses on investments
Comprehensive income
Dividends 

Diluted earnings per share
Diluted operating earnings per share
Fully converted book value per share
Return on equity
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio
Accident year loss ratio 
Net total return on investments1

Note: Dividends included in the financial statement year in which they were recorded. 

(1) Net return on investments includes internal foreign exchange hedges. 

2010
$m
689.1
649.9
614.2
165.7
342.2
53.4
33.2
306.5
330.8
(2.2)
328.6
294.2

$1.86
$1.73
$7.57
23.3%
27.0%
17.3%
10.1%
54.4%
42.9%
4.2%

2011 
$m
632.3
565.1
574.5
182.3
208.8
43.2
8.6
219.0
212.2
(10.6)
201.6
180.4

$1.20
$1.23
$7.62
13.4%
31.7%
19.6%
12.4%
63.7%
59.3%
1.8%

2012 
$m
724.3
576.1
582.6
174.1
289.1
32.5
11.8
220.3
234.9
17.8
252.7
201.4

$1.29
$1.21
$7.83
16.7%
29.9%
20.5%
13.5%
63.9%
34.6%
3.1%

2013 
$m
679.7
557.6
568.1
188.1
254.2
25.4
12.6
184.2
222.5
(32.5)
190.0
325.6

$1.17
$0.97
$7.50
18.9%
33.1%
22.1%
15.0%
70.2%
36.1%
0.3%

2014 
$m
907.6
742.8
715.6
226.5
335.7
28.6
(5.9)
231.9
229.3
(2.1)
227.2
321.0

$1.16
$1.17
$6.96
13.9%
31.7%
21.4%
15.6%
68.7%
35.9%
1.0%

Q |  HOW HAS KCML FINANCIALLY 

CONTRIBUTED TO 2014 RESULTS?

A | We earned $6.2 million in underwriting fees for  
the year against an expense base of approximately  
$4.6 million. We also recorded a $4.7 million share  
of profits in associates on our 10 per cent equity 
interest in KHL. During 2014 we received $9.7 million 
in total profit commissions on previous vehicles and  
we should receive $5.8 million in profit commission 
from the Kinesis vehicle in the first quarter of 2015. 

Q |  WHAT IS THE VALUE OF WARRANTS 

EXERCISED AND REMAINING AT YEAR END?

A | Warrant exercises during the year reduced RoE  
by 0.8 per cent. With 18.7 million warrants remaining 
outstanding at the end of the year, and due to expire 
on 16 December 2015, we anticipate the imminent 
exercise of these outstanding instruments. 

Q |  HOW HAS CAPITAL BEEN MANAGED IN 2014?

A | During the year we returned $346.0 million of  
capital, or 152.3 per cent of comprehensive income,  
by way of dividends and share repurchases paid in  
the year. Including dividends declared on 11 February 
2015, our capital return from inception now stands  
at $2.3 billion. Our total capital at the end of the  
year was $1.4 billion. As ever, we will adjust our  
capital position to match business opportunities  
and to generate a superior risk-adjusted return  
for our shareholders. 

ELAINE WHELAN
GROUP CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER

www.lancashiregroup.com 

19

PERFORMANCE 
KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATORS

RETURN ON EQUITY

COMBINED RATIO

TOTAL INVESTMENT RETURN

13.9%

DR

68.7%

1.0%

30

20

10

80

60

40

20

Aim

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

The Group’s aim is to provide 
shareholders with a risk-adjusted return 
on equity of 13 per cent in excess of  
a risk-free rate over the insurance cycle.

The Group aims to price its business  
to ensure that the combined ratio  
in any year is less than 100 per cent.

5

4

3

2

1

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

The Group’s primary investment 
objectives are to preserve capital and 
provide adequate liquidity to support 
the Group’s payment of claims and 
other obligations.

The Group’s aim is to provide an 

The Group aims to carry the right  

The Lancashire Foundation was 

attractive risk-adjusted return to 

level of capital to match attractive 

established in 2007 with the aim  

shareholders over the insurance cycle. 

underwriting opportunities, utilising  

of creating a charitable trust for  

This is a long-term goal, recognising 

an optimal mix of capital tools.  

the benefit of charitable causes in 

that the cyclicality and volatility of  

Over time, through pro-active and 

Bermuda, the UK and worldwide.

Measurement

The return on equity is measured by 
management as the internal rate of 
return of the increase in fully converted 
book value per share in the period, 
adjusted for dividends.

2014 Performance Our market in 2014 was almost 

universally in a soft phase. We recognise 
that whilst we have attained very high 
RoE in the recent past, at this stage of 
the cycle we cannot expect to earn such 
high returns. But we continue to focus 
on getting the best risk-adjusted return 
for our shareholders. In 2014 this  
led us to buy more reinsurance and 
retrocession protection to reduce  
our exposures.

The stated aim is a long-term goal, 
acknowledging that management 
expects both higher and lower results 
in the shorter term. The cyclicality and 
volatility of the insurance market is 
expected to be the largest driver of this 
pattern. We seek to align our variable 
remuneration to shareholders interest 
by having an RoE component in this.

Risk Management

The combined ratio is the ratio of total 
costs to total net earned premium and 
is a measure of an insurance company’s 
operating performance. It is calculated 
as the sum of the loss ratio, the acquisition 
cost ratio and the expense ratio.

Whilst the combined ratio in 2014 was above 
the five-year average, it was still an excellent 
result. In the context of a softening market 
we would expect the loss ratio to increase 
and have increased our attritional loss ratio 
to take account of this and Cathedral’s more 
frequency-oriented portfolio.

Total investment return measures 
investment income and net realised 
and unrealised gains and losses 
produced by the Group’s managed 
investment portfolio.

In 2014 Lancashire continued to monitor 
risk-on/risk-off volatility and increased 
the allocation to risk assets as a hedge 
against the interest rate risk inherent in 
the significant fixed-income portfolio. 
However, given the liquidity and duration 
needs of the portfolio, the composition 
of the core portfolio is unchanged.

The Group’s underwriters assess likely 
losses, using tools such as BLAST and 
BAM and catastrophe models, and their 
experience and knowledge of past loss 
experience, industry trends and current 
circumstances. This allows them to 
estimate the premiums sufficient to meet 
likely losses and expenses. Peer reviews  
of risks are conducted through the daily 
underwriting call or peer review, 
depending on risk impact, enabling the 
Group to ensure careful risk selection, 
limits on concentration and appropriate 
portfolio diversification. The RRC then 
monitors performance at a portfolio level. 

The investment strategy places an 
emphasis on the preservation of invested 
assets and provision of sufficient liquidity 
for the prompt payment of claims, in 
conjunction with providing a reasonably 
stable income stream. These objectives 
are reflected in the Group’s investment 
guidelines and its conservative asset 
allocation. Management reviews the 
composition, duration and asset 
allocation of the investment portfolio  
on a regular basis in order to respond  
to changes in interest rates and other 
market conditions. 

20 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

both the insurance market and the 

flexible capital management across  

financial markets in general will impact 

the cycle, we aim to generate  

management’s ability to maximise the 

optimum returns for shareholders. 

share multiple in the immediate term. 

Total shareholder return is measured  

The percentage of profit returned to 

Money is donated by the Group to  

in terms of the internal rate of return 

shareholders equals the total capital 

the Lancashire Foundation through  

of the increase/decrease in share price 

returned to shareholders through 

an annual cash donation and by 

in the period, measured in U.S. dollars 

dividends and share repurchases paid 

dividends on Lancashire warrants  

and adjusted for dividends.

in a given year, divided by the Group’s 

that were donated to the Foundation 

comprehensive income.

on its inception. 

The performance of the share price  

In 2014, Lancashire maintained it’s  

Charities supported in 2014 include 

in 2014 was disappointing, but we 

A rating. In view of the current market 

charities proposed by staff and by 

continue to communicate regularly  

outlook Lancashire took the decision  

clients and brokers. Over 40 charities  

and transparently to our investors,  

to return surplus capital to shareholders 

in total were supported financially  

and to tell the Lancashire story around 

due to the lack of opportunities which 

in Bermuda, the UK and around the 

the world. The combination of change, 

met internal hurdles. With significant 

world. All staff had the opportunity  

including the acquisition of Cathedral 

and long-term new market capital to 

to take part in volunteering days.

and a new CEO, a difficult market,  

support our reinsurance needs, we were 

and Lancashire’s previous history  

able to improve the capital efficiency 

of out performance meant that it was  

on our outwards purchases.

a challenging year for the share price.

The Lancashire remuneration structure 

Risk tolerances are set at a level that 

The Lancashire Foundation is a  

and share scheme ensure that staff are 

aim to prevent the Group incurring 

charity registered in England and  

highly motivated and closely aligned  

losses that would impair its ability  

Wales (registration number 1149184).  

to the Group’s goals, and therefore 

to operate. The Group’s key capital 

The charity’s trustees are Group 

with shareholders. Permanent staff  

measure is it’s A.M. Best rating, and  

employees and non-executive Board 

are eligible to receive RSS awards for  

a minimum rating of A- is considered 

members. The day-to-day operations 

which TSR is an element of the vesting 

necessary to attract business. 

criteria. The participation of employees 

in the RSS ensures that there is a  

strong focus on sustainable long-term 

shareholder value. 

are administered by a Foundation 

Donations Committee made up of 

employees from across the Group 

which operates within the specific 

criteria set for the Foundation’s 

charitable giving. 

Aim

The Group’s aim is to provide 

The Group aims to price its business  

The Group’s primary investment 

shareholders with a risk-adjusted return 

to ensure that the combined ratio  

objectives are to preserve capital and 

on equity of 13 per cent in excess of  

in any year is less than 100 per cent.

provide adequate liquidity to support 

a risk-free rate over the insurance cycle.

the Group’s payment of claims and 

other obligations.

Measurement

The return on equity is measured by 

The combined ratio is the ratio of total 

Total investment return measures 

management as the internal rate of 

costs to total net earned premium and 

investment income and net realised 

return of the increase in fully converted 

is a measure of an insurance company’s 

and unrealised gains and losses 

book value per share in the period, 

operating performance. It is calculated 

produced by the Group’s managed 

adjusted for dividends.

as the sum of the loss ratio, the acquisition 

investment portfolio.

cost ratio and the expense ratio.

2014 Performance Our market in 2014 was almost 

Whilst the combined ratio in 2014 was above 

In 2014 Lancashire continued to monitor 

universally in a soft phase. We recognise 

the five-year average, it was still an excellent 

risk-on/risk-off volatility and increased 

that whilst we have attained very high 

result. In the context of a softening market 

the allocation to risk assets as a hedge 

RoE in the recent past, at this stage of 

we would expect the loss ratio to increase 

against the interest rate risk inherent in 

the cycle we cannot expect to earn such 

and have increased our attritional loss ratio 

the significant fixed-income portfolio. 

high returns. But we continue to focus 

to take account of this and Cathedral’s more 

However, given the liquidity and duration 

on getting the best risk-adjusted return 

frequency-oriented portfolio.

needs of the portfolio, the composition 

of the core portfolio is unchanged.

for our shareholders. In 2014 this  

led us to buy more reinsurance and 

retrocession protection to reduce  

our exposures.

Risk Management

The stated aim is a long-term goal, 

The Group’s underwriters assess likely 

The investment strategy places an 

acknowledging that management 

losses, using tools such as BLAST and 

emphasis on the preservation of invested 

expects both higher and lower results 

BAM and catastrophe models, and their 

assets and provision of sufficient liquidity 

in the shorter term. The cyclicality and 

experience and knowledge of past loss 

for the prompt payment of claims, in 

volatility of the insurance market is 

experience, industry trends and current 

conjunction with providing a reasonably 

expected to be the largest driver of this 

circumstances. This allows them to 

stable income stream. These objectives 

pattern. We seek to align our variable 

estimate the premiums sufficient to meet 

are reflected in the Group’s investment 

remuneration to shareholders interest 

likely losses and expenses. Peer reviews  

guidelines and its conservative asset 

by having an RoE component in this.

of risks are conducted through the daily 

allocation. Management reviews the 

underwriting call or peer review, 

composition, duration and asset 

depending on risk impact, enabling the 

allocation of the investment portfolio  

Group to ensure careful risk selection, 

on a regular basis in order to respond  

limits on concentration and appropriate 

to changes in interest rates and other 

portfolio diversification. The RRC then 

market conditions. 

monitors performance at a portfolio level. 

5 Year Average

DR
KPI linked to Executive 
Directors’ remuneration. 
For more information 
see pages 61 to 78.

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN

PERCENTAGE OF PROFIT 
RETURNED TO SHAREHOLDERS

DONATIONS MADE TO THE 
LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION

-24.2%

DR

152.3%

$3.0m

50

37.5

25

12.5

0

-12.5

200

150

100

50

3

2

1

-25

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

The Group’s aim is to provide an 
attractive risk-adjusted return to 
shareholders over the insurance cycle. 
This is a long-term goal, recognising 
that the cyclicality and volatility of  
both the insurance market and the 
financial markets in general will impact 
management’s ability to maximise the 
share multiple in the immediate term. 

Total shareholder return is measured  
in terms of the internal rate of return 
of the increase/decrease in share price 
in the period, measured in U.S. dollars 
and adjusted for dividends.

The performance of the share price  
in 2014 was disappointing, but we 
continue to communicate regularly  
and transparently to our investors,  
and to tell the Lancashire story around 
the world. The combination of change, 
including the acquisition of Cathedral 
and a new CEO, a difficult market,  
and Lancashire’s previous history  
of out performance meant that it was  
a challenging year for the share price.

The Lancashire remuneration structure 
and share scheme ensure that staff are 
highly motivated and closely aligned  
to the Group’s goals, and therefore 
with shareholders. Permanent staff  
are eligible to receive RSS awards for  
which TSR is an element of the vesting 
criteria. The participation of employees 
in the RSS ensures that there is a  
strong focus on sustainable long-term 
shareholder value. 

The Group aims to carry the right  
level of capital to match attractive 
underwriting opportunities, utilising  
an optimal mix of capital tools.  
Over time, through pro-active and 
flexible capital management across  
the cycle, we aim to generate  
optimum returns for shareholders. 

The Lancashire Foundation was 
established in 2007 with the aim  
of creating a charitable trust for  
the benefit of charitable causes in 
Bermuda, the UK and worldwide.

The percentage of profit returned to 
shareholders equals the total capital 
returned to shareholders through 
dividends and share repurchases paid 
in a given year, divided by the Group’s 
comprehensive income.

Money is donated by the Group to  
the Lancashire Foundation through  
an annual cash donation and by 
dividends on Lancashire warrants  
that were donated to the Foundation 
on its inception. 

In 2014, Lancashire maintained it’s  
A rating. In view of the current market 
outlook Lancashire took the decision  
to return surplus capital to shareholders 
due to the lack of opportunities which 
met internal hurdles. With significant 
and long-term new market capital to 
support our reinsurance needs, we were 
able to improve the capital efficiency 
on our outwards purchases.

Risk tolerances are set at a level that 
aim to prevent the Group incurring 
losses that would impair its ability  
to operate. The Group’s key capital 
measure is it’s A.M. Best rating, and  
a minimum rating of A- is considered 
necessary to attract business. 

Charities supported in 2014 include 
charities proposed by staff and by 
clients and brokers. Over 40 charities  
in total were supported financially  
in Bermuda, the UK and around the 
world. All staff had the opportunity  
to take part in volunteering days.

The Lancashire Foundation is a  
charity registered in England and  
Wales (registration number 1149184).  
The charity’s trustees are Group 
employees and non-executive Board 
members. The day-to-day operations 
are administered by a Foundation 
Donations Committee made up of 
employees from across the Group 
which operates within the specific 
criteria set for the Foundation’s 
charitable giving. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

21

PERFORMANCE 
UNDERWRITING REVIEW

STRONG PERFORMANCE 
IN TOUGH MARKETS

John Hamblin 
Active Underwriter,  
Cathedral Syndicates 2010 and 3010

Sylvain Perrier
Chief Underwriting Officer, LICL

Q&A

Bruce Carman, Hayley Johnston, 
 John Spence
Aviation War, AV52 and General Aviation

Simon King
Direct and Facultative Property

A roundtable discussion on  
the state of the market with the  
Group’s underwriters

Q |  THERE HAS BEEN A LOT OF DISCUSSION ABOUT 
NEW CAPACITY IN THE MARKET. HOW DOES 
THAT AFFECT YOUR LINE OF BUSINESS?

A | J Hamblin: For our part at Syndicate 2010, our core 
U.S. catastrophe book is made up of some 300 small to 
mid-size companies who have almost completely shunned 
the capital markets to date, mostly because of the basis risk 
which still exists between capital fund offerings and the 
underlying risks our customer base writes. A combination 
of the relatively small reinsurance premiums on offer with 
the conservatism of our customer base has seen less than  
2 per cent of deals being completed with new markets to 
date with no change in their overall buying habits.

A | S Perrier: At LICL, the property reinsurance portfolio 
has seen a significant decline in retrocession business and 
this does directly reflect the introduction of new capital 
with a hunger for the commoditised, model-dependent 
part of the market. But as John indicates, the traditional 
market has a superior product in many respects, with 
features like reinstatements which are very difficult for  
the capital markets sector to reproduce. 

A | J Flude: For much of the remainder of the Group’s 
business it isn’t the direct impact of new capital that is 
being felt, as capital markets cannot satisfactorily rate  
or underwrite our products in the absence of a model. 
Rather it is surplus capital and retained earnings in the 
traditional sector, resulting from benign loss experience 
and the displacement effect of new capital in catastrophe 
reinsurance, that is driving competition. But again, we’re 
used to competition and we have a very experienced 
group of underwriters to navigate all kinds of markets. 

Q |  SO HOW IMPORTANT ARE RELATIONSHIPS  

IN A SOFTENING MARKET?

A | J Hamblin: Both Cathedral’s U.S. and international 
books are made up of strong relationships which have 
lasted decades during which time we’ve been tested by 
softer markets than this one. As in most years, we are 
seeing some organic growth from within our existing 
client base which will, to some extent, offset lower pricing. 
But client retention on our book is strong. 

A | J Flude: For the Energy and Marine portfolios, we have 
strong relationships based on our clients’ need to have 
insurance counterparties who understand their exposures 
and operations in detail. We can provide bespoke coverage 
for unique exposures such as ultra-deep-water units,  
and we always aim to adjust claims fairly and quickly,  

22 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Simon Thurgood, Mark Wilson
Terror and Property Reinsurance

James Flude, Alasdair Butler
Energy & Cargo

even when they are complex. We’ve been very pleased  
by the support those clients have shown by giving  
orders to both LUK and the new energy capacity in 
Syndicate 3010. 

A | A Butler: In Marine Cargo, Cathedral’s emphasis  
has always been to concentrate on our core accounts.  
We have been working with many of our clients for  
up to 25 years, and offer them cover right around the 
world. These clients are more immune to the fickle 
rate-chasing that can be seen elsewhere and we consider 
them to be the foundation on which we can build in  
more favourable market conditions. 

Q |  ARE THERE OPPORTUNITIES EVEN IN A SOFT 

MARKET TO DEVELOP THE BUSINESS?

A | B Carman: There are always opportunities, and  
the development of the Aviation accounts at Syndicate 
3010 in 2014 are a good illustration of this. John Spence  
and I were able to bring teams with both a track record 
and experience to Cathedral, and we’ve already seen  
the support of brokers and clients. 

A | J Spence: Even in General Aviation, which has not  
been affected by the headline losses, we have been able  
to lay firm foundations for the account, based on our  
long experience and relationships in the market. 

A | S Thurgood: Lancashire has been able to build out  
its terrorism and energy lines in Syndicate 3010 as well, 
often with additional lines on existing Group business 
thanks to the support of our clients and brokers.

Q |  SO HOW CAN YOU UNDERWRITE YOUR  

WAY THROUGH THIS PHASE OF THE CYCLE?

A | M Wilson: For a start it’s important to have the 
experience to know what to look for. Changes to terms 
and conditions, like expanding the number of hours  
in which flood losses can accumulate, can have significant 
potential impacts on profit margin, depending on the 
region and attachment point. If you understand these 
impacts, you can assess whether there is a viable price  
for the coverage, or whether you need to exclude it. 

A | H Johnston: To be fair, the softening of the 
reinsurance market can actually be a benefit for a Group 
like ours where around 70 per cent of our income is 
direct insurance. We’re able to buy more and cheaper 
reinsurance to protect our primary portfolios, and that 
means we can limit exposure and volatility. As Alex has 
said, we aim to retain the most risk when markets are 
hardest, and the least when they are softest, so finding 
the right balance for the stage of the cycle is key. 

A | S King: We can also look at the balance of our 
business mix. For 2015, the Cathedral D&F portfolio  
will be about 45 per cent binder business, the small 
commercial business written through MGAs, which is 
much less susceptible to violent rate swings. That’s the 
highest that it has ever been. And as Hayley says, we’ve 
been able to reduce our retentions by buying more 
reinsurance at better prices.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

23

PERFORMANCE 
BUSINESS REVIEW

SOLID PERFORMANCE

In a difficult year for 
underwriting, Lancashire  
still achieved a combined  
ratio of 68.7 per cent.

Hayley Johnston
Chief Underwriting Officer, LUK

Sylvain Perrier
Chief Underwriting Officer, LICL

BUSINESS ENVIRONMENT AND OUTLOOK
2014 has been a challenging year for the specialty insurance 
market as we are firmly in the soft phase of the underwriting cycle. 
But managing the cycle is one of the key skills of the Lancashire 
Group. As a long-standing leader in the specialty insurance and 
reinsurance lines, the silver lining of the highly competitive market 
is the ability for Lancashire to maintain its core inwards portfolio 
while managing net exposures through greatly improved pricing, 
and terms and conditions on the outward placements.

The market is not without challenges, but the Lancashire business 
model was always designed in the knowledge that we have to cater 
for all phases of the cycle. Solid return on equity and an excellent 
combined ratio have been achieved in difficult trading conditions 
and allowed us to maintain our excellent dividend record, based on 
our continued commitment to focusing first on our underwriting 
and our capital management. With market-leading underwriters 
across all three of our business platforms we have defended our core 
portfolio, built our lines where we had true growth opportunities, 
reduced exposures where competition made returns unacceptable, 
and maintained our relevance to brokers and clients. The work we 
have done over the last couple of years in widening the base of our 
income, and adding to our underwriting resources, reinforces  
our ability to trade successfully through all conditions. 

RENEWAL PRICE INDEX (RPI)
Lancashire’s RPI is an internal methodology that management  
uses to track trends in premium rates on a portfolio of insurance 
and reinsurance contracts. The RPI is calculated on a per contract 
basis and reflects Lancashire’s assessment of relative changes in 
price, terms, conditions and limits on like-for-like renewals only, 
and is weighted by premium volume. The RPI does not include 
new business and only covers business written by LICL and LUK,  
to offer a consistent basis for analysis. The calculation involves  
a degree of judgement in relation to comparability of contracts  
and the assessment noted above. To enhance the RPI tool,  
the management of Lancashire may revise the methodology  
and assumptions underlying the RPI, so the trends in premium  
rates reflected in the RPI may not be comparable over time. 
Consideration is only given to renewals of a comparable nature  
so it does not reflect every contract in Lancashire’s portfolio.  
The future profitability of the portfolio of contracts within  
the RPI is dependent upon many factors besides the trends  
in premium rates.

The following table summarises the RPI figures for the main 
business classes, excluding the Lloyd’s segment, using 2006  
as the base year: 

RPI

Class
Aviation (AV52)
Gulf of Mexico offshore energy
Worldwide offshore energy
Marine
Property retrocession and reinsurance
Terrorism
Combined

2006
100
100
100
100
100
100
100

2007
80
80
80
88
97
86
86

2008
69
64
68
80
86
71
76

2009
68
137
84
82
127
66
83

2010
62
139
88
80
121
60
81

2011
59
140
97
79
131
57
83

2012
55
140
100
86
157
55
84

2013
49
136
97
89
152
52
81

2014
44
125
91
91
132
48
76

24 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

UNDERWRITING RESULTS

2014

2013

Gross premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio

Marine 
$m
67.7
57.7

Energy 
$m
239.4
169.7

Aviation 
$m
53.2
52.6

Property 
Total 
$m
$m
263.0
679.7
221.5
568.1
9.8% 24.7% 47.8% 62.5% 47.9% 31.7% 13.8% 26.5% 105.3% 44.7% 47.7% 33.1%
11.8% 30.9% 30.7% 18.3% 22.2% 21.4% 13.4% 27.7% 34.8% 22.6% 21.6% 22.1%
15.0%
21.6% 55.6% 78.5% 80.8% 70.1% 68.7% 27.2% 54.2% 140.1% 67.3% 69.3% 70.2%

Property 
$m
333.4
218.8

Aviation 
$m
48.9
44.7

Lloyd’s 
$m
284.3
214.1

Total 
$m
907.6
715.6

Energy 
$m
209.9
203.1

Marine 
$m
63.0
61.7

Lloyd’s
$m
24.5
39.8

15.6%

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

PREMIUMS
Gross premiums written increased by 33.5 per cent compared  
to 2013. The increase in premiums is derived primarily from the 
new Lloyd’s segment following the acquisition of Cathedral in  
the fourth quarter of 2013. The Group’s five principal segments, 
and the key market factors impacting them, are discussed below. 

PROPERTY
Property gross premiums written decreased by 21.1 per cent for  
the year ended 31 December 2014 compared to the year ended  
31 December 2013. The decrease is driven primarily by reductions 
in the property retrocession book at the 1 January 2014 renewals, 
offset in part by the expansion of our property catastrophe excess 
of loss book. As property retrocession rates, terms and conditions 
continued to worsen, we redeployed capital to property catastrophe 
excess of loss, adding some new business and restructuring some 
existing programmes for core clients, including writing some 
business on a multi-year basis. Otherwise we saw a reduction in 
both the terrorism and political and sovereign risks books due  
to the impact of timing from long-term contract renewals.

ENERGY
Energy gross premiums written increased by 14.1 per cent for  
the year ended 31 December 2014 compared to the year ended  
31 December 2013. The increase for the year is driven primarily  
by the Gulf of Mexico book where a number of both new and 
renewing deals were written on a multi-year basis. Volumes across 
other energy lines are fairly flat year on year.

MARINE
Marine gross premiums written increased by 7.5 per cent for  
the year ended 31 December 2014 compared to the year ended  
31 December 2013. The increase is largely due to non-annual contract 
renewals in the marine hull sub-class in the second quarter of 2014.

AVIATION
Aviation gross premiums written increased by 8.8 per cent for  
the year ended 31 December 2014 compared to the year ended  
31 December 2013 driven by increases in the aviation satellite 
sub-classes, due to new satellite business plus additional satellite 
launches on contracts written in previous years.

LLOYD’S
2014 reflects the first full year of gross premiums written 
attributable to the Lloyd’s segment since the Cathedral acquisition 
in the fourth quarter of 2013. Two months of gross premiums 
written, from the date of acquisition, were included in the fourth 
quarter of 2013. The Lloyd’s segment gross premiums written  
for the year ended 31 December 2014 were $284.3 million,  
$3.9 million or 1.4 per cent lower than the year ended 31 December 
2013 (including premiums written prior to the acquisition).  
For the year ended 31 December 2014, while there have been 
decreases across the existing book of business due to declining 
rates, these have been offset by the new energy, terrorism and 
aviation classes being written by Syndicate 3010.

CEDED
Ceded premiums increased by $42.7 million, or 35.0 per cent for 
the year ended 31 December 2014 compared to the year ended  
31 December 2013. The overall increase for the year is predominantly 
due to the new Lloyd’s segment. Cessions to the Accordion sidecar 
were $47.9 million in 2013. The Accordion quota share contract 
was commuted in the first quarter of 2014 and, other than standard 
premium adjustments, no premiums were ceded to the facility this 
year. This reduction was more than offset by $64.9 million of ceded 
premiums in relation to the Lloyd’s segment. Lancashire also took 
advantage of lower reinsurance rates to purchase some new 
non-marine retrocession aggregate cover and to restructure and 
increase limits for the marine, energy and terror programmes. 

EARNED
Net premiums earned as a proportion of net premiums written 
were 96.3 per cent for the year ended 31 December 2014, 
compared to 101.9 per cent for the year ended 31 December 2013. 
The decreased percentage in premiums earned for the year ended 
31 December 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 reflects 
the impact of increased multi-year premiums written in the 
property catastrophe and energy Gulf of Mexico classes in 2014.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

25

PERFORMANCE 
BUSINESS REVIEW CONTINUED

LOSSES
The Group’s net loss ratio was 31.7 per cent for the year ended  
31 December 2014 compared to 33.1 per cent for 2013. For the 
year ended 31 December 2014, there were relatively low reported 
losses across all lines, although there was some negative development 
on prior accident year mid-sized marine and energy claims.  
In 2013, attritional losses were exceptionally low, offset by prior  
year adverse development on the Costa Concordia marine loss  
of $37.9 million, after reinsurance and reinstatement premiums. 

Prior year favourable development was $34.4 million for the year 
ended 31 December 2014, compared to $15.9 million for the same 
period in 2013, which included the adverse development on Costa 
Concordia above. Both years otherwise experienced releases due  
to lower than expected reported losses.

The 2014 accident year loss ratio, including the impact of foreign 
exchange revaluations, was 35.9 per cent compared to 36.1 per 
cent for the year ended 31 December 2013. The 2014 accident year 
loss ratio for the year ended 31 December 2014 did not include  
any significant large losses. The corresponding period of 2013  
also included low levels of current accident year losses.

The following tables show the impact of prior year development 
and large losses on the Group’s loss ratio: 

FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2014

At 31 December 2014
Absent prior year development
Adjusted losses and ratio

Losses 
$m
226.5
260.9
260.9

Loss ratio 
%
31.7
36.5
36.5

Note: Adjusted loss ratio excludes large losses and prior year development. The table does not sum to 
a total due to the impact of reinstatement premiums.

FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2013

At 31 December 2013
Absent Europe hail and flood
Absent Costa Concordia
Absent remaining prior  
year development
Adjusted losses and ratio

Losses 
$m
188.1
167.2
154.6

237.5
183.1

Loss ratio 
%
33.1
29.4
27.0

41.8
32.0

Note: Adjusted loss ratio excludes large losses and prior year development. The table does not sum to 
a total due to the impact of reinstatement premiums.

The table below provides further detail of the prior year’s loss development by class, excluding the impact of foreign  
exchange revaluations:

LOSS DEVELOPMENT BY CLASS

Property
Energy
Marine
Aviation
Lloyd’s
Total

Note: Positive numbers denote favourable development.

ACCIDENT YEAR LOSS RATIOS 

Accident year loss ratio 
Initial accident year loss ratio
Change in loss ratio post-accident year

Note: Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2014.

2010 
$m
28.8
47.6
17.7
6.0
n/a
100.1

2010
28.1%
42.9%
14.8%

2011 
$m
63.5
57.3
28.6
5.9
n/a
155.3

2011
56.5%
59.3%
2.8%

2012 
$m
(36.0)
37.4
25.9
0.1
n/a
27.4

2012
31.2%
34.6%
3.4%

2013 
$m
13.2
18.4
(23.4)
(1.4)
9.1
15.9

2013
32.7%
36.1%
3.4%

2014 
$m
19.8
5.4
(9.7)
0.9
18.0
34.4

2014
35.9%
n/a
n/a

26 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, previous 
accident years’ ultimate losses developed as follows during 2014 
and 2013:

ULTIMATE LOSS DEVELOPMENT BY ACCIDENT YEAR

2006 and prior accident years
2007 accident year
2008 accident year
2009 accident year
2010 accident year
2011 accident year
2012 accident year
2013 accident year
Total

2013 
$m
(0.7)
(0.9)
(4.1)
2.0
1.4
(4.1)
22.3
n/a
15.9

2014 
$m
1.8
(0.3)
3.6
4.3
5.7
(6.1)
11.1
14.3
34.4

Note: Positive numbers denote favourable development.

The ratio of IBNR to total net loss reserves was 31.6 per cent at  
31 December 2014 compared to 31.8 per cent at 31 December 2013.

ACQUISITION COSTS
The accident acquisition cost ratio was 21.4 per cent compared  
to 22.1 per cent for the 12 months to 31 December 2013. The 
decrease was largely due to profit commission received on 
Accordion (see page 32).

INVESTMENTS, LIQUIDITY AND CASH FLOW
Since inception, the primary objectives for our investment portfolio 
have been capital preservation and liquidity. Those objectives 
remain unchanged, and are more important than ever in today’s 
volatile and reactive markets. As market volatility continues,  

MANAGED INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO ALLOCATIONS

Cash
Short-term investments
Fixed income funds
Government debt
Agency debt
Agency MBS, CMBS
Non-agency RMBS, ABS, CMBS
FDIC corporate bonds
Corporate bonds
Bank loans
Fixed income – at FVTPL
Equity securities
Hedge Funds – at FVTPL
Other investments
Total

we position our portfolio to limit downside risk in market shocks.  
In 2014, our focus has been on managing our interest rate risk,  
the largest risk to our predominantly fixed income portfolio.  
We continue to maintain a short duration fixed income portfolio 
and have been using our risk budget to add products to our 
portfolio to help mitigate a rise in rates. We produced a total 
investment return of 1.0 per cent (2013 – 0.3 per cent) for the year. 
Our average annual total investment return since inception  
is 3.3 per cent, and we have made a positive investment return  
in every year since inception, including 2008.

Our portfolio mix illustrates our philosophy, as shown in the  
table on page 112. With the composition regulated by the Group’s 
investment guidelines we have three investment portfolio 
categories: ‘core’, ‘core plus’ and ‘surplus’. The core portfolio 
contains at least enough funds required to meet near-term 
obligations and cash flow needs following an extreme event.  
Assets in excess of those required to be held in the core portfolio 
may be held in any of the three portfolio categories, which are 
discussed further on page 111. As at 31 December 2014 and 2013 
the managed portfolio was as follows:

Fixed income securities
Cash and cash equivalents
Equity securities
Hedge funds
Other investments
Total

2010 
%
21.9
0.5
–
22.4
1.6
15.3
2.9
4.3
31.1
–
–
–
–
–
100.0

2011 
%
13.2
4.0
–
27.2
4.2
13.2
5.8
2.5
29.9
–
–
–
–
–
100.0

2012 
%
11.1
5.4
–
18.8
6.2
19.2
5.3
–
32.2
1.8
–
–
–
–
100.0

2013 
%
84.4
14.7
0.7
–
0.2
100.0

2013 
%
14.7
9.8
1.1
14.6
4.1
10.9
8.4
–
29.7
4.5
1.3
0.7
–
0.2
100.0

2014 
%
81.9
10.6
0.7
6.8
–
100.0

2014 
%
10.6
1.4
0.7
21.4
0.8
7.7
11.0
–
31.7
5.8
1.4
0.7
6.8
–
100.0

www.lancashiregroup.com 

27

PERFORMANCE 
BUSINESS REVIEW CONTINUED

The corporate bond allocation represented 31.7 per cent  
of managed invested assets at 31 December 2014 compared  
to 29.7 per cent at 31 December 2013. At 31 December 2014  
the Group’s allocation to bank loans represented 5.8 per cent  
of the portfolio compared to 4.5 per cent at 31 December 2013. 
The Group’s portfolio at 31 December 2014 also included  
a 6.8 per cent allocation to a diversified portfolio of low  
volatility hedge funds. There was no allocation to hedge funds  
at 31 December 2013.

The composition, duration and asset allocation of the investment 
portfolio are reviewed on a regular basis in order to respond to 
changes in interest rates and other market conditions. If certain 
asset classes are anticipated to produce a higher return within 
management’s risk tolerance an adjustment in asset allocation  
may be made. Conversely, if the risk profile is expected to move 
outside of tolerance levels, adjustments may be made to reduce  
the risk in the portfolio. We try to be nimble in our investment 
strategy while putting our objective of capital preservation first  
and foremost. We believe in the application of common sense,  
and do not place much reliance on ‘black box’ approaches to 
investment selection. 

Investments are, however, inherently unpredictable and there  
are risks associated with any investment strategy decisions.  
Recent history has been tumultuous and we remain ever watchful. 
We will continue to monitor the economic environment closely.

INVESTMENT PERFORMANCE 
Net investment income excluding realised and unrealised gains 
and losses, was $28.6 million for the year ended 31 December 2014, 
an increase of 12.6 per cent compared to 2013. The increase for 
the year ended 31 December 2014 compared to 2013 is mainly  
due to the increased size of the investment portfolio resulting  
from the acquisition of Cathedral during 2013.

Total investment return, including net investment income,  
net realised gains and losses, impairments and net change in 
unrealised gains and losses was $22.0 million for the year ended  
31 December 2014 compared to $6.9 million for 2013. For the  
year ended 31 December 2014, returns were generated primarily  
by a reduction in treasury yields, which offset the slight widening  

of investment grade credit spreads. This was in contrast to 2013 
which saw a significant increase in treasury yields, offset somewhat 
by notable investment grade credit spread narrowing. In addition, 
in 2013, our EMD portfolio was detrimentally impacted by rising 
treasury yields and wider EMD credit spreads which led to negative 
performance in this asset class.

LIQUIDITY 
Lancashire is a short-tail insurance and reinsurance group. As such, 
the investment portfolio must be liquid, short duration, and highly 
credit-worthy. As noted earlier, Lancashire’s investment strategy 
places an emphasis on the preservation of invested assets and 
provision of sufficient liquidity for the prompt payment of claims 
in conjunction with providing a reasonably stable income stream.

Liquid securities will be maintained at an adequate level to more 
than meet expenses, including unanticipated claims payments. 
Only once safety, liquidity, and investment income requirements 
are satisfied, may additional growth in the investment portfolio be 
pursued. Given the current global outlook and incessant volatility 
in the markets, this is unlikely to occur in the near future.

CASH FLOW
Lancashire’s cash inflows are primarily derived from net premiums 
received, from losses recovered from reinsurers, from net 
investment income, including dividends and other returns from 
associates, and any capital raising activities performed in a given 
year including the issuance of debt. Excess funds are invested in 
the investment portfolio, which consists of high-quality, highly 
liquid fixed income securities of short duration. Other cash inflows 
result from the sale and redemption of investments. 

The principal outflows for the Group are the settlement of claims, 
the payment of reinsurance cover, payment of general and 
administrative expenses, the servicing of debt, the purchase  
of investment products, the distribution of dividends and the 
repurchasing of shares. 

In 2014, operating cash flow was again strong, driven by the 
Group’s robust underwriting performance. A net positive cash 
inflow arose from operations during the year of $212.5 million 
(2013 – $167.7 million). We have generated positive operating  
cash flows in each year of operation since inception. 

KEY INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO STATISTICS

Duration
Credit quality
Market yield
Book yield

2010
2.2 years
AA
1.9%
2.4%

2011
1.8 years
AA–
1.5%
1.9%

2012
1.8 years
AA–
1.1%
1.8%

2013
1.0 years
AA-
1.2%
1.4%

2014
1.5 years
AA-
1.5%
1.5%

28 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

ASSOCIATES
The $5.9 million share of profit of associates for the year ended  
31 December 2014, mostly reflects Lancashire’s 10 per cent equity 
interest in KHL. The share of profit of associates was $9.2 million 
for the year ended 31 December 2013 and related to the Accordion 
and Saltire vehicles. Kinesis and third-party capital are discussed  
on page 32. 

OTHER OPERATING EXPENSES

Employee salaries and benefits
Employment taxes  
on equity compensation
Other operating expenses
Total Lancashire,  
excluding Lloyd’s segment
Lloyd’s segment
Total

2013 
$m
37.3

4.2
36.2

77.7
7.3
85.0

2014 
$m
36.0

(2.0)
36.8

70.8
40.5
111.3

Excluding the Lloyd’s segment, employee remuneration costs  
were $1.3 million lower for the year ended 31 December 2014 
compared to the same period in 2013 largely due to the retirement 
of the Company’s previous CEO earlier in the year. The year  
ended 31 December 2014 included reversals of employee national 
insurance accruals in relation to equity compensation exercises 
driven by both the timing of exercises and fluctuations in the  
share price. 

The Lloyd’s segment for the year ended 31 December 2014 
includes $20.1 million of employee remuneration costs and  
$12.0 million of other operating expenses and $8.4 million relating  
to the amortisation of intangible assets arising on acquisition.  
For comparison, for the full year 2013, including the period 
pre-acquisition, the Lloyd’s segment included $17.2 million,  
$14.1 million and $4.7 million respectively.

Equity based compensation was $23.3 million for the year  
ended 31 December 2014 and $16.7 million for the year ended  
31 December 2013. Included in the 2014 charge is $4.4 million  
for awards made to Cathedral employees.

CAPITAL MANAGEMENT
Lancashire has built a reputation for being one of the best known 
and most active proponents of capital management in the industry. 
Capital management is our most important area of focus after 
underwriting and it is our firm belief that pro-active and flexible 
capital management is crucial in helping to generate a superior 
risk-adjusted return over time. With our focus on maximising 
shareholder return we will return capital where this offers  
the best returns for our shareholders. Including dividends  
declared in February 2015, we have returned 101.9 per cent  
of comprehensive income generated via dividends or share 
repurchases since inception.

The Group actively reviews the level and composition of capital  
on an ongoing basis. Internal methods have been developed to 
review the profitability of classes of business and their estimated 
capital requirements plus the capital requirements of the 
combination of a wide range of other risk categories. The key  
aim of the capital management process is to maintain a strong 
balance sheet, whilst:

•  maintaining sufficient capital for underwriting opportunities  

and to meet obligations to policyholders;

•  maximising the risk-adjusted return to shareholders within 

predetermined risk tolerances; 

•  maintaining adequate financial strength ratings; and 

•  meeting internal, regulatory and rating agency requirements.

The subsidiary operating entities also conduct capital requirement 
assessments under internal measures and in compliance with  
local regulatory requirements. 

Capital raising can include debt or equity, and returns of capital 
may be made through dividends, share repurchases, a redemption 
of debt or any combination thereof. All capital actions require 
approval by the Board of Directors. The retention of earnings 
generated also leads to an increase in capital.

The composition of capital is driven by management’s appetite  
for leverage, amongst other factors, including the cost and 
availability of different types of capital. 

Maintaining a strong balance sheet will be the overriding factor  
in all capital management decisions.

CAPITAL
At 31 December 2014, total capital available to the Group was 
$1.683 billion, comprising shareholders’ equity of $1.357 billion and 
$326 million of long-term debt. Tangible capital was $1.530 billion. 
Leverage was 19.4 per cent on total capital and 21.4 per cent on  
total tangible capital. Total capital and total tangible capital at  
31 December 2013 was $1.792 billion and $1.615 billion respectively.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

29

PERFORMANCE 
BUSINESS REVIEW CONTINUED

DIVIDENDS
During 2014, the Lancashire Board declared an interim dividend 
of $0.05, special dividends of $0.20 and $1.20, and a final dividend 
in respect of 2013 of $0.10 per common share. With the final 
dividend in respect of 2014 of $0.10 per common share plus the 
additional special dividend of $0.50 per share, total capital returns 
since inception amount to $2.3 billion, or 234.6 per cent of initial 
capital raised. The final dividend of $0.10 per common share  
and special dividend of $0.50 per share have been declared  
and will be paid on 15 April 2015 to the shareholders of record  
on 20 March 2015.

NON PRE-EMPTIVE ISSUE OF SHARES
As part of Lancashire’s flexible approach to capital management 
the Board has in recent years requested and received from 
shareholders authority to issue up to 15 per cent of its shares  
on a non pre-emptive basis. Lancashire believes that this ability  
to raise capital quickly is important in securing first mover 
advantage in the catastrophe insurance and reinsurance business 
which it underwrites. The Board proposes to put a similar request 
for authority to shareholders in a resolution at the 2015 AGM  
to be held on 29 April 2015.

REPURCHASE PROGRAMME
During 2014, under the current Repurchase Programme  
ratified at the AGM on 30 April 2014, the Group commenced  
the repurchase of its own shares. The total shares repurchased  
during the year ended 31 December 2014 was $25.0 million 
compared to $nil in the year ended 31 December 2013.

WARRANTS
The outstanding warrants to purchase the Company’s common 
shares were issued on 16 December 2005 and expire on  
16 December 2015. We saw a higher volume of warrants  
exercised during 2014, relative to the prior year, and would  
expect this trend to continue until expiry. Warrants exercised 
during the year are shown below.

LETTERS OF CREDIT
Lancashire has standard LOC facilities which in total amount  
to $400.0 million, with a $75.0 million loan sub-limit available for 
general corporate purposes. Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 
each have a catastrophe facility in place to assist in paying claims 
and gross funding of catastrophes. These facilities amount to  
a combined $100.0 million with a total of $60.0 million available  
by way of LOCs.

There was no outstanding debt under the above facilities at any 
reporting date. There are no off-balance sheet forms of capital.

WARRANTS

Outstanding and exercisable  
as at 31 December 2013
Exercised during the year
Outstanding and exercisable  
as at 31 December 2014

Number of 
Management Team 
Performance 
warrants

Number of 
Management Team 
Ordinary warrants 

Number of 
Founder warrants

Number of 
Lancashire 
Foundation 
warrants

Number of  
ordinary warrants

Total Number 
of warrants

859,445
(741,965)

6,184,399
(5,625,217)

19,074,787
(4,042,108)

648,143
–

2,350,000
–

29,116,774
(10,409,290)

117,480

559,182

15,032,679

648,143

2,350,000

18,707,484

30 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

CATHEDRAL

2014 reflects the first full-year of contribution from Cathedral  
to the Lancashire Group’s results, following the completion of the 
acquisition in November 2013. The trading conditions were tough, 
but this was as expected. There was competition on all fronts, but 
Cathedral’s long-standing client and broker relationships served  
to mitigate the worst effects of this.

Syndicate 2010, for which Lancashire owns 57.8 per cent of the 
capacity, had a good year with the emphasis on protecting the core 
portfolio. The reinsurance and primary lines saw pricing pressure 
across the board, but in general our signings, the proportion of the 
business that we subscribe to that we actually get, remained strong. 
The Aviation Reinsurance account suffered a number of losses 
including two Malaysian Airlines aircraft and the violence in Tripoli 
airport. This led to an all too brief up tick of the market, but was 
quickly overwhelmed by continued overcapacity. Cathedral has 
renewed the majority of its core book and reduced exposures where 
appropriate. For the Direct and Facultative Property line, the Binding 
Authorities segment remained generally stable with small increases  
in the first half of 2014 balanced with small reductions in the second 
half. The Open Market segment, however, did see continued rate 
pressure, which we expect to build. Our Property Reinsurance book 
came under some rating pressure, but the terms and conditions  
held up better than was feared at one point and we have been able  
to deliver a book largely where we expected it to be.

Syndicate 3010 continued its build out to four new lines in 2014,  
which has seen us increase our stamp from £30.0 million to  
£60.0 million during the year with a further increase to £100.0 million  
for 2015. The core Cargo portfolio is now supported by new Energy  
and Terrorism accounts written by the LUK teams in conjunction  
with the existing Lancashire portfolios and benefiting from their 
relationship and expertise, and by two new aviation portfolios. 

“Cathedral has demonstrated  
the ability to adapt to the market, 
and to attract new talent and 
develop new product lines,  
even in a very difficult market.”

Peter Scales,  
Chief Executive Officer, Cathedral

Cathedral was fortunate to secure the services of two teams  
of underwriters specialising in Direct Aviation Hull and Liabilities  
with an emphasis on General Aviation and Rotorwing, and Aviation  
War including three consortia which the team leads on behalf  
of a number of Syndicates in Lloyd’s.

Cathedral has demonstrated the ability to trade through a difficult 
market, to attract new talent and develop new product lines.  
As a significant buyer of reinsurance, the silver lining to the soft 
market cloud has been the ability to buy a greater depth of cover, 
reduce retentions and make savings to mitigate the effect of 
reductions on inwards business, as was the case for 2014.

Key financial information for Cathedral is as follows:

Gross premiums written
Net premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net insurance losses
Net underwriting profit
Other income
Profit after tax
Comprehensive income

For the period  
7 November 2013 to 
31 December 2013  
$m
24.5
22.8
39.8
19.0
12.2
2.9
6.4
6.7

Full year 20131
$m
288.2
222.3
224.6
90.3
82.3
8.9
33.0
33.3

Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio2
Combined ratio2

47.7%
21.6%
15.8%
85.1%

40.2%
23.2%
13.9%
77.3%

2014
$m
284.3
219.4
214.1
102.5
64.1
10.2
25.7
25.4

47.9%
22.2%
15.0%
85.1%

(1) Full 2013 year financial information is presented for informational purposes only.

(2)  In accordance with standard Lloyd’s practice the expense ratio in CCL’s financial statements is 

presented net of fees, commissions and other non-investment income. On this basis the combined 
ratio for 2014 is 81.5 per cent compared to 78.7 per cent for the full year 2013 and 77.8 per cent for 
the period 7 November 2013 to 31 December 2013.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

31

PERFORMANCE 
 
BUSINESS REVIEW CONTINUED

KINESIS AND THIRD-PARTY CAPITAL

“Kinesis bound its first deals  
in 2014, representing a further 
development of Lancashire’s 
strategy to build partnerships 
with capital market participants.”

Darren Redhead,  
Chief Executive Officer, Kinesis

Following the success of the Accordion and Saltire sidecars,  
Kinesis was launched in 2013 and represents a further development 
of Lancashire’s strategy to build partnerships with capital market 
participants. It gives the Group the opportunity to leverage  
its underwriting expertise, whilst affording flexibility in the 
management and deployment of its own capital. In early 2014, 
Kinesis underwrote its first tranche of multi-class reinsurance 
agreements with further business written during the year.  
All contracts are fully collateralised with combined aggregate  
limits of $252.5 million, including net premiums written  
of $56.2 million. Two further offerings were completed during 
2014, where an additional $87.5 million of limits were written  
for $21.6 million of net written premiums.

Lancashire’s subsidiary KCML receives underwriting fees on  
all net premiums written by Kinesis Re, generating a stable  
stream of fee income, in addition to potential profit commissions.  
LHL also holds a 10 per cent equity stake in KHL, which is treated 
as an associate for accounting purposes. Lancashire’s share of 
KHL’s results is reflected as an equity pick up in the consolidated 
financial statements.

During the year ended 31 December 2014, Accordion and Saltire 
were placed in members’ voluntary liquidation. A final profit 
commission of $6.7 million was paid by Accordion following a 
commutation of our quota share agreement and this was recorded 
in net insurance acquisition cost. The Saltire vehicle ran loss free 
in 2013. During the first half of 2014 the Group received a payment 
of $3.0 million of profit commission from the Saltire vehicle. 

 Financial information for the year ended 31 December is as follows:

For the year ended 31 December 
Profit commission
Underwriting fees
Equity pick up

Note: LHL owns 92.7% of KCML at 31 December 2014.

Kinesis 

Accordion

Saltire

Total

2014 
$m
–
6.2
4.7

2013 
$m
–
–
–

2014 
$m
6.7
–
1.1

2013 
$m
–
1.8
6.6

2014 
$m
3.0
–
0.1

2013 
$m
–
1.2
2.6

2014 
$m
9.7
6.2
5.9

2013 
$m
–
3.0
9.2

32 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT

ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT

“The fundamental principle  
of the Group’s approach to ERM 
is that risk management should 
be embedded in the processes  
and procedures that we use  
to run our business every day. ”

Charles Mathias,  
Chief Risk Officer

In 2014 the Group has:

•  Developed and approved ERM and ORSA policies and procedures 

that were reviewed and agreed by the Board.

•  Performed and documented a Risk Taxonomy Review to validate 
the completeness of the risk registers and the relation of risk 
assessment to Internal Audit activity.

•  Performed and documented a Risk Appetite review leading to  

a Risk Appetite Process document to test and provide an overview 
of how we set and measure risk appetites.

•  Integrated the CUL exposures to the Group exposure monitoring 
suite to allow stochastic modeling of Group PMLs and aggregation 
of overlapping RDS events.

•  Submitted a Group ORSA point-in-time report to the PRA 

including an assessment of the appropriateness of the Standard 
Formula using a best efforts approach prior to finalisation  
of the guidelines.

Cathedral has maintained its ‘Green’ rating by Lloyd’s in relation to 
the Lloyd’s Solvency II regime. This has included submissions and 
procedural and process documentation for the internal model, 
submission of an ORSA and overall compliance with the Lloyd’s 
risk framework.

KCML has instituted its own risk register, with input from the CRO, 
which reflects its unique role within the Group as an underwriting 
manager. It has also been the subject of review by Internal Audit.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

33

The fundamental principle of the Group’s approach to ERM is  
that risk management should be embedded in the processes and 
procedures that we use to run our business every day. This has  
not changed. However in 2014 we have had a busy year, preparing 
for the advent of Solvency II and ensuring that, whilst we recognise 
the different operating models and environments of our different 
platforms, we have a clear view of our risks and their management 
right across the Group.

ERM DEVELOPMENTS
With Solvency II now slated to apply from 1 January 2016, and  
the first supervisory reporting to the PRA due in mid-2015 there 
has been a lot of activity in 2014. Currently the Group Supervisor  
is the BMA, but both LUK and Cathedral (via Lloyd’s) are subject 
to the supervision of the PRA and FCA in the UK. Bermuda is  
in the process of being assessed for Solvency II equivalence and  
is in the first wave of countries for consideration. The PRA has 
confirmed that it will be the Group Supervisor under the  
provisions of Solvency II.

At the Group level Lancashire created an ORSA Working Group. 
The concept of the ORSA is one that is gaining currency in many 
jurisdictions including the U.S. We believe that Lancashire has  
a good story to tell as we continually review our levels of risk  
and capital through established procedures such as the daily 
underwriting call, underwriting exception reports, weekly LICL 
and LUK PML updates and the fortnightly RRC meetings, as well  
as quarterly at the entity and Group Boards. The ORSA Working 
Group consists of the CRO and two Non-Executive Directors  
from the LHL Board who will rotate every two years. The ORSA 
Working Group allows Non-Executive Directors to make a more 
detailed review of the ORSA process and procedure, to raise 
challenges throughout the ORSA development and to contribute 
directly to the point-in-time report given to our regulators.

PERFORMANCE 
ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT CONTINUED

ERM STRUCTURE

Capital Optimisation
Continuous monitoring of current and projected solvency 
against a suite of rating agency, regulatory and internal 
tolerances using proprietary and external models.

Active capital optimisation across the cycle, maintaining 
appropriate buffers and contingency arrangements.

...maintaining the focus and flexibility to optimise  
capital in line with underwriting opportunity...  
(not the other way around) 

Risk Optimisation
Timely and appropriate integration of strategic and 
business planning, stress and scenario testing and  
capital and risk management to maximise shareholder 
returns across the cycle whilst maintaining exposures  
within appetite.

...targeting RoE of 13 per cent over the risk free rate across 

the cycle whilst exposing a maximum of 25 per cent  
of capital to a single peak zone return period loss  

in any one period...

ORSA & ERM

People
Collegiate underwriting approach across entities 
supported by the UMCC, daily exception reports, 
fortnightly management RRC covering the entire 
ERM and ORSA scope with core risk themes embedded  
in the work of key management and Board committees 
rather than being stand-alone.

...fostering and rewarding a culture of risk challenge, 
questioning and understanding throughout all our  
business – a ‘way of working’ not a ‘function’...

Process
Clear Group and Entity Risk Appetites spanning 

the entirety of the Risk Universe.

Significant investment in risk modeling and analytics 
tools and associated processes enabling virtually continuous 
monitoring and management of key risk metrics and their 
associated capital implications.

...clearly defined risk appetite and tolerances with effective 
processes for the identification, selection, assessment  
and optimisation of intrinsic and operational risk...

RRC
The Risk and Return Committee, now under the Chairmanship  
of the Group CEO, is the key management tool for monitoring and 
challenging the assessment of risk on a continual basis. The RRC 
agenda has seen a number of amendments in 2014 as part of  
a programme to ensure that we clearly embed the ownership  
of core ORSA elements in the RRC, and to schedule appropriate 
review activities across the business cycle. In particular, this has  
led to a more formal review of business planning, stress testing  
and reinsurance purchasing.

BLAST
We continue to challenge the assumptions used in BLAST and 
make changes where appropriate. In 2014, we have for example 
revised our assumptions about the frequency and severity of major 
energy losses, based on recent experience. We also developed 
BLAST to provide a more forward-looking assessment of underwriting 
risk through the use of synthetic portfolios for inwards property 
catastrophe reinsurance and retrocession business (i.e. the business 
that has most impact on our catastrophe exposures). The Kinesis 
catastrophe exposures were included alongside those of Cathedral, 
LICL and LUK.

EMERGING RISK
As ever, the Group tried in 2014 to foresee potential areas  
of new risk, or developments in existing risk that could threaten 
the Group. The continued emergence of new capital into the 
reinsurance arena and the subsequent displacement of traditional 
capacity into primary insurance may stretch the definition  
of an ‘emerging’ risk but it is an area that we monitor carefully. 
The Group CEO and CUO are uniquely well placed to see the 
trends through participation in the LICL and LUK daily UMCC. 
We also monitor cyber risk carefully, both in our operating 
exposure; where through our lack of retail clients and limited 
holding of our own employees personal data we present a low risk 
profile; and our insurance risk where we have conducted a careful 
review of our energy and marine hull accounts to determine  
what exposures there could be under our policies, and the 
robustness of policy exclusions where they are applied. We were 
satisfied that our exposure to cyber risk in these lines was limited 
and did not pose a threat to the business. The general geopolitical 
instability is also something we constantly monitor for implications 
for our Political Risk and trade-related lines such as Cargo and 
Sovereign obligors. The steep decline in the oil price is also  

34 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

bound to have an affect on our energy business, and we certainly  
expect the energy construction portfolio to be strongly impacted.  
There is little we can do to mitigate this, although parts of our  
Gulf of Mexico wind portfolio are sold on a multi-year basis,  
which is of some assistance.

fail to design or maintain effective tolerances and limits, and fail 
to maintain exposures within such limits; or that we fail to keep 
accurate and timely records of our exposures. We then devise 
systems and processes to mitigate these risks, such as PML 
reconciliations, and RDS sign-offs.

RISK UNIVERSE
We performed a detailed study and provided a paper to the ORSA 
Working Group in 2014 that looked at the taxonomy of risk –  
how we identify and classify risks, and what this means in terms  
of our management and mitigation strategy. We classify risks  
in three broad classes;

•  Intrinsic Risk: ‘Risk that stems from the inherent randomness and 
uncertainty that exists in the universe in which we operate and 
that is therefore fundamental to how we manage our business’. 
This is the risk we accept as inherent in the core functions of our 
business; so we recognise that by insuring against fortuitous events 
we can suffer losses, and by investing premiums and other assets 
we can see the value of those investments fall. We cannot avoid 
these risks so we focus on the correlated operational risks and  
seek to mitigate them. So for example, we know that by insuring 
against the risk of earthquake we are exposed to the risk that 
losses exceed our plan. We model our portfolio using stochastic 
modeling to review actual and planned exposures to ensure they 
remain within tolerances. The correlated risks are that we might 

•  Operational Risk: ‘The potential for specific losses arising as  
a result of inadequate or failed internal processes, personnel, 
systems or (non-insurance) external events’. Risks that are 
operational in causation can be split in to two sub-categories  
in terms of how they crystallise:

 – Independent: risks that have the potential to crystallise 

independently from intrinsic risk. For example, losses arising 
through the imposition of fines as a result of a regulatory 
breach, so unrelated to our core functions.

 – Correlated: risks that relate to the failure to effectively operate 
the processes designed to manage intrinsic risk, and therefore 
have the potential to amplify its impact beyond that modeled. 
For example, increased reinsurer default losses arising through 
the use of non-approved counterparties. 

•  Other Risk: This is the more nebulous category of risks such as 

reputational risk, or communication risk which cannot necessarily  
be mitigated by holding capital since they may not have direct 
balance sheet implications. These are included within the risk register 
and assessed and mitigated through scenario and stress testing.

RISK UNIVERSE

Type

Category

Description

c
i
s
n
i
r
t
n
I

l
a
n
o
i
t
a
r
e
p
O

r
e
h
t
O

e Underwriting Market 
r
o
C

(Investment)

Intrinsic risks representing the potential to generate a return as well as a loss.

In these areas, the Group promotes informed risk taking that considers the  
risk and return equation in all major decisions, with the intention of maximising 
risk adjusted return on equity.

-

e Reserving  
r
o
C
n
o
N

(Re)Insurance  
Counterparty 
Liquidity

Operational

Intrinsic risks to which we are inevitably exposed as a result of conducting  
our day-to-day business operations yet offer no direct potential for return.

They are quantified in so far as practicable for the purposes of capital and risk 
management and avoided or minimised insofar as is economically justifiable.

These are risks arising as a result of inadequate or failed internal processes, 
personnel, systems or (non-insurance) external events. 

They have the potential either to magnify the adverse impacts of intrinsic  
risks or crystallise separately in their own right.

Strategic Group  
Emerging

These are risks for which quantitative assessment is difficult but for which  
a structured approach is still required to ensure that their potential impact  
is considered and mitigated in so far as is practicable.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

35

PERFORMANCE 
PRINCIPAL RISKS

PRINCIPAL RISKS

As described under our review of the Risk Universe, our classification 
of risks as Intrinsic Core and Non-Core, Operational and Other,  
helps us to focus on our management and mitigation of those risks. 
Within BLAST insurance risk accounts for over 80 per cent of the 
allocated risk capital, so this is clearly the principal area where we 
stringently apply controls and reviews. For example, we place lots of 

controls around monitoring risk levels across the business. However we 
understand that even risks that do not generate a capital charge under 
an economic capital model can pose serious threats to the execution  
of the business plan and strategy, and therefore need to be monitored 
and tested. For example, we spend a lot of time looking at the 
implications of emerging capital and the evolution of the market cycle.

INTRINSIC RISK: CORE

TYPE
Underwriting: Losses in our classes are hard to predict as to the 
specifics of timing and quantum of occurrence. Additionally, we 
write lines of business that are subject to accumulations, including 
accumulations of individual risks in a single event such as several 
property catastrophe excess of loss programmes being affected  
by a windstorm or earthquake, and accumulations between business 
lines such as a 9/11 type event impacting both the terrorism and 
AV52 portfolios. Losses can also exceed expectations in terms  
of both frequency and severity. So although we model losses,  
for example using the RMS and AIR stochastic models, we know  
that these projections can and will be wrong in many instances. 

TYPE
Investment: We need to hold sufficient assets in readiness  
to pay claims, and the markets and products in which we invest  
can suffer volatility and losses. As a short-tail insurer, we are able  
to hold the majority of assets in low duration securities such as 
fixed income bonds. However, this creates an additional source  
of risk in the current environment, where there is a considerable 
risk from changes to interest rates as quantitative easing 
programmes may begin to taper or be increased. We model our 
investment portfolios and use various stressed scenarios to see  
what kinds of losses we could expect under a range of outcomes.

INTRINSIC RISK: NON-CORE

TYPE
Reserving: Because we do not know the amount of losses we  
are going to incur at the outset of a contract, we have to make 
estimates of the reserves we need to hold to pay claims. If these 
reserves are inadequate and claims exceed them, the change  
may have an impact on earnings, or indeed capital. We use 
independent external reviews of our reserves which look at the 
overall levels of expected losses, as well as individual large events, 
including benchmarking analyses.

36 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

MITIGATION
Modeling: We apply loads to, and stress test, stochastic models  
and develop alternative views of losses using exposure damage ratios.

Risk and Return Committee: The Committee considers 
accumulations, clashes and paramaterisation of losses and models.

Capital: We set our internal capital requirements at a level that 
allows for buffers above accumulations of extreme events.

MITIGATION
Investment strategy: Our strategy is that investment income is  
not expected to be a significant driver of our returns. Our primary 
focus remains on underwriting as the engine of profits. In 2014,  
we sought to hedge our interest rate risk through an increased  
risk asset allocation. 

Investment Risk and Return Committee: The IRRC forms  
an integral part of our risk management framework, meeting  
at least twice a quarter and reporting to the Board quarterly.

External advisers: Lancashire’s Board and management recognise 
that the Company’s principal expertise lies in underwriting,  
so we use the services of internationally recognised investment 
managers who are experts in their fields. 

MITIGATION
Short-tail business: Lancashire’s focus is on short-tail lines of 
business where losses are usually known within, or shortly after,  
the policy period with a reasonable degree of certainty. 

Experience data: We have access to a lot of data, both our own and 
from the industry as a whole, about losses and loss trends. Actuarial 
and statistical data is used to set estimates of future losses, and 
these are reviewed by underwriters, claims staff and actuaries  
to ensure that they reflect the actual experience of the business. 

External review: Insurers typically conduct an independent, 
external review of their loss reserves. Lancashire retains the 
services of one of the leading industry experts, and our appetite  
is defined so as to set reserves within a range of reasonable 
estimates based on both internal and external review. 

INTRINSIC RISK: NON-CORE CONTINUED

TYPE
Reinsurance and intermediary counterparty: Almost all our risks 
are brought to us by brokers, who act as an intermediary between 
us and the client and handle the transaction of payments of claims 
and premiums on our behalf. This exposes us to the risk of the 
mishandling by, or failure of, the broker concerned. In order to 
make our portfolio as efficient as possible, we buy reinsurance  
to protect against severity, frequency and accumulation of losses. 
Again, this exposes us to the risk that our counterparties may have 
the inability or unwillingness to pay us in the event of a loss. 

MITIGATION
Counterparty credit limits: We use counterparty limits and seek  
to deal with reputable reinsurers, and use collateral agreements 
where appropriate. The operating entities of the Group that 
contract for reinsurance separately, maintain and report their  
own counterparty credit limits at the entity level. System checks 
prevent the use of unauthorised intermediaries and we have  
terms of business agreements with all of them that seek to limit  
our exposure. All reinsurers must conform to minimum rating 
standards or collateral arrangements where appropriate.

TYPE
Liquidity: In order to satisfy claims payments we need to ensure  
that sufficient of our assets are held in readily realisable form.  
This includes holding cash accounts for the expected level of 
attritional losses, as well as ensuring we can meet claims payment 
requirements in extreme events.

MITIGATION
Portfolio management: The Group maintains liquidity significantly 
in excess of the Board agreed tolerances through its focus on 
maintaining a portfolio that is highly liquid, of overall short 
duration and highly creditworthy. We monitor this through the  
use of stress tests, and mitigate it through the quality of the 
investments themselves.

OPERATIONAL

TYPE
These are risks arising as a result of inadequate or failed internal 
processes, personnel, systems or (non-insurance) external events. 
They have the potential either to magnify the adverse impacts  
of intrinsic risks or crystallise separately in their own right. This can 
encompass IT availability where failure of an IT system such as our 
underwriting system could impact our ability to maintain accurate  
and up-to-date records of our exposure, which if correlated with an 
insurance loss could cause us to breach insurance risk tolerances.  
It could also encompass IT integrity, where an unauthorised intruder 
could alter data in our systems, or introduce a bug that would  
corrupt the system.

OTHER

TYPE
These are risks for which quantitative assessment is difficult but  
for which a structured approach is still required to ensure that 
their potential impact is considered and mitigated insofar as 
practicable. They include categories such as Strategic, Group and 
Emerging risks. A key area in 2014 has been Strategic Risk as we 
have seen continued emergence of capital eating away at pricing, 
and broadening of terms and conditions as the cycle reaches  
a low point.

MITIGATION
Capacity: We mitigate the availability risk by adding redundancy  
to the capacity we need and using backups of data including off-site 
storage and we test these systems regularly.

Testing and access: We mitigate the integrity risk by using 
independent external penetration tests, and by restricting access  
to key systems to only those people who need to use them.

MITIGATION
Qualitative approach: These risks require a qualitative approach, 
engaging staff in appropriate discussions about sources of risk,  
and then thinking about possible outcomes. The Group Executive 
Committee and the RRC consider these issues, and the CRO 
reports to the Board include standing items on Emerging Risk.

Revision of Attritional Loss Ratio: Lancashire has responded  
to the influx of new capital and the downturn in the market cycle 
by revising the expected attritional loss ratios to account for the 
changes to pricing and coverage, and using Kinesis to participate 
in a niche product for the collateralised market.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

37

PERFORMANCE 
CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY

BALANCING RISK, RETURN  
AND RESPONSIBILITY

WHY CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY  
IS IMPORTANT TO LANCASHIRE
Just as the Group seeks to balance risk and reward  
in the insurance market we are aware of the need to 
balance the responsibilities we owe to our stakeholders 
such as shareholders, regulators, staff and clients with 
our responsibilities to the broader society in which we 
operate. The insurance business by its nature seeks to 
provide support to those afflicted by the unexpected, 
but we recognise that many people and businesses 
around the world cannot afford, or do not have access 
to, the right kind of insurance. So we use our talents 
and resources, our people, time and money to support 
those who are in distress or at a disadvantage. We do 
this through our Foundation which supports a number 
of excellent charities, through giving our staff charity 
sabbatical weeks after an initial period of employment. 
We also do it by trying to be a responsible employer 
and a good corporate citizen in the societies in which 
we operate.

In terms of governance, the LHL Board sets the  
Group Corporate Responsibility policy and reviews 
reports on the activities of the Foundation (and is 
represented directly by a Non-Executive Director as 
one of the Trustees), the execution of the HR function, 
and the environmental impact of the business.  
The day-to-day activities of the Foundation are delegated 
to a Donations Committee comprised entirely of staff 
members, which monitors and reports on the activities 
of the charities to which donations are made.

OUR APPROACH
Corporate responsibility is an integral part of 
Lancashire’s approach to its business. We try to limit 
the negative impact of our carbon footprint through 
mitigation strategies and offsets, and we also try to 
improve the world around us in positive ways such  
as the donations of the Foundation and the staff charity 
days to work on local improvement projects. As well  
as the direct benefits, we believe that Lancashire reaps 
indirect benefits in terms of its attraction as an ethical 
and compassionate employer, and the positive 
team-building benefits of the activities undertaken.

COMMUNITY
There is a growing sense in the insurance market of an 
insurance community that can combine a commitment 
to excellence in providing a crucial support for trade 
and business with a determination to influence local 
and global societies for the better. We remain strongly 
committed to engaging with our local communities  
in Bermuda and London and continue to support  
local initiatives and activities across the network, 
through partnerships with schools, local government 
and local businesses. 

OUR APPROACH
We support our communities through the Foundation 
making donations to locally based charities and 
through our staff charity day release programmes  
and charity leave. We also help to run fundraising for 
the London Summer in the City Appeal to provide 
activities and care in the school holidays, and working 
groups to help improve our industry. We make our 
people available for market forums, and hold staff 
raffles to aid in our fundraising efforts.

OUR FOCUS AREAS 
We focus on victims of disasters and those who are 
disadvantaged whether through lack of opportunity, 
lack of resources or just a need for a helping hand.  
As our business is in part based on insuring against 
natural disasters we know very well how disruptive  
they can be, so our biggest Foundation donation  
is to Médecins Sans Frontières (MSF), who provide 
immediate aid in crisis situations (both natural and 
man-made) right across the globe.

The Foundation has made significant financial 
commitments to charities that support families in crisis 
(Family Centre) and children with autism (Tomorrow’s 
Voices) in Bermuda, and charities supporting ex-
offenders throughout the UK (St Giles Trust), and  
a poverty relief programme in the Philippines (ICM). 
But we also support them in other ways, for instance 
renovating premises for Tomorrow’s Voices, mentoring 
staff members for St Giles Trust and sending volunteers 
on week-long service missions to ICM. 

We also make donations to charities suggested by staff 
and indeed by clients and brokers. In 2014, we supported 
Medical Detection Dogs, Find a Better Way, Action  
on Addiction and Ace Africa, all at the suggestion  
of our business partners, helping to build the sense  
of an insurance community in Bermuda and London.

38 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

COMMUNITY

$14.0m

donated through the 
Lancashire Foundation 
since inception.

ENVIRONMENT

 100%

of CO2 emissions 
offset. 

MARKETPLACE

6,500

kids helped by the 
summer appeal 
co-ordinated by 
Lancashire in 2014.

WORKPLACE

 100%

of employees  
are eligible for  
RSS awards.

EMPLOYEE ENGAGEMENT
We recognise that the energy and talents of the people  
of Lancashire can make a difference in a number  
of ways, and that our charitable partnerships offer  
a valuable way to channel these generous instincts.  
We provide day release programmes for staff to give 
back to the communities in which they live and around 
the world. In addition, staff are entitled to a week’s 
charity leave on completion of three years’ permanent 
employment with the Group, which they can spend 
with a charity of their choice or with an existing 
Foundation-supported entity.

INTERNATIONAL CARE MINISTRIES (‘ICM’)
Teamwork is important at Lancashire, so for the last five years we’ve  
sent a team of six volunteers each year to work with ICM in the Philippines 
on a building project to improve the quality of life of the poorest of  
the poor. In 2014, a team of eight built toilets for slum dwellers, assisted  
in various lessons at kindergartens and hosted health and livelihood 
sessions to participants of a major transformation project run by the 
charity. The experience of working together in an environment that  
is both physically and emotionally tough is one that all the participants 
have cited as something that improves their relationships with colleagues  
across the Group.

“Lancashire have been a faithful partner to the poorest of the poor in the 
Philippines. Coming alongside ICM for the past 5 years with both financial 
sponsorship and volunteer service, your commitment to improving lives in the 
Philippines is an admirable and much needed investment.

At ICM, we focus on efficiency and effectiveness, and we are proud to say that 
Lancashire’s funding has been stewarded to create the maximum impact in the 
Philippines. Providing education to at risk children, delivering anti-malnutrition 
food, and developing strong leaders with effective training teams, Lancashire’s 
generosity has turned despair into hope for thousands of people, and provided  
them a better future.

Thank you for your generosity, commitment and support. Your gifts to ICM,  
both as volunteers and sponsors, inspire and encourage us to go further.  
We are so grateful to have a company of such high calibre standing alongside us  
in the fight against poverty. On behalf of the thousands of lives you have touched, 
thank you.”

DAVID SUTHERLAND, 
CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD, ICM 

ENVIRONMENT
As a business based in London and Bermuda, with 
clients and brokers around the globe, the Lancashire 
Group incurs the bulk of its carbon footprint in  
the form of airline travel, which we offset through  
an organised programme. In 2014, Cathedral  
and Lancashire UK moved into a new building at  
20 Fenchurch Street, which complies with all the  
latest standards for energy use and recycling.

OUR APPROACH
The figures in this report calculate 12 months from  
1 January 2014 to 31 December 2014. Lancashire  
has elected to use the number of full-time employees 
(FTE) as its intensity metric and has determined  
an intensity ratio of 12.9 tCO2e per FTE.

Types of Emissions

Activity

Direct (Scope 1)

Gas (kWh)
Refrigerant

tCO2e

40.3
13.0

Electricity (kWh)

751.6

Indirect energy 
(Scope 2)
Indirect other 
(Scope 3)

Business travel (km)
Additional 
Upstream Activities
Other
TOTAL EMISSIONS (tCO2e)
Intensity metric:  
Staff number – 192 FTE
TOTAL EMISSIONS (tCO2e) 
Intensity ratio per FTE

1,270.9

334.3
67.4
2,477.5

12.9

OUR FOCUS AREAS
Using an operational control approach, Lancashire 
assessed its boundaries to identify all of the activities 
and facilities for which it is responsible and reported 
on all of the material Green House Gas (GHG) 
emissions including Scope 1, 2 and 3. Calculations 
performed follow the ISO-14064-1:2006 standard  
and give absolute and intensity factors for the  
Group’s emissions. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

39

PERFORMANCE 
CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY CONTINUED

Results show that GHG emissions in the year 
were 2,477.5 tonnes of CO2e, comprised of direct 
emissions (Scope 1) amounting to 53.3 tonnes  
of CO2e, and indirect emissions (Scope 2) amounting 
to 751.6 tonnes of CO2e. The source of other indirect 
emissions (Scope 3) comprised 1,672.6 tonnes  
of CO2e. Lancashire has purchased carbon credits  
to reduce its gross GHG emissions by 2,477.5 tonnes, 
off-setting its total carbon emissions and remaining 
carbon neutral.

In terms of emissions intensity, tCO2e per FTE  
has increased by 13.2 per cent. This is due to the 
acquisition of Cathedral in 2013 and a subsequent 
increase in the number of FTEs. As actual data for 
Cathedral was unavailable in 2013, an extrapolation 
method was used based on industry standards; however 
a full set of actual data has been used in 2014’s 
calculation, which has also contributed to the increase 
in Group emissions. In addition, Well-to-Tank (WTT) 
and Transmission and Distribution (T&D) emissions 
that were not reported in 2013, have been included  
in 2014’s calculation, and account for more than  
13 per cent of total Group emissions.

MARKETPLACE
We continue to help the development of our 
marketplace by making employees available to sit  
on market committees, boards and working groups.  
In 2014, they have given talks at industry conferences, 
investor days and symposia, and as part of market 
education programmes. We continue to work closely 
with colleagues in the market on the Summer in the 
City fundraising. As noted above, we also donate  
to many of the causes supported by our industry  
peers through the Foundation.

OUR APPROACH
We believe the most important thing we can do is  
to make the talents of our people available, and we  
do this happily. We also engage actively with our 
regulators in Bermuda and London, and the Cathedral 
team are active within the Lloyd’s market structure. 
With our clients we are happy to welcome them to  
our offices, but we also travel to see them and their 
businesses right around the world.

40 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

INTERNSHIP PROGRAMME
Following a meeting with the Bermuda Minister for Home Affairs,  
the Company and the Lancashire Foundation jointly sponsor two two-year 
internship positions for Bermuda resident college graduates, to be spent 
working and learning in the Group’s London office. The two-year term  
is a major commitment demonstrating the Group’s determination to give 
back to Bermuda and the first two interns have been working in the 
London office during 2014.

“The Lancashire Foundation Graduate Development 
Programme has given me great insight into the 
underwriting process. The daily underwriting  
call allows for exposure to all classes of business 
written at Lancashire, enabling me to gain an 
understanding of various lines of business, 
beyond those that I have had the opportunity to  
be involved with on a daily basis. The Lancashire 
culture is one into which it has been incredibly easy  
to fit. Everyone is exceptionally approachable, willing  

to help and answer any questions; this setting has allowed me 

to learn about different aspects of the business beyond underwriting. The Lancashire 
Foundation Graduate Development Programme is a great jump start to my career and  
so far has given me a solid foundation in the London insurance market. I am really 
looking forward to the rest of my time at Lancashire.”

JAIME FERRARI-MCCOMB 
INTERN

“The Lancashire Foundation Graduate Development 
Programme has been a great experience for me.  

In my role I have been exposed to various 
classes of business. This has expanded my 
knowledge on different types of insurance,  
and I’ve learned more about the dynamic 
London market. Through various research 
tasks I’ve become more aware of current events 
around the world, and I am constantly learning 

new things. In my team I’m encouraged to ask 
questions, lines of communication are open, and teamwork 
is essential. During my time at the Bermuda office, I gained more knowledge about 
the reinsurance sector as well as more insight into the property catastrophe class of 
business. It was a very good learning experience to work with the team in Bermuda, 
particularly throughout the renewal period. The Lancashire Foundation Graduate 
Development Programme has had a very positive impact on me personally  
and professionally, and I am excited to see what the future holds!”

NICHOLAS BUTTERFIELD
INTERN

Visit our corporate website for more information: 
http://www.lancashiregroup.com

OUR FOCUS AREAS
Regulators: we recognise the need to engage closely 
with our regulators at the BMA, PRA, FCA and at 
Lloyd’s and seek to be transparent in all our dealings 
with them.

Clients: we strive to offer clear, fairly-priced and useful 
products that meet our clients’ needs across our three 
capital bases.

Brokers: we are fully committed to being a ‘broker 
market’ and prize our broker relationships very highly 
right across the Group. 

Investors: we continue to work hard at investor 
relations and have an active programme of engagement 
with investors around the globe. 

WORKPLACE 
We continue to strive to attract excellent employees 
who drive our appetite to outperform. Every company 
says it, but we truly believe that the talents of our 
people and our unique culture set us apart from our 
competitors. We strive to attract and retain the very  
best employees in the insurance industry. 

Recruiting the right people for the Group will always  
be a high priority for the business. It is critical that the 
aspirations and values of new recruits are a good match 
to both the role and the values of the Company.

OUR FOCUS AREAS
Our focus in 2014 has been to maintain the success of  
our employees through ongoing training and coaching –  
provided both internally and externally. We have continued 
to deliver the Management Development Programme and 
we measure our employees’ success through attainment 
of personal performance metrics as well as performance 
within the Group’s values framework. 

DIVERSITY
We are committed to being an equal opportunities 
employer. The Lancashire Group is currently 
represented by employees from 16 different nations. 
There is a 65/35 per cent split of males to females  
(see page 58) that work in the Group. New staff receive 
equal opportunities training during their induction, 
and refresher training sessions for all staff are planned 
for 2015. We promote the value of having a diverse 
workforce. We have recently supported the ‘Ban the 
Box’ campaign, an initiative from Business in the 
Community to give ex-offenders better employment 
opportunities by calling for the removal of tick boxes 
from employment application forms that ask about 
criminal convictions. 

Page 58
See our diversity figures

MÉDECINS SANS FRONTIÈRES

“2014 has been a remarkable year for MSF, as our 
staff continue to face an almost unprecedented 
level of humanitarian need. At the start  
of the year, MSF teams were responding to 
emergencies in South Sudan, Central African 
Republic and the Philippines. Whilst the 
devastation wrought by Typhoon Haiyan 
required a much shorter response, the violence 
prevalent in South Sudan and Central African 
Republic has been widespread. There has been little 
immunity granted to those working to provide healthcare  

to affected people – in South Sudan MSF hospitals have been bombed, looted and 
destroyed; in Central African Republic hospitals sheltering those wounded and sick 
were targeted, and in April, MSF lost three of our own staff in such an attack.

Other concurrent emergencies were even more challenging to respond to. The targeting 
of aid workers in Syria, including our own staff, resulted in the closure of MSF 
health facilities in the north-west of the country. Despite the mass violence and  
huge needs in Syria, MSF teams are constrained to working on the periphery  
of the country, providing medical care for those who make it to Jordan or Lebanon, 
and supporting national medical staff inside the country with supplies and 
equipment. In Myanmar, MSF activities in Rakhine State were suspended in 
February by the government, depriving a Muslim minority group, the Rohingya, 
many of whom live in squalid camps with restricted movement and without  
vital healthcare.

Then Ebola happened. An outbreak, not a war or communal violence, not a natural 
disaster, and not the actions of a government. During my years with MSF, I’ve read 
many testimonies from our staff working in crisis situations, however I’ve never  
been transported to the horrors of a situation quite so vividly as to the horrors  
of West Africa in the grip of the biggest Ebola outbreak the world has ever seen.  
A disease that preys on the compassion of those who care for those that are sick.  
Yet somehow in between all of the horror, our staff have also managed to transport 
me to those that have survived.

The work we do is possible because of your support. MSF puts a priority on private 
funds, raised from donors like Lancashire Insurance. Without this, MSF would  
not be able to work in situations that are not in the public eye, nor would we have 
been able to be the first responder to Ebola, or mounted large emergency responses  
in remote parts of South Sudan and Central African Republic.

Knowing that we have the continued support of Lancashire Insurance is so important 
to our teams, both in the office and in the field. I want to extend my personal thanks 
to you for that support, for entrusting MSF with your donation and enabling us  
to do our vital work. Thank you.”

VICKIE HAWKINS 
EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR – MSF UK

www.lancashiregroup.com 

41

PERFORMANCE 
GOVERNANCE

Opportunities

emerge & 

while here at Lancashire, we keep 
ourselves one step ahead of the curve,  
so that we are ready to maximise the 
right opportunities as they emerge  
into the market.

DIVIDEND YIELD
Lancashire’s dividend yield demonstrates 
the active capital management that 
underpins our business model. Although 
we will buy back shares when the valuation 
makes sense, if we want to right-size capital 
quickly, the special dividend has become 
the key tool to enable us to do this.

17.8%

20

15

10

5

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

5 Year average 

13.0%

42 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

evolve 

GOVERNANCE

www.lancashiregroup.com 

43

 
CHAIRMAN’S INTRODUCTION

EFFECTIVELY MANAGING CHANGE

“ A combination of independence 
and diversity of talents  
and perspectives equips the 
Board to meet the challenges  
of our business. ”

Martin Thomas,  
Non-Executive Chairman

Q |  IS THE BOARD EFFECTIVE?

A | In my opening remarks I highlighted those changes that  
we have implemented to the Board and management team during  
this last year. The transition in management required time and 
attention from all the Non-Executive members of our Board,  
and I am grateful to all our Directors for the diligence with which 
they discharged their duties during the year. A Board is not always 
a comfortable place, but when it holds the necessary diversity  
of skills and experience it can operate as a forum to provide  
the strategic leadership and direction required by a business, 
particularly during times of transition. Having risen to these 
challenges earlier during the year, the Board took the opportunity 
to consider in more detail its own operation, composition and 
governance in a process facilitated by KPMG. That process has 
helped our Board to learn useful lessons and to focus on the 
requirement to maintain a Board whose members are independent 
in judgement and character and whose diversity of talent and 
perspectives equips the Board as a whole to meet challenges  
of the business. It has also helped inform our search for new talent 
and insight and I am delighted to be able to welcome Peter Clarke 
and Tom Milligan to our Board, who between them bring a wealth 
of experience in the areas of insurance, underwriting and 
investments as well as senior management and the operation  
of listed companies.

In my opening statement I gave a broad overview of the challenges 
addressed by the Board during 2014 in ensuring that our business 
has the right management and strategic goals. The following 
section contains a more detailed account of the work carried out  
by the Board and its Committees in exercising effective oversight, 
taking decisions and providing support and constructive challenge 
to the business.

Q |  HOW DOES THE BOARD SET AND MONITOR THE 
GOVERNANCE OBJECTIVES FOR THE GROUP?

A | Lancashire seeks to achieve the highest standards of corporate 
governance. By virtue of its premium listing on the LSE, Lancashire 
measures its corporate governance compliance against the 
requirements of the UK Corporate Governance Code published  
by the UK Financial Reporting Council (FRC). The FCA requires 
each company with a premium listing to ‘comply or explain’ 
against the Code (i.e. to disclose how it has complied with Code 
provisions or, if the Code provisions have not been complied with, 
provide an explanation for the non-compliance). The Code was 
further revised during 2014 for financial years beginning on or 
after 1 October 2014, but Lancashire and the Board have decided 
to comply with these new requirements in this year’s Annual 
Report. The Company monitors its compliance with the Code,  
and in this corporate governance section and throughout this 
Annual Report for the 2014 financial year, areas of corporate 
governance compliance and non-compliance are explained by 
reference to the Code, as revised. The Company also monitors  
its compliance with applicable corporate governance requirements 
under Bermuda law and regulations. I am pleased to be able  
to report that there are no areas of material non-compliance  
with the Code.

44 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

The 2014 performance appraisal of the Board and its Committees 
was facilitated by Chris Head, our Company Secretary, (see page 50 
for further details). A summary report was discussed by the full 
Board and I am pleased to report the conclusion that the Board 
and each of its Committees are considered to have a balance  
of skills and perspectives that serve the Company effectively.  
The process also identified a number of areas for procedural 
improvements, training and learning. Following the recent period  
of rebuilding and refreshment, I believe Lancashire’s Board  
is appropriately constituted to deliver the benefits of experience 
from a diverse range of perspectives and backgrounds. All the 
current Directors are recommended to shareholders for re-election 
at the 2015 AGM and I anticipate that 2015 will be a year of  
relative stability and continuity on the Board. 

In closing I would like to record the thanks and appreciation  
of everyone at Lancashire to Ralf Oelssner, who sadly died in  
May 2014, shortly after having stepped down from the Boards  
of LHL and LUK. Ralf was a true gentleman who served our 
business over many years with a close attention to detail and  
a particular talent for contributing to the debate only at those 
moments when his insight was most valuable. 

MARTIN THOMAS
CHAIRMAN

OUR GOVERNANCE STRUCTURE

Group 
Board

LANCASHIRE HOLDINGS LIMITED
BOARD OF DIRECTORS

Group 
Committees

AUDIT 
COMMITTEE

NOMINATION 
& CORPORATE 
GOVERNANCE COMMITTEE

INVESTMENT 
COMMITTEE

REMUNERATION 
COMMITTEE

UNDERWRITING  
& UNDERWRITING  
RISK COMMITTEE

Page 52

Page 57

Page 56

Page 60

Page 59

Operational 
Boards

LUK 
BOARD

LICL   
BOARD

KCML 
BOARD

CCL BOARD

www.lancashiregroup.com 

45

GOVERNANCE 
BOARD OF DIRECTORS

OUR TEAM

MARTIN THOMAS (AGE 51),
NON-EXECUTIVE CHAIRMAN

ALEX MALONEY (AGE 41),
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER

ELAINE WHELAN (AGE 40),
CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER

PETER CLARKE (AGE 55),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

EMMA DUNCAN (AGE 55),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

SIMON FRASER (AGE 51),
SENIOR INDEPENDENT
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

SAMANTHA HOE-RICHARDSON (AGE 44),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

TOM MILLIGAN (AGE 45),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

CHRISTOPHER HEAD (AGE 48),
COMPANY SECRETARY 

46 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

MARTIN THOMAS (AGE 51),
NON-EXECUTIVE CHAIRMAN

PETER CLARKE (AGE 55),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

Martin Thomas is a partner and board member of Altima Partners, 
LLP, the hedge fund manager, and a Director of two farming 
businesses, El Tejar Limited and Spearhead International Limited. 
Prior to this, he was an official of the Bank of England, most 
recently on secondment to the EU Commission where he worked 
in the Financial Services Policy and Financial Markets Directorate 
of the Internal Market and Services Directorate General. Before  
Mr Thomas joined the Commission, he established the Financial 
Markets Law Committee at the Bank of England. Prior to that, he 
was Deputy Chief Executive of the Financial Law Panel and prior  
to that, senior counsel to the European Central Bank in Frankfurt. 
He started his career in private practice, specialising in corporate 
and commercial litigation at Travers Smith and in the law and 
regulation of financial services at Clifford Chance. 

ALEX MALONEY (AGE 41),
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER

Alex Maloney joined Lancashire in December 2005 and was 
appointed Group Chief Executive Officer in April 2014. On 
joining, Mr Maloney was responsible for establishing and building 
the energy underwriting team and account and, in May 2009, was 
appointed Group Chief Underwriting Officer. Since November 
2010 Mr Maloney has served as a member of the Board and was 
appointed Chief Executive Officer of Lancashire Insurance 
Company (UK) Limited in 2012. Mr Maloney also serves as a 
Director of Cathedral Underwriting Limited and has been closely 
involved in the development of the Group’s Lloyd’s strategy.  
Mr Maloney has over 20 years of underwriting experience and has 
also worked in the New York and Bermuda markets.

ELAINE WHELAN (AGE 40),
CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER

Elaine Whelan joined Lancashire in March 2006 and leads both 
the Group finance function and the Bermuda insurance subsidiary, 
reporting to the Group Chief Executive Officer. Ms Whelan was 
previously Chief Accounting Officer of Zurich Insurance Company, 
Bermuda Branch. Prior to joining Zurich, Ms Whelan was an  
Audit Manager at PricewaterhouseCoopers, Bermuda, where  
she managed a portfolio of predominately (re)insurance and 
captive insurance clients.

Peter Clarke was Group Chief Executive of Man Group plc  
between April 2007 and February 2013. In 1993 Mr Clarke joined 
Man Group plc, a leading global provider of alternative investment 
products and solutions as well as one of the world’s largest futures 
brokers. He was appointed to the board in 1997 and served in  
a variety of roles before becoming the Group Finance Director in 
2000. During this period he was responsible for investing in and 
developing one of the leading providers of third-party capital 
insurance and reinsurance products. In November 2005, he was 
given the additional title of Group Deputy CEO. Mr Clarke is 
currently the Chairman of the National Teaching Awards Trust and 
a Non-Executive Director of both AXA Investment Management S.A. 
and Lombard Odier Investment Management. Mr Clarke took a 
first in Law at Queens’ College, Cambridge and is a qualified 
solicitor, having practised at Slaughter and May, and has 
experience in the investment banking industry, working at 
Morgan Grenfell and Citibank.

EMMA DUNCAN (AGE 55),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

Emma Duncan is the Deputy Editor of The Economist. She has  
also held several other posts on the magazine, including Britain 
Editor and Asia Editor. She has covered the media business,  
the Middle East, home affairs, agriculture, commodities and the 
transport industry and has served as Delhi correspondent, covering 
India, Pakistan, Bangladesh and Sri Lanka. She has written special 
reports for the magazine on Saudia Arabia and the Gulf states, 
India, Pakistan and the food industry. Ms Duncan appears regularly 
on television and radio programmes. She has written widely on a 
freelance basis, for publications such as The Times, The Sunday 
Times, The Daily Telegraph, Vogue and Cosmopolitan. She has  
an honours degree in politics, philosophy and economics from 
Oxford University and started her career as a researcher and 
reporter at Independent Television News.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

47

GOVERNANCE 
BOARD OF DIRECTORS CONTINUED

SIMON FRASER (AGE 51),
SENIOR INDEPENDENT NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

CHRISTOPHER HEAD (AGE 48),
COMPANY SECRETARY 

Christopher Head joined Lancashire in September 2010. Mr Head 
is Company Secretary of Lancashire Holdings Limited and advises 
on issues of corporate governance and generally on legal affairs  
for the Group. Prior to joining Lancashire, Mr Head was in-house 
counsel with the Imagine Insurance Group, advising specifically  
on policy wording and the structuring of reinsurance transactions. 
He transferred to Max at Lloyd’s in 2008 as Lloyd’s and London 
Counsel. Between 1998 and 2006 Mr Head was Legal Counsel  
at KWELM Management Services Limited, where he managed  
an intensive programme of reinsurance arbitration and litigation  
for insolvent members of the HS Weavers underwriting pool.  
Mr Head is a qualified solicitor having trained at Barlow Lyde  
and Gilbert where he worked in the Reinsurance and International 
Risk Team. Mr Head has a History degree and legal qualification  
from Cambridge University, where he was a choral scholar in  
the choirs of King’s College and Trinity College.

Simon Fraser was Head of Corporate Broking at Merrill Lynch  
and subsequently Bank of America Merrill Lynch until his 
retirement in 2011. He began his career in the City in 1986  
with BZW and joined Merrill Lynch in 1997. He led initial public 
offerings, rights issues, placings, demergers and mergers and 
acquisitions transactions during his career and advised many  
UK companies on stock market and London Stock Exchange 
issues. Mr Fraser has an MA degree in modern history from  
St Andrews University. He is also a Non-Executive Director  
of Derwent London plc where he chairs the Remuneration 
Committee and sits on the Audit and Nominations Committees.

SAMANTHA HOE-RICHARDSON (AGE 44),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

Samantha Hoe-Richardson is Head of Environment for Anglo 
American plc, one of the world’s leading mining and natural 
resources companies. Ms Hoe-Richardson is responsible for 
improving sustainable development performance across the 
breadth of Anglo American’s business units in areas such as  
water and climate change. She is also a director of Anglo American 
Zimele Green Fund (Pty) Ltd, which supports entrepreneurs  
in South Africa. Prior to her role with Anglo American,  
Ms Hoe-Richardson worked in investment banking and audit  
and she holds a masters degree in nuclear and electrical 
engineering from the University of Cambridge. She also has  
a chartered accountancy qualification.

TOM MILLIGAN (AGE 45),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR

Tom Milligan was Co-Chief Executive Officer of Ariel Re Holdings 
Ltd., until his retirement in 2015. He began his career in the City 
in 1991 with Guy Carpenter & Co. and worked in both London  
and Bermuda as an insurance intermediary and underwriter.  
In 2005, Mr Milligan joined Goldman Sachs Group Inc. to start  
and manage the GS Reinsurance Group’s non-life activities.  
As a Managing Director of Goldman Sachs, Mr Milligan served  
as Chief Underwriting Officer of Arrow Capital Re in Bermuda, 
before starting GS-owned Lloyd’s Syndicate 1910 in 2008 and 
serving as Active Underwriter until 2012. In 2012, Mr Milligan  
led GS’ purchase of Ariel Re and served as Co-CEO from April 
2012 until July 2014. During 2013, Mr Milligan played a leading 
role in the spin-off of GS Reinsurance Group into Global Atlantic 
Financial Group (GAFG), before managing the sale of the Ariel 
businesses from GAFG to BTG Pactual in 2014. Mr Milligan 
graduated from Durham University in 1991.

48 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT

BOARD COMMITTEES

THE DIRECTORS
Appointments to the Board are made on merit, against objective 
criteria and with due regard for the benefits of diversity on  
the Board, including gender. The Board considers all of the 
Non-Executive Directors to be independent within the meaning  
of the Code.

Peter Clarke, Emma Duncan, Samantha Hoe-Richardson and  
Tom Milligan are independent, as each is independent in character 
and judgement and has no relationship or circumstance likely to 
affect his or her independence. Prior to his appointment in 2013, 
the Board noted special circumstances relevant to determination  
of the independence of Simon Fraser which required consideration 
under the Code. Having taken into account Simon Fraser’s 
employment at Merrill Lynch, in which capacity he had acted  
as lead corporate broker to the Company, and from which he  
had retired in December 2011, the Board determined that Simon 
Fraser is independent in character and judgement. This matter  
was previously disclosed and discussed in the Company’s 2013 
Annual Report. Simon Fraser became the Senior Independent 
Director on 30 April 2014 succeeding Ralf Oelssner upon his 
retirement from the Board. Martin Thomas was independent  
upon his appointment as Chairman on 1 May 2007. At the Board 
meeting held on 11 February 2015, further to a recommendation 
by the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee,  
the Board affirmed its judgement that five of the eight members  
of the Board are independent Non-Executive Directors. Therefore, 
in the Board’s judgement, the Board composition complies with 
the Code requirement that at least half the Board, excluding the 
Chairman, should comprise Non-Executive Directors determined 
by the Board to be independent. 

In accordance with the provisions of the Code, all Directors  
are subject to annual election by shareholders. Shareholders  
are asked to note that Martin Thomas will have served as both  
a Non-Executive Director and Chairman of the Board for more  
than six years. Notwithstanding this period of service, the Board  
is of the view that Mr. Thomas continues to offer valuable  
service to the Company. The Board proposes to recommend  
the re-election of all the Directors at the 2015 AGM. 

INFORMATION AND TRAINING
On appointment, the Directors receive written information 
regarding their responsibilities as Directors and information  
about the Group. An induction process is tailored for each new 
Director in the light of his or her existing skill set and knowledge 
of the Company, and includes meeting with senior management 
and visiting the Company’s operations. Information and advice 
regarding the Company’s official list and legal and regulatory 
obligations and on the Company’s compliance with the 
requirements of the Code is also provided on a regular basis.

An analysis of the Company’s compliance with the Code is  
collated and summarised in quarterly reports together with a  
more general summary of corporate governance developments, 
which are prepared by the Company’s Legal and Compliance 
department for consideration by the Nomination and Corporate 
Governance Committee. The Directors have access to the Company 
Secretary who is responsible for advising the Board on all legal  
and governance matters. The Directors also have access to 
independent professional advice as required. Regular sessions  
are held between the Board and management as part of the 
Company’s quarterly Board meetings, during which in-depth 
presentations covering areas of the Group’s business are made. 
During these presentations the Directors have the opportunity  
to consider, challenge and help shape the Company’s  
commercial strategy.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

49

GOVERNANCE 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT CONTINUED

BOARD PERFORMANCE EVALUATION
A formal performance evaluation of the Board, its Committees  
and individual Directors is undertaken on an annual basis and the 
process is initiated by the Nomination and Corporate Governance 
Committee. The aim of this work is to assess the effectiveness  
of the Board and its Committees in terms of performance, 
composition, supporting processes and management of the  
Group, as well as to review each Director’s performance, training 
and development needs. The 2012 performance evaluation  
was facilitated by external consultants, whilst in 2013 and 2014  
the evaluation was conducted internally.

During 2014, it was decided that the evaluation process would be 
led by the Company Secretary, who conducted a series of meetings 
with each of the Directors to appraise and discuss their individual 
performances and to ascertain their views on the effectiveness  
of the Board and its Committees, the contribution of each of  
the individual Directors, and the management of the Company. 
The process was informed by the governance review which had 
been facilitated by KPMG earlier during 2014. On completion of 
the interviews, the Company Secretary reported to the Nomination 
and Corporate Governance Committee and the Board.

In summary, the 2014 evaluation discussions found that the  
Board operates effectively and has a good blend of insurance, 
financial and regulatory expertise. All Non-Executive Directors  
are committed to the continued success of the Company and  
to making the Board and its Committees work effectively. 
Attendance at Board meetings was found to be good. The CEO  
and the CFO, the Company’s Executive Directors, were also  
found to be operating effectively.

Appropriate infrastructure, processes and governance mechanisms 
are in place to support the effective performance of the Board  
and its Committees. The Board is considered to manage risk 
effectively. The number of Directors on the Board is considered  
to be appropriate and the Board Committees are considered to 
have an appropriate balance of skills and to function effectively.  
The Board will continue to review its procedures, training 
requirements, effectiveness and development in 2015. 

The Chairman’s performance appraisal was convened by the Senior 
Independent Director, who consulted with the Non-Executive 
Directors with input from the Executive Directors during July 2014. 
The Chairman’s performance was found to be effective.

At the end of the year, the Chairman met the CEO, and the CEO 
met the CFO, to conduct a performance appraisal in respect  
of 2014 and to set targets for 2015.

Non-Executive Directors
John Bishop1
Peter Clarke2
Emma Duncan3
Simon Fraser4
Samantha Hoe-Richardson5
Neil McConachie6
Ralf Oelssner7
Robert Spass8
William Spiegel9
Martin Thomas
Executive Directors
Richard Brindle10
Alex Maloney
Elaine Whelan

Board

Audit  
Committee

Investment 
Committee

Nomination
and Corporate 
Governance 
Committee

Remuneration 
Committee

Underwriting 
and Underwriting 
Risk Committee

4/4
3/3
8/8
8/8
8/8
3/4
0/4
8/8
7/8
8/8

1/1
7/7
6/6

2/2
1/2
–
4/4
4/4
–
0/2
_
–
–

–
–
–

–
1/2
0/0
–
–
2/2
_
3/4
3/4
_

_
–
4/4

–
_
3/3
_
3/3
–
1/5
–
4/5
8/8

–
–
–

–
0/0
6/6
6/6
–
_
0/4
_
5/6
–

_
–
_

2/2
_
–
–
–
–
0/2
–
–
–

1/2
4/4
–

(1) John Bishop retired from the Board, and as a member of the Audit and Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committees, on 30 April 2014.

(2) Peter Clarke was appointed to the Board and as a member of the Audit and Investment Committees on 9 June 2014, and was appointed as a member of the Remuneration Committee on 4 November 2014.

(3) Emma Duncan was appointed as a member of the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee on 5 June 2014 and as a member of the Investment Committee on 4 November 2014.

(4) Simon Fraser was appointed Chair of the Remuneration Committee on 30 April 2014.

(5) Samantha Hoe-Richardson was appointed Chair of the Audit Committee on 30 April 2014 and as a member of the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee on 5 June 2014.

(6) Neil McConachie retired from the Board and as a member of the Investment Committee on 30 April 2014.

(7)  Ralf Oelssner suffered from ill health for much of 2014 and was unable to attend the majority of meetings held prior to his retirement from the Board on 30 April 2014. He also retired as a member  

of the Audit, Nomination and Corporate Governance, Remuneration and Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committees on 30 April 2014. Mr Oelssner sadly passed away shortly after his retirement.

(8) Robert Spass retired from the Board and the Investment Committee on 31 December 2014.

(9) William Spiegel retired from the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee on 5 June 2014 and from the Board and Investment and Remuneration Committees on 31 December 2014.

(10) Richard Brindle retired from the Board, and as a member of the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee, on 30 April 2014.

50 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

COMMITTEES
The Board has established Audit, Nomination and Corporate 
Governance, Remuneration, Investment and Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk Committees. Each of the Committees has 
written Terms of Reference, which are reviewed regularly and are 
available on the Company’s website (www.lancashiregroup.com). 
All the Committee Terms of Reference were reviewed and revised 
by the Board during 2014 with particular reference to the good 
practice guidance published by the ICSA. The Committees  
are generally scheduled to meet quarterly although additional 
meetings are scheduled as business requirements dictate.

The composition of the Committees as at 31 December 2014 was  
as set out in the table appearing on page 45. A report from each  
of the Committees is set out from page 52 through to page 60.

RELATIONS WITH SHAREHOLDERS
During 2014, the Group’s Head of Investor Relations, usually 
accompanied by one or more of the CEO, the CUO, the CFO,  
the CRO, the Chairman or a senior member of the underwriting 
team, made presentations to major shareholders, analysts and  
the investor community. Formal reports of these meetings were 
provided to the Board on at least a quarterly basis. 

Conference calls with shareholders and analysts hosted by senior 
management are held quarterly following the announcement  
of the Group’s financial results. The CEO, CUO and CFO are 
generally available to answer questions at these presentations.

Shareholders are invited to request meetings with the Chairman, 
the Senior Independent Director and/or the other Non-Executive 
Directors by contacting the Head of Investor Relations. All of the 
Directors are expected to be available to meet with shareholders  
at the Company’s 2015 AGM.

The Company commissions regular independent shareholder 
analysis reports together with independent research on feedback 
from shareholders and analysts following the Company’s results 
announcements. This research, together with the analysts’ notes,  
is made available to all Directors.

ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT
The Board is responsible for setting the Group’s risk appetite  
and preferences, defining its risk tolerances, and monitoring  
and ensuring compliance with risk tolerances. During 2014,  
the Board carried out a robust assessment of the principal  
risks affecting the Group’s business model, future performance, 
solvency and liquidity.

Further discussion of the risks affecting Lancashire and the  
policies in place to manage them can be found in the risk 
disclosures section on pages 100 to 126. 

Each of the Committees is responsible for various elements of risk. 
The CRO reports directly to the Group and subsidiary Boards and 
facilitates and aids the identification, evaluation, quantification  
and control of risks at a Group and subsidiary level. The CRO 
provides regular reports to the Group and subsidiary Boards 
covering, amongst other things, actual risk levels against tolerances, 
emerging risks and any lessons learned from risk events. The Board 
considers that a supportive ERM culture, established at the Board 
and embedded throughout the business, is of key importance. 
Facilitating and embedding of ERM and helping the Group  
to improve its ERM practices is a major responsibility assigned  
to the CRO. The Group’s risk management is informed by FRC’s 
Internal Control: Revised Guidance for Directors on the Combined 
Code. The CRO’s remuneration is subject to annual review  
by the Remuneration Committee.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

51

GOVERNANCE 
COMMITTEE REPORTS

Samantha Hoe-Richardson –  
Chairman of the Audit Committee

AUDIT COMMITTEE
“ The Audit Committee works closely with 
management and the Company’s internal and 
external auditors to give the Board and our 
broader stakeholders assurance on the quality 
and integrity of the Company’s financial 
statements, reports and financial controls.”

Following the AGM on 30 April 2014, I was delighted to take up  
the position of Audit Committee Chairman, a role that I assume 
from John Bishop who had ably chaired the Audit Committee  
since 2010. I would like to thank John Bishop and Ralf Oelssner, 
who served on the Audit Committee until their retirement  
from the Board at the 2014 AGM, as well as the current Audit 
Committee members and all those staff who contribute to the 
Audit Committee’s work.

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
The Audit Committee comprises three independent Non-Executive 
Directors and is chaired by Samantha Hoe-Richardson, a qualified 
accountant, whom the Board considers to have recent and relevant 
financial experience (see Ms Hoe-Richardson’s biography on page 
48). The internal and external auditors have the right of direct 
access to the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee’s detailed 
Terms of Reference are available on the Company’s website. 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson (Chairman)
Simon Fraser 
Peter Clarke (appointed effective 9 June 2014) 
Former members
John Bishop
Ralf Oelssner

Notes:

(1)  John Bishop and Ralf Oelssner retired from the Committee on 30 April 2014  

(see notes 1 and 7 on page 50).

Meetings attended

4/4
4/4
1/2

2/2
0/2

PRIORITIES FOR 2015
The Committee’s priorities for 2015 are to ensure the continued 
effectiveness of the Company’s control environment and ensure 
that the Company is able to meet the requirements of the new 
Solvency II regime in 2016.

52 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

FINANCIAL REPORTING

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Monitors the integrity of the 
Company’s financial statements  
and any other formal announcement 
relating to the Company’s financial 
performance. Reports to the Board 
on significant financial reporting 
issues and judgements contained  
in the financial statements.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
At each quarterly meeting the Committee reviews the Company’s financial statements for the 
purposes of recommending their approval by the Board. The Committee also monitors the 
activities of the Company’s Disclosure Committee and reviews the Company’s quarterly financial 
press releases, which it recommends to the Board for approval. The Committee receives quarterly 
reports from management on:

•  developments in accounting and financial reporting requirements,

•  any new and/or significant accounting treatments/transactions in the quarter, and

•  loss reserving (see page 143 for further details).

An annual paper is also presented that details the areas of judgement or estimation in the 
financial statements (see accounting policies page 94 for detail of these areas). The Committee 
also considers quarterly reports on the financial statements from the external auditors, including 
an interim review report and a year-end audit results report. These are discussed with the 
external auditors at the Committee’s meetings.

Of the areas of judgement or estimation considered by the Committee in 2014, those that were 
considered significant are loss reserving and the valuation of intangible assets. These are explained 
in further detail in the box below. In accordance with auditing guidance, the external auditors’ 
report includes revenue recognition and the estimation of premium revenues as an area of risk. 
The Audit Committee considered this and concluded that for Lancashire revenue recognition  
is straightforward and low risk. While some premiums are subject to estimation, revenues are 
unlikely to be materially different from initial estimates, particularly on a consolidated Group basis.

Reviews the content of the  
Annual Report and Accounts  
and advises the Board on whether, 
taken as a whole, it is fair,  
balanced and understandable. 

The Chairman of the Committee reviews early drafts of the Annual Report and Accounts to  
keep appraised of its key themes and messages and to raise any issues early in the process.  
The Committee reviewed the 2014 Annual Report and Accounts at the February 2015 Audit 
Committee meeting and advised the Board that the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as  
a whole, are fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for 
shareholders to assess the Company’s position and performance, business model and strategy. 

SIGNIFICANT AREAS OF JUDGEMENT OR ESTIMATION 
LOSS RESERVING
As detailed on pages 143 to 146 of the consolidated financial 
statements, the estimation of ultimate loss reserves is a 
complex actuarial process that incorporates a significant 
amount of judgement. The Committee considers the adequacy 
of the Company’s loss reserves at each Audit Committee 
meeting, for which purpose it receives quarterly reports  
from the Company’s Reserving Actuary. Both the Reserving 
Actuary and Ernst & Young LLP (EY) present a comparison  
of Lancashire’s reserves to their own best estimate at the  
Q2 and Q4 Audit Committee meetings. EY also conducts a 
high level review of the Company’s loss reserves as part of their 
Q1 and Q3 review procedures. During 2014, the Committee 
focused its discussions around the Company’s loss reserves on: 
the range of reasonable actuarial estimates and the divergence  
of the Company’s estimates to the external actuarial estimates; 
current and prior year loss development including ‘back-testing’ 
of the Company’s prior year reserves; and reserving for  
each insurance operating subsidiary. Having reviewed and 
challenged these areas, the Committee concurred with 

management’s valuation of the Company’s loss reserves  
and the relevant disclosures around loss reserving in the 
Company’s consolidated financial statements.

INTANGIBLE ASSET VALUATION
The Company has two indefinite life intangible assets 
following the acquisition of Cathedral – goodwill and 
syndicate participation rights. Intangible assets with indefinite 
useful lives are subject to an impairment review at least 
annually or sooner if there is an indication of impairment. 
Some of the key inputs in the impairment review are based  
on management judgement and/or estimation (see page 96  
of the consolidated financial statements for further details). 
These inputs are reviewed by the Audit Committee annually 
and are considered reasonable. The Audit Committee also 
considers the Company’s internal stress tests and what stress 
scenarios would have to occur to indicate an impairment  
of its intangible assets. As a result of these considerations  
the Audit Committee agreed that there was no indication  
of an impairment of the Company’s intangible assets and  
that the valuation of these assets was reasonable.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

53

GOVERNANCE 
COMMITTEE REPORTS CONTINUED

SOLVENCY II

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Monitors developments in the 
Solvency II regime and the progress 
made within the Group in readiness 
for its implementation.

INTERNAL AUDIT

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Monitors and reviews the  
effectiveness of the Group’s  
Internal Audit function in the  
context of the Group’s overall  
risk management system.

EXTERNAL AUDIT

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Oversees the relationship with  
the Group’s external auditors and  
is responsible for assessing annually 
their independence and objectivity, 
taking into account the relevant 
professional and regulatory 
requirements, specifically including:

•  An annual assessment of the 
qualifications, expertise and 
resources of the external  
auditors and the effectiveness  
of the external audit process.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
A quarterly report is provided to the Audit Committee by the CRO detailing the Company’s 
current progress towards meeting its Solvency II requirements. The Group remains on track  
to meet the requirements of the new regime on implementation in 2016.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
The Group’s Internal Audit function reports directly to the Committee. Each year the Head  
of Internal Audit presents an audit plan to the Committee for consideration and approval.  
The key objective of Internal Audit is to audit on at least an annual basis those areas of the 
Group’s business that are deemed to pose the greatest risk to the achievement of the Group’s 
business objectives, and to audit all other areas of the Group’s operations at least once every 
three years. The findings of each internal audit are reported to the Committee at the quarterly 
meetings. The Committee has a responsibility to ensure the timely implementation of agreed 
management actions and to review the status of these at its meetings. 

During 2014, the Committee reviewed and approved an updated Internal Audit Charter. This can 
be viewed on the Company’s website. An external assessment of the effectiveness of the Internal 
Audit function was commissioned by the Committee and was conducted by Deloitte LLP (Deloitte), 
with a report issued to the Committee. The Committee discussed the report and its findings  
with Deloitte and the Head of Internal Audit and noted that no significant issues were raised.  
The Committee concluded that the Internal Audit function is operating effectively and efficiently  
in the context of the Group’s overall risk management system and is adequately resourced.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
The Committee reviews reports from the external auditors at each quarterly Committee meeting 
including the annual audit plan and an ongoing assessment of the effective performance of  
the audit compared to the plan. The Committee Chairman conducts informal meetings with  
the auditors and the CFO prior to, during and after the quarterly audits. The Committee meets 
in executive session with the external auditors and with management at least twice per annum. 

During 2014, a detailed assessment of the effectiveness of the external audit process was  
performed by the Committee Chairman by means of the completion of a detailed questionnaire. 
This included input from the Company’s senior management and the external auditors.  
The review enabled the Audit Committee to determine that the external audit process was 
effective and to note some minor development areas for future audits. Also during 2014, a review 
of EY’s 2013 audit of the Company was completed by the FRC with no significant issues noted.  
The results of this review were discussed by the Committee and minor improvements to the 
external audit process were agreed for future years. 

54 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

EXTERNAL AUDIT CONTINUED

•  The implementation of a policy  

on the supply of non-audit services 
to ensure that the provision of 
non-audit services by the external 
auditors does not impair their 
independence and objectivity. 

•  Making a recommendation to the 
Board, to be put to shareholders  
for approval at the AGM, in relation 
to the appointment, re-appointment 
and removal of the Company’s 
external auditors.

The Committee has approved and adopted a non-audit services policy that is reviewed on an 
annual basis and was last updated in October 2014. The policy, which stipulates rules around 
approvals required for various types of non-audit services, can be found on the Company’s 
website. During 2014, EY provided non-audit services in relation to taxation services, capital 
management projects, Cathedral group restructuring and services pursuant to the KCML 
shareholder and subscription agreement. Fees for non-audit services provided in 2014 totalled 
$0.3 million representing 15.0 per cent of total fees paid to EY. The Committee gave careful 
consideration to the nature of the non-audit services provided and the level of fees charged, and 
has determined that they would not affect the independence and objectivity of EY as auditors.

The Committee has recommended to the Board the re-appointment of EY to perform the  
2015 external audit. EY has been the Group’s external auditors since 2005 and Angus Millar  
has been the lead audit partner since 2012. When making its recommendation to the Board,  
the Committee considered and had regard to EY’s length of tenure and any non-audit services 
provided during the year, and continued to be satisfied with EY’s performance, independence 
and objectivity, level of fees charged, compliance with ethical standards and audit partner 
rotation policy. During 2014, the Board approved a recommendation by the Committee that  
the external audit contract is put out to tender during 2016, which will be during the fifth  
year for the current EY lead audit partner. A recommendation will be made to shareholders  
at the 2017 AGM.

INTERNAL CONTROLS AND RISK MANAGEMENT SYSTEMS

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Reviews the adequacy and 
effectiveness of the Group’s  
internal financial controls and 
internal control and financial  
risk management systems  
(including financial, operational  
and compliance controls).

Reviews for adequacy and security  
of the Company’s ‘whistleblowing’ 
arrangements, procedures for 
detecting fraud and systems and 
controls for the prevention  
of bribery and money laundering.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
The Board has ultimate responsibility for maintaining a robust framework of internal controls 
and risk management and for overseeing and ensuring the effectiveness of the Group’s risk 
management and internal control systems and has delegated the monitoring and review of  
this framework to the Committee. The system of internal control is designed to manage rather 
than eliminate the risk of failure to achieve business objectives, and can only provide reasonable 
and not absolute assurance against material misstatement or loss. The Committee receives an 
annual paper detailing the effectiveness of the Company’s internal controls, which is reviewed 
and discussed by the Committee. This paper covers all material controls including financial, 
operating and compliance controls. In 2014, the Committee was satisfied that the Company’s 
internal control framework was operating effectively.

During 2014, the Committee reviewed and recommended the adoption by the Board of updated 
policies and procedures for anti-money laundering, bribery and financial crime, conflicts  
of interest and whistleblowing. The Committee regularly reviews the Company’s procedures  
for detecting fraud. The Committee also keeps under review the adequacy and effectiveness  
of the Company’s legal and compliance function.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

55

GOVERNANCE 
COMMITTEE REPORTS CONTINUED

INVESTMENT COMMITTEE
“ The focus of the Committee continues  
to be on capital preservation and liquidity  
to support and complement the Group’s 
underwriting operations.”

Elaine Whelan –  
Chairman of the Investment Committee

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
The Investment Committee comprises two Non-Executive Directors 
and one Executive Director (the CFO) together with the Head  
of Investments and Treasury (who is not a Director).

Meetings attended

Elaine Whelan (Chairman)
Peter Clarke
Emma Duncan
Denise O’Donoghue
Former members
Neil McConachie1
Robert Spass2
William Spiegel3

Notes:

4/4
1/2
0/0
4/4

2/2
3/4
3/4

(1) Neil McConachie retired from the Committee on 30 April 2014.

(2) Robert Spass retired from the Committee on 31 December 2014 (see note 8 on page 50).

(3) William Spiegel retired from the Committee on 31 December 2014 (see note 9 on page 50).

PRINCIPAL RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE
•  Recommend investment strategies, guidelines and policies for the 
Board of the Company and operating entities to approve annually.

•  Recommend and set risk asset definitions and risk tolerance  

levels for management to operate within.

•  Recommend the appointment of investment managers to manage 

the Group’s investments.

•  Monitor the performance of the investment strategies against 

pre-defined benchmarks.

•  Establish and monitor compliance with investment operating 

guidelines relating to custody of investments and internal controls.

56 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS 
RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2014
During 2014, the Investment Committee recommended the 
development of a hedge fund portfolio and the appointment  
of hedge fund managers. The Committee also conducted a review 
of the Group portfolio investment managers and recommended  
a reduction in the number of generalist fixed income managers.

The Committee undertook a strategic asset allocation study that 
resulted in recommended changes to the Group asset allocations. 
The Committee also recommended amendments to the definition 
of risk assets, although no changes were proposed to the maximum 
risk asset allocation. 

The Committee considered regular reports on investment 
performance, asset allocation and compliance with pre-defined 
guidelines and tolerances. 

During Q4 2014, the Investment Committee recommended  
to the Board the adoption of the 2015 investment strategy.

PRIORITIES FOR 2015
The Investment Committee will continue to focus upon the 
appropriate balance of risk and return in the implementation  
of the Group’s investment strategy, preserving capital and 
managing its interest rate risk.

NOMINATION AND 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE 
COMMITTEE
“ A particular focus of the Committee during 
2014 has been to ensure that, during a period 
of transition for the management team and  
the Board, the business is refreshed with 
individuals who bring skills, experience and  
a diversity of perspectives and backgrounds.” 

Martin Thomas –  
Chairman of the Nomination and  
Corporate Governance Committee

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
A majority of the members of the Nomination and Corporate 
Governance Committee are independent Non-Executive Directors. 
The Committee Chairman is Martin Thomas who is the Chairman 
of the Board. 

Martin Thomas (Chairman)
Emma Duncan
Samantha Hoe-Richardson
Former members
Ralf Oelssner1
William Spiegel2

Notes:

Meetings attended

8/8
3/3
3/3

1/5
4/5

(1) Ralf Oelssner retired from the Committee on 30 April 2014 (see note 7 on page 50).

(2) William Spiegel retired from the Committee on 5 June 2014 (see note 9 on page 50).

PRINCIPAL RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE
•  Review the structure, size and composition (including the  
skills, knowledge, experience and diversity) of the Board.

•  Consider succession planning for Directors and other  

senior executives.

•  Nominate candidates to fill Board vacancies.

•  Make recommendations to the Board concerning Non-Executive 
Director independence, membership of Committees, suitable 
candidates for the role of Senior Independent Director and  
the re-election of Directors by shareholders.

•  Review the Company’s corporate governance arrangements  

and compliance.

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS 
RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2014
BOARD COMPOSITION
The Committee reviewed the composition of the Board, with 
particular focus on the Non-Executive Directors, to ensure that  
the balance of skills, experience and diversity continued to be 
appropriate for the Group’s business to meet the strategic objectives. 
The Committee also considered whether any additional skills and 
experience would be needed, either to complement those already 
on the Board, or to plan for filling vacancies due to the retirement 
of Directors.

The Committee recommended changes to the composition  
of the Board Committees during the year. It also recommended 
Simon Fraser for the role of Senior Independent Director upon 
the retirement of Ralf Oelssner at the 2014 AGM.

SUCCESSION PLANNING
The Committee reviewed the Company’s succession plan for 
Executive Directors and other senior executives, taking into 
account the Company’s risk environment and strategic objectives  
as well as the anticipated demands of the business. The Committee 
also recommended the appointment of Paul Gregory as Group 
Chief Underwriting Officer following the promotion of Alex 
Maloney to Group Chief Executive Officer.

APPOINTMENT OF DIRECTORS
Peter Clarke and Tom Milligan were considered by the Committee 
and recommended to the Board for appointment as new  
Non-Executive Directors. In each case, the recruitment process  
was initiated by the Committee and, as part of that process, the 
Company engaged Odgers Berndtson (an executive search firm 
with no other connection to the Lancashire Group), who identified 
a number of potential candidates. Both Directors have received  
a tailored induction programme led by the Company Secretary.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

57

GOVERNANCE 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
The Committee keeps under review the Company’s corporate 
governance, particularly compliance with the Code, and is 
responsible for making recommendations to the Board concerning 
the process for conducting and facilitating the annual performance 
evaluation of the Board, its Committees and its individual  
Directors – see page 50. 

During 2014, the Committee recommended the adoption by  
the Board of revised Terms of Reference for the Audit Committee, 
the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee and  
the Remuneration Committee. It also recommended the approval  
by the Board of an amended Schedule of Reserved Matters and  
an updated protocol for the division of responsibilities and roles  
of the Chairman and Group CEO and the responsibilities and 
reporting lines of the CEOs of Group subsidiaries.

The Committee recommended approval by the Board of an 
updated statement on the representation of women on the  
Board, on executive committees and in senior management.  
This is published on the Company’s website. In the context of  
the Davies Report, the Committee recognises the benefits that  
a broad diversity of skills, experience and gender, amongst other 
factors, brings to enhance Board performance but considers  
that quotas are not the best option for achieving diversity. 

The Committee considered statistics relevant to the gender 
composition of the Board, Group management excluding  
Non-Executive Directors, and overall Lancashire Group employees. 
These statistics are shown opposite.

THE LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION
Flowing from the review of the Committee’s Terms of Reference, 
the Committee assumed responsibility for monitoring and making 
recommendations to the Board in relation to the Company’s 
charitable giving policy and the operation of, and reporting 
requirements for, the Lancashire Foundation.

PRIORITIES FOR 2015
The priority for the Nomination and Corporate Governance 
Committee for 2015 will be a continued focus on succession 
planning and to support management in the development  
of talent planning within the business, to ensure that the Board 
benefits from the skills and expertise of a diverse and independent 
team of Non-Executive Directors. 

COMMITTEE REPORTS CONTINUED

LHL BOARD MEMBERS

Female: 3

Male: 6

GROUP MANAGEMENT EXCLUDING 
LHL NON-EXECUTIVE BOARD DIRECTORS

Female: 4

Male: 16

OVERALL LANCASHIRE GROUP EMPLOYEES

Female: 68

Male: 124

* As at 31 December 2014.

58 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

UNDERWRITING  
AND UNDERWRITING 
RISK COMMITTEE
“ The Committee is an important forum  
for discussing and setting the right 
underwriting risk appetites. It also monitors 
the Company’s underwriting performance 
against the risk tolerances.”

Alex Maloney –  
Chairman of the Underwriting  
and Underwriting Risk Committee

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
The Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee comprises one 
Executive Director (the Group CEO) together with the Group CUO, 
the CUO of LICL, the CUO and Reinsurance Manager of LUK and 
the Head of Capital Modeling (who are not Directors).

Meetings attended

Alex Maloney (Chairman)
Paul Gregory
Hayley Johnston
Sylvain Perrier
Ben Readdy
Former members
John Bishop1
Richard Brindle1
Ralf Oelssner1

Note:

4/4
4/4
1/1
4/4
4/4

2/2
1/2
0/2

(1)  John Bishop, Richard Brindle and Ralf Oelssner all retired from the Committee on 30 April 2014  

(see notes 1, 7 and 10 on page 50).

PRINCIPAL RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE
•  Formulate Group underwriting strategy.

•  Oversee the development of, and adherence to, underwriting 

guidelines by operating company CUOs.

•  Review underwriting performance.

•  Review significant changes in underwriting rules and policies.

•  Establish, review and maintain strict underwriting criteria and limits.

•  Monitor underwriting risk and its consistency with Lancashire’s 

risk profile and risk appetite.

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS 
RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2014
Underwriting risk is one of the key risks faced by the Company,  
and the Committee is actively engaged in the development of strategy 
and underwriting risk tolerances, which are approved by the Board. 
The Committee also monitors underwriting performance on a 
quarterly basis. In what has been a challenging ratings environment, 
Lancashire continues to prioritise good risk selection first and 
foremost, and the portfolio mix since inception has been relatively 
stable. The soft market has presented opportunities for the business 
to increase its reinsurance purchasing thereby de-risking the 
portfolio. The strategic underwriting priority for the business is to 
service the needs of clients and their brokers and thereby build a core 
book of business capable of sustaining a relevant and viable operation 
over the insurance cycle. During 2014, the Cathedral platform has 
afforded opportunities for new lines of business within the Lloyd’s 
market through the build out of Syndicate 3010. The Committee  
has also received regular reports on the progress made in the 
development of the Kinesis platform during 2014. The Committee 
receives quarterly reports of significant claims to the business.

During 2014, the Committee meetings were open to attendance  
by all the Board members and provided a useful forum for the 
discussion of underwriting performance, risk tolerances and strategic 
initiatives. The Committee and Board place great importance on  
the management of the Company’s capital so as to match capital  
to the underwriting requirements of the business. 

A more detailed analysis of the Lancashire underwriting performance 
appears in the Business Review section of this Annual Report at pages 
24 to 32.

PRIORITIES FOR 2015
For the coming year the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk 
Committee will continue to monitor the development of a forward-
looking and disciplined underwriting strategy appropriate for  
the Group’s three underwriting platforms, within a framework  
of appropriate risk tolerances.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

59

GOVERNANCE 
COMMITTEE REPORTS CONTINUED

REMUNERATION 
COMMITTEE
“The Committee seeks to align the interests  
of the Company’s owners with those of its senior 
executives. Our remuneration policy affords 
financial rewards which are closely linked  
to performance.”

Simon Fraser –  
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
The Remuneration Committee comprises three independent 
Non-Executive Directors.

Simon Fraser (Chairman)
Peter Clarke
Emma Duncan
Former members
Ralf Oelssner1
William Spiegel2

Notes:

Meetings attended

6/6
0/0 
6/6

0/4
5/6

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS 
RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2014
During 2014, the Committee approved the terms of the retirement 
arrangements for Richard Brindle, the former Group CEO.  
The Committee also approved the remuneration packages for  
Alex Maloney as the new Group CEO and for Paul Gregory as  
the new Group CUO.

The Committee considered the salary and bonus awards for 2014  
for Executive Directors and other designated senior executives.  
The Committee also approved the grant of awards under the 
Company’s restricted share scheme.

(1) Ralf Oelssner retired from the Committee on 30 April 2014 (see note 7 on page 50).

(2) William Spiegel retired from the Committee on 31 December 2014 (see note 9 on page 50).

The Committee approved revised share ownership guidelines for 
senior and key executives. 

PRINCIPAL RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE
•  Set the remuneration policy for the Company’s Chairman, the 
Executive Directors, Company Secretary and other designated 
senior executives, to deliver long-term benefits to the Company.

•  Determine the total individual remuneration package, including 

pension arrangements, of the Company’s Chairman, the Executive 
Directors and other designated senior executives.

•  Agree personal objectives for each Executive Director and the 
related performance and pay-out metrics for the performance 
element of the annual bonus.

•  Determine each year whether awards will be made under the 

Company’s restricted share scheme and, if so, the overall amount 
of such awards, the individual awards to Executive Directors and 
other designated senior executives, and the performance targets 
to be used.

•  Ensure that contractual terms on termination, and any payments 

made, are fair to the individual and the Company.

•  Oversee any major changes in employee benefit structures 

throughout the Group.

The Committee also reviewed the policy for Executive Director 
remuneration which was approved by shareholders at the 2014 AGM. 
The Committee considers the policy fit for purpose and does not 
propose any amendments for the 2015 AGM.

The Directors’ Remuneration Policy and the Annual Report on 
Remuneration for which the Committee is responsible can be found 
on pages 61 to 78.

The Committee’s Terms of Reference were amended on 4 November 
2014 to include provisions for the Committee’s oversight and 
approval of performance objectives for Executive Directors and the 
related metrics for the performance element of the annual bonus.

PRIORITIES FOR 2015
During the coming year the Remuneration Committee, working 
with management, will undertake a review of incentivisation 
packages throughout the Group to ensure that remuneration  
is structured appropriately to promote the long-term success of  
the Company. This is expected to involve a degree of standardisation 
across the Group as Catherdral is integrated fully. The RSS 
structure for Executive Directors will also be reviewed to ensure 
that the performance metrics continue to align the interests  
of the Company, its investors and management.

60 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT 

ANNUAL STATEMENT 
Dear Shareholder, 

I am pleased to present my first Directors’ Remuneration Report to 
shareholders following my appointment to chair the Remuneration 
Committee on 30 April 2014.  

As a company incorporated in Bermuda, Lancashire is not bound by UK 
law or regulation in the area of Directors’ remuneration to the same 
extent that it applies to UK incorporated companies. However, by virtue  
of the Company’s premium listing on the London Stock Exchange and 
reflecting the Committee’s approach to good governance, shareholders 
were given the opportunity to approve our remuneration policy at the 
2014 AGM and we were grateful for the support of over 90 per cent of  
our shareholders. We are not proposing any changes to our remuneration 
policy but for convenience we have reproduced the policy on pages  
62 to 65. 

REMUNERATION AND STRATEGY 
Lancashire’s goal continues to be to reward its employees fairly and 
responsibly, by providing an appropriate balance between fixed and 
variable remuneration, linked to the achievement of suitably challenging 
Group and individual performance measures.  

There is a strong link between the remuneration policy and the  
business strategy. As highlighted at the front of this Annual Report, our 
strategy focuses on the effective operation of the business necessary to 
maximise long-term and sustainable RoE and the delivery of superior  
total shareholder returns. Our remuneration policy is closely aligned  
to this strategy.  

PERFORMANCE OUTCOME FOR 2014 
The Lancashire Group has delivered solid results in a challenging market 
for 2014 (see the performance review of this report on pages 70 to 74).  

Against a background of challenging market conditions there was a 
significant reduction between 2013 and 2014 in the total remuneration 
for our CEO and CFO (see the comparison table for single figure 
remuneration on page 69). This resulted in part from a lower RoE  
than was achieved in 2013 and a disappointing total shareholder  
return of -24.2 per cent for the year (see page 21 for further details).  

The annual bonus was focused on both absolute RoE and relative RoE 
and also on individual objectives. Executive Directors’ performance targets 
set at the beginning of 2014 for financial performance were stretching, 
and reflecting the Company's 2014 performance were achieved at about 
target level (and at or below 53 per cent of maximum bonus). Executive 
Directors’ 2014 bonuses are expected to pay between 100 per cent and 
106 per cent of target. Due to the large number of warrants outstanding, 
and the potentially volatile impact on the annual bonus performance 
metrics and the fact that the warrants are no longer owned by employees, 
the Committee decided at the beginning of the year that for the annual 
bonus performance targets for both the absolute and relative elements 
there should be an adjustment for the impact of warrant exercises. 
Accordingly the warrant adjusted RoE used for purposes of the absolute 
RoE metric is 14.7 per cent which represents an uplift of 0.8 per cent  
on the 2014 actual RoE of 13.9 per cent. For full details of Executive 
Directors’ bonuses and the associated performance delivered see page 71. 

In relation to long-term incentives, the 2012 Performance RSS awards 
were half based on absolute RoE targets and half on relative TSR against 
other peers over the three year period to 31 December 2014. Our TSR 
performance (in USD) over this period ranked the Company below the 
median of the designated peer group of 11 companies, resulting in no 
vesting for the TSR component. This, in part, was a reflection of the  
out-performance of the Company’s share price relative to its peer group 
comparator companies in 2011, with a high base point resulting in a 
weaker TSR performance by comparison to peers during the relevant 
three year period. 

Our average RoE performance over this period was 16.5 per cent  
against a threshold target of the 13 week Treasury bill rate plus 6 per cent, 
resulting in 100 per cent of the RoE component of the 2012 Performance 
RSS award vesting, a total vesting of 50 per cent of awards. This compared 
to the 100 per cent vesting of the 2011 RSS Performance awards, which  
we reported last year.  

The total remuneration received by our current directors in 2014 was 
significantly lower than what was received in 2013 and this demonstrates 
the Committee's key principles of setting challenging performance  
criteria and having a significant proportion of the overall package linked 
to Company performance. The like for like employee costs at Lancashire 
(excluding the costs of the Lloyd’s segment, but including the cost of the 
retirement package for Richard Brindle) were $1.3 million lower in  
2014 (see page 29 for further detail). 

Overall, in light of the annual and three-year performance delivered,  
the Committee is satisfied that there has been a robust link between 
performance and reward. 

CHANGES TO THE EXECUTIVE BOARD 
As detailed in the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee 
report, at the 2014 AGM, there was a change in Chief Executive as  
Richard Brindle retired and Alex Maloney was promoted from his 
previous role as the Group's Chief Underwriting Officer. 

As specified in his contract, Richard Brindle received payments 
comprising salary, benefits and pension in lieu of his notice period, and a 
pro-rata bonus for the period he was employed in 2014. In consideration 
of his decision to retire and his significant contribution to the foundation 
and management of Lancashire since its incorporation in 2005, the 
Committee decided to treat him as a good leaver under the rules of the 
annual bonus and Restricted Share Scheme. Full details of his termination 
payments are set out in the Annual Report on Remuneration on page 72. 

APPLICATION OF REMUNERATION POLICY FOR 2015 
Since my appointment, the Remuneration Committee has reviewed the 
policy approved by shareholders and considers it to remain fit for purpose. 
That said we have taken on board shareholder comments expressed at the 
last AGM and have made a number of changes in the way we will operate 
our policy for 2015. 

  The policy includes a share ownership guideline requiring the CEO 
to build and maintain a holding of two times his salary and for other 
Directors to have shares worth one times salary. The Committee  
has revisited the share ownership guideline and tightened up the 
definition of ownership. Going forward, only wholly-owned shares or 
vested entitlements to shares will count whereas previously unvested 
deferred bonus awards were included. This will strengthen the 
alignment between management and shareholders. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

61 
61

GOVERNANCE 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

  The Committee is cognisant of the need to set remuneration at a 

level which is sufficiently attractive to incentivise the best talent in a 
very competitive industry but at the same time to ensure that reward 
is not excessive by market and shareholder standards. In this regard, 
it should be noted that we have set the new Chief Executive's pay  
at a level which is significantly lower than his predecessor. See  
page 77 for further details.  

  The minimum and maximum absolute RoE targets (adjusted for 
warrant exercises) attached to our annual bonus plan have been  
left unchanged despite the increased likelihood of a softer market  
in 2015. The target pay-out has been reduced from 12 per cent to  
11 per cent to reflect the market outlook.  

The final section of this report is the Annual Report on Remuneration 
which provides detailed disclosure on how the policy will be implemented 
for 2015 and how Directors have been paid in relation to 2014.  

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION POLICY SECTION 
This part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report sets out the 
Remuneration Policy for the Company. The policy has been developed 
taking into account the principles of the Code and the views of our 
major shareholders. The policy was voted into effect from the date  
of the 2014 AGM and is currently intended to operate until the  
AGM in 2017.  

Although not required by the regulations, the substantive terms of  
the Remuneration Policy are reproduced below for ease of reference. 
However, any details that were specific to 2014 or earlier years 
(including, for example, the disclosure of the illustrative remuneration 
scenarios) have been updated where applicable. The policy table has 
been updated to incorporate the change to the share ownership 
guideline as set out in the Annual Statement. The full Policy Report 
approved by the Company's shareholders at last year's AGM can be 
accessed in the 2013 Annual Report on the Company's website.  

GOVERNANCE AND APPROACH 
The Company's Remuneration Policy is geared towards providing a 
level of remuneration which attracts, retains and motivates Executive 
Directors of the highest calibre to further the Company's interests and 
to optimise long-term shareholder value creation, within appropriate 
risk parameters. The Remuneration Policy also seeks to ensure that 
Executive Directors are provided with appropriate incentives to drive 
individual performance and to reward them fairly for their 
contribution to the successful performance of the Company. 

The Remuneration Committee and the Board have considered 
whether any element of the current Remuneration Policy could 
conceivably encourage Executive Directors to take inappropriate risks 
and have concluded that this is not the case, given the following: 

  there is an appropriate balance between fixed and variable pay, and 
therefore Executive Directors are not required to earn performance 
related pay to maintain their day-to-day living expenses; 

  there is a blend of short-term and long-term performance metrics 
with an appropriate mix of performance conditions, meaning that 
there is no undue focus on any one particular metric; 

62 
62 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

The disclosures provide shareholders with the information necessary to 
form a judgement as to the link between Company performance and 
how the Executive Directors are paid. This Annual Statement together 
with the Annual Report on Remuneration will be subject to an advisory 
vote and I hope that you will be able to support the resolution at the 
forthcoming AGM. 

The Committee is committed to maintaining an open and constructive 
dialogue with our shareholders on remuneration matters and I 
welcome any feedback you may have. The Committee has committed 
to a full review of Group compensation for 2016 to include all  
Group Companies. 

SIMON FRASER 
CHAIRMAN OF THE REMUNERATION COMMITTEE 

  there is a high level of share ownership amongst Executive  

Directors, meaning that there is a strong focus on sustainable  
long-term shareholder value; and 

  the Company has the power to claw back bonuses (including the 
deferred element of the annual bonus) and long-term incentive 
payments made to Executive Directors in the event of material 
misstatements in the Company’s financial statements, error in the 
calculation of any performance condition, or the Executive Director 
ceasing to be a Director and/or employee due to gross misconduct. 

HOW THE VIEWS OF SHAREHOLDERS ARE TAKEN  
INTO ACCOUNT 
The Committee Chairman and, where appropriate, the Company 
Chairman, will consult with major investors and representative  
bodies on any significant remuneration proposal relating to Executive 
Directors. Views of shareholders at the AGM and feedback received  
at other times will be considered by the Committee.  

HOW THE VIEWS OF EMPLOYEES ARE TAKEN  
INTO ACCOUNT 
The Remuneration Committee takes into account levels of pay 
elsewhere in the Group when determining the pay levels for Executive 
Directors. The Remuneration Policy for all staff is, in principle, the 
same as that for Executive Directors in that all employees are offered 
similarly structured packages, with participation in annual bonus  
and long-term incentive plans. For Executive Directors with higher 
remuneration levels, a higher proportion of the compensation  
package is subject to performance pay, share based remuneration and 
deferral. This ensures that there is a strong link between remuneration, 
Company performance and the interests of shareholders. 

The Company does not consult with employees on Executive  
Directors’ remuneration. However, as noted above, the Committee  
is made aware of pay structures across the wider Group when setting 
the Remuneration Policy for Executive Directors.  

 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

  The Committee is cognisant of the need to set remuneration at a 

The disclosures provide shareholders with the information necessary to 

level which is sufficiently attractive to incentivise the best talent in a 

form a judgement as to the link between Company performance and 

very competitive industry but at the same time to ensure that reward 

how the Executive Directors are paid. This Annual Statement together 

is not excessive by market and shareholder standards. In this regard, 

with the Annual Report on Remuneration will be subject to an advisory 

it should be noted that we have set the new Chief Executive's pay  

vote and I hope that you will be able to support the resolution at the 

at a level which is significantly lower than his predecessor. See  

forthcoming AGM. 

page 77 for further details.  

  The minimum and maximum absolute RoE targets (adjusted for 

dialogue with our shareholders on remuneration matters and I 

warrant exercises) attached to our annual bonus plan have been  

welcome any feedback you may have. The Committee has committed 

left unchanged despite the increased likelihood of a softer market  

to a full review of Group compensation for 2016 to include all  

The Committee is committed to maintaining an open and constructive 

in 2015. The target pay-out has been reduced from 12 per cent to  

Group Companies. 

11 per cent to reflect the market outlook.  

The final section of this report is the Annual Report on Remuneration 

which provides detailed disclosure on how the policy will be implemented 

SIMON FRASER 

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION POLICY SECTION 

This part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report sets out the 

  there is a high level of share ownership amongst Executive  

Remuneration Policy for the Company. The policy has been developed 

Directors, meaning that there is a strong focus on sustainable  

taking into account the principles of the Code and the views of our 

long-term shareholder value; and 

major shareholders. The policy was voted into effect from the date  

of the 2014 AGM and is currently intended to operate until the  

AGM in 2017.  

  the Company has the power to claw back bonuses (including the 

deferred element of the annual bonus) and long-term incentive 

payments made to Executive Directors in the event of material 

Although not required by the regulations, the substantive terms of  

misstatements in the Company’s financial statements, error in the 

the Remuneration Policy are reproduced below for ease of reference. 

calculation of any performance condition, or the Executive Director 

However, any details that were specific to 2014 or earlier years 

ceasing to be a Director and/or employee due to gross misconduct. 

(including, for example, the disclosure of the illustrative remuneration 

been updated to incorporate the change to the share ownership 

guideline as set out in the Annual Statement. The full Policy Report 

approved by the Company's shareholders at last year's AGM can be 

accessed in the 2013 Annual Report on the Company's website.  

GOVERNANCE AND APPROACH 

The Company's Remuneration Policy is geared towards providing a 

INTO ACCOUNT 

The Committee Chairman and, where appropriate, the Company 

Chairman, will consult with major investors and representative  

bodies on any significant remuneration proposal relating to Executive 

Directors. Views of shareholders at the AGM and feedback received  

at other times will be considered by the Committee.  

level of remuneration which attracts, retains and motivates Executive 

HOW THE VIEWS OF EMPLOYEES ARE TAKEN  

Directors of the highest calibre to further the Company's interests and 

INTO ACCOUNT 

to optimise long-term shareholder value creation, within appropriate 

risk parameters. The Remuneration Policy also seeks to ensure that 

Executive Directors are provided with appropriate incentives to drive 

individual performance and to reward them fairly for their 

contribution to the successful performance of the Company. 

The Remuneration Committee and the Board have considered 

whether any element of the current Remuneration Policy could 

conceivably encourage Executive Directors to take inappropriate risks 

and have concluded that this is not the case, given the following: 

  there is an appropriate balance between fixed and variable pay, and 

therefore Executive Directors are not required to earn performance 

related pay to maintain their day-to-day living expenses; 

  there is a blend of short-term and long-term performance metrics 

with an appropriate mix of performance conditions, meaning that 

there is no undue focus on any one particular metric; 

62 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

The Remuneration Committee takes into account levels of pay 

elsewhere in the Group when determining the pay levels for Executive 

Directors. The Remuneration Policy for all staff is, in principle, the 

same as that for Executive Directors in that all employees are offered 

similarly structured packages, with participation in annual bonus  

and long-term incentive plans. For Executive Directors with higher 

remuneration levels, a higher proportion of the compensation  

package is subject to performance pay, share based remuneration and 

deferral. This ensures that there is a strong link between remuneration, 

Company performance and the interests of shareholders. 

The Company does not consult with employees on Executive  

Directors’ remuneration. However, as noted above, the Committee  

is made aware of pay structures across the wider Group when setting 

the Remuneration Policy for Executive Directors.  

POLICY TABLE 
Base Salary 

Purpose and Link to Strategy 

Helps recruit, motivate and retain high-calibre Executive Directors by offering salaries at market competitive levels.  

Operation  

Reflects individual experience and role. 

Reviewed annually and fixed for 12 months, effective from 1 January. Positioning and annual increases influenced by: 
  role, experience and performance; 
  change in broader workforce salary; and 
  changes in responsibility or position. 
Salaries are benchmarked periodically against insurance company peers in the UK and in Bermuda. 

Opportunity 

No maximum. 

Benefits 

for 2015 and how Directors have been paid in relation to 2014.  

CHAIRMAN OF THE REMUNERATION COMMITTEE 

Purpose and Link to Strategy 

Market competitive structure to support recruitment and retention.  

scenarios) have been updated where applicable. The policy table has 

HOW THE VIEWS OF SHAREHOLDERS ARE TAKEN  

Opportunity 

Company contribution is currently 10 per cent of base salary. 

Medical cover aims to ensure minimal business interruption as a result of illness. 

Operation  

Executive Directors are entitled to healthcare, dental, vision, gym membership and life insurance. Executive Directors  
who are expatriates may be eligible for a housing allowance or other relocation-related expenses. 

Opportunity 

No maximum. 

Pension 

Purpose and Link to Strategy 

Contribution towards funding post-retirement lifestyle. 

Operation  

The Company operates a defined contribution pension scheme (via outsourced pension providers) or cash-in-lieu of  
pension where contributions would exceed HMRC pension limits in the UK. 

There is a salary sacrifice structure in the UK. 

There is the opportunity for additional voluntary contributions to be made by individuals, if elected. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

63 
63

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

POLICY TABLE CONTINUED 
Annual Bonus1,2 

Purpose and Link to Strategy 

Rewards the achievement of financial and personal targets. 

Operation 

Bonus targets (percentage of salary) are based on mechanistic calculations for financial and personal performance. 

The precise weightings may differ each year, although there will be a greater focus on financial as opposed to  
personal performance. 

The Committee, based upon input from the CEO, will have the ability to override the results of any mechanistic bonus 
calculation to either increase or decrease the amount payable (subject to the cap) to ensure a robust link between reward 
and performance. 

At least 25 per cent of each Executive Director’s bonus is automatically deferred into shares as nil cost options over three 
years, with one third vesting each subsequent year. 

A dividend equivalent provision operates enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on unvested deferred bonus 
shares in the form of nil cost options up to the point of exercise. 

If Lancashire’s comprehensive income in the relevant full financial year should be negative, there will be no pay-out  
possible under the Relative Financial Performance element (details of the bonus metrics are included on page 68 of the 
Annual Report). 

The bonus is subject to claw back if the financial statements of the Company were materially misstated or an error  
occurred in assessing the performance conditions on bonus and/or if the Executive ceased to be a Director or employee  
due to gross misconduct. 

Opportunity3 

Bonus for achieving target level of performance as a percentage of salary is: 
  CEO – 200 per cent 
  CUO – 175 per cent (note this is not currently an Executive Director position) 
  CFO – 150 per cent 
Maximum opportunity is two times target. 

Note for 2015: The Committee may set bonus opportunities less than the amounts set out above – see Implementation  
of Policy section of the Annual Report on Remuneration.  

Performance Metrics 

Financial Performance 

The financial component is based on the Company's key financial measures of performance. For any year, these may  
include RoE, growth in BVS, combined ratio, investment return or any other financial KPI4. 

A sliding scale of targets applies for financial performance targets. Bonus is earned on an incremental basis once a 
predetermined threshold level is achieved. 25 per cent of the total bonus opportunity is payable for achieving 
threshold/median rising to maximum bonus for stretch/upper quartile performance. 

The degree of stretch in targets may vary each year depending on the business aims and the broader economic or industry 
environment at the start of the relevant year. 

Personal Performance 

Personal performance is based upon achievement of clearly articulated objectives. A performance rating is attributed to 
participating Executive Directors, which determines the pay-out for this part of the bonus. 

The weightings applying to the bonus measures and the degree of stretch in objectives may vary each year depending on 
the business aims and the broader economic or industry environment at the start of the relevant year. For Executive 
Directors, the financial component will have a higher weighting than the personal element. 

64 
64 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

POLICY TABLE CONTINUED 

Annual Bonus1,2 

Long Term Incentives (LTI) 

Purpose and Link to Strategy 

Rewards Executive Directors for achieving superior returns for shareholders over a longer-term timeframe. 

Purpose and Link to Strategy 

Rewards the achievement of financial and personal targets. 

Operation 

Bonus targets (percentage of salary) are based on mechanistic calculations for financial and personal performance. 

Operation2,4 

The precise weightings may differ each year, although there will be a greater focus on financial as opposed to  

personal performance. 

and performance. 

The Committee, based upon input from the CEO, will have the ability to override the results of any mechanistic bonus 

calculation to either increase or decrease the amount payable (subject to the cap) to ensure a robust link between reward 

At least 25 per cent of each Executive Director’s bonus is automatically deferred into shares as nil cost options over three 

years, with one third vesting each subsequent year. 

A dividend equivalent provision operates enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on unvested deferred bonus 

shares in the form of nil cost options up to the point of exercise. 

If Lancashire’s comprehensive income in the relevant full financial year should be negative, there will be no pay-out  

possible under the Relative Financial Performance element (details of the bonus metrics are included on page 68 of the 

Enables Executive Directors to build a meaningful shareholding over time and align goals with shareholders. 

RSS awards are made annually in the form of nil cost options with vesting dependent on the achievement of performance 
conditions over at least three financial years, commencing with the year of grant. This three year period is longer than  
the typical pattern of loss reserve development on the Group’s insurance business, which is approximately two years. 

The number of awards will normally be determined by reference to the share price at 1 January in the year of grant unless 
the Committee at its discretion determines otherwise. 

The Remuneration Committee considers carefully the quantum of awards each year to ensure that they are competitive 
in light of peer practice and the targets set. 

Awards are subject to claw back if there is a material misstatement in the Company’s financial statements, an error in  
the calculation of any performance conditions or if the Executive Director ceases to be a Director or employee due to  
gross misconduct. 

A dividend equivalent provision operates enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on RSS awards up to the  
point of exercise. 

Opportunity 

Award levels are determined primarily by seniority. A maximum individual grant limit of 350 per cent of salary applies.  

The bonus is subject to claw back if the financial statements of the Company were materially misstated or an error  

occurred in assessing the performance conditions on bonus and/or if the Executive ceased to be a Director or employee  

Performance Metrics  

Note for 2015: The Committee may set bonus opportunities less than the amounts set out above – see Implementation  

Share Ownership Guidelines5 

Awards vest at the end of a three year performance period based on performance measures reflecting the long-term 
strategy of the business at the time of grant.  
These may include measures such as TSR, RoE/BVS, Company profitability or any other relevant financial measures1. 

If more than one measure is used, the Committee will review the weightings between the measures chosen and the  
target ranges prior to each LTI grant to ensure that the overall balance and level of stretch remains appropriate. 

A sliding scale of targets applies for financial metrics with no more than 25 per cent vesting at threshold performance. 

For TSR, none of this part of the award will vest below median ranking and full vesting will require upper quartile 
performance or better. Awards vest on a proportionate basis for performance between the median and upper quartiles. 

Under the guidelines, the CEO is expected to maintain an interest equivalent in value to no less than two times salary over time. For other Executive Directors 
the threshold is one times salary. Until such time as the guideline threshold is achieved Executive Directors are required to retain no less than 50 per cent of  
the net of tax value of awards that vest under the RSS. 

Chairman and Non-Executive Directors’ (NEDs) fees 

Purpose and Link to Strategy 

Helps recruit, motivate and retain a Chairman and Non-Executive Directors of a high calibre by offering a market 
competitive fee level. 

Operation 

The Chairman is paid a fee for his responsibilities as Chairman and also receives a separate fee for his position as  
Chairman of LUK. The level of these fees is reviewed periodically by the Committee and the CEO by reference to broadly 
comparable businesses in terms of size and operations. 

In general, the Non-Executive Directors are paid a single fee for all responsibilities, although supplemental fees may be 
payable where additional responsibilities are undertaken. 

Opportunity 

Notes  

No maximum. 

(1)  The Committee operates the annual bonus plan and RSS according to their respective rules and in accordance with the Listing Rules. The Committee, consistent with normal market practice, retains discretion over a number  

of areas relating to the operation and administration of these plans and this discretion forms part of this policy. 

(2)  All historic awards that were granted under any current or previous share schemes operated by the Company but remain outstanding remain eligible to vest based on their original award terms and this provision forms part  

of the policy. 

(3)  The target bonuses set at the 2014 AGM in this policy were based on the incumbents in the roles at the time.  

(4) Performance Measures; these may include the performance indicators shown on pages 20 to 21 or others described within the Annual Report Glossary commencing on page 160. 

(5)  Share Ownership interest equivalent is defined as wholly owned shares or fully vested rights over shares; since November 2014 unvested annual RSS bonus awards do not count towards share ownership. 

Annual Report). 

due to gross misconduct. 

  CEO – 200 per cent 

  CFO – 150 per cent 

Opportunity3 

Bonus for achieving target level of performance as a percentage of salary is: 

  CUO – 175 per cent (note this is not currently an Executive Director position) 

Maximum opportunity is two times target. 

of Policy section of the Annual Report on Remuneration.  

Performance Metrics 

Financial Performance 

The financial component is based on the Company's key financial measures of performance. For any year, these may  

include RoE, growth in BVS, combined ratio, investment return or any other financial KPI4. 

A sliding scale of targets applies for financial performance targets. Bonus is earned on an incremental basis once a 

predetermined threshold level is achieved. 25 per cent of the total bonus opportunity is payable for achieving 

threshold/median rising to maximum bonus for stretch/upper quartile performance. 

The degree of stretch in targets may vary each year depending on the business aims and the broader economic or industry 

environment at the start of the relevant year. 

Personal Performance 

Personal performance is based upon achievement of clearly articulated objectives. A performance rating is attributed to 

participating Executive Directors, which determines the pay-out for this part of the bonus. 

The weightings applying to the bonus measures and the degree of stretch in objectives may vary each year depending on 

the business aims and the broader economic or industry environment at the start of the relevant year. For Executive 

Directors, the financial component will have a higher weighting than the personal element. 

64 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

65 
65

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

ILLUSTRATIONS OF ANNUAL APPLICATION OF REMUNERATION POLICY 
The charts below show the potential total remuneration opportunities for the Executive Directors in 2015 at different levels of performance  
under the policy. 

)

M
$
(

N
O
I
T
A
S
N
E
P
M
O
C
L
A
T
O
T

6

5

4

3

2

1

0

5.30

40%

44%

16%

3.08

34%

38%

28%

0.86

100%

2.21

33%

36%

31%

0.68

100%

3.73

39%

43%

18%

Fixed pay

On-target

Maximum

Fixed pay

On-target

Maximum

CEO

CFO

Fixed pay

Annual bonus

LTI Awards (RSS)

Fixed pay = 2015 Salary + Actual value of 2014 Benefits + 2015 Pension Contribution. 

On-target = Fixed Pay + Target Bonus (being half the Maximum Bonus Opportunity) + Target Value of 2015 RSS grant  
(assuming 50 per cent vesting with face values of 275 per cent and 276 per cent of salary for the CEO and CFO respectively).  

Maximum = Fixed Pay + Maximum Bonus Opportunity + Maximum Value of 2015 RSS grant (assuming 100 per cent vesting  
shown as the face value of grant). 

No account has been taken of any share price growth or dividend equivalents accrual. 

APPROACH TO RECRUITMENT REMUNERATION 
The remuneration package for a new Executive Director would be set in accordance with the terms of the Company’s prevailing approved 
Remuneration Policy at the time of appointment and take into account the skills and experience of the individual, the market rate for  
a candidate of that experience and the importance of securing the relevant individual. 

Salary would be provided at such a level as is required to attract the most appropriate candidate. The annual bonus and LTI potential would be  
in line with the Policy. In addition, the Committee may offer additional cash and/or share based elements to replace deferred or incentive pay 
forfeited by an executive leaving a previous employer. It would seek to ensure, where possible, that these awards would be consistent with awards 
forfeited in terms of vesting periods, expected value and performance conditions. 

For an internal Executive Director appointment, any variable pay element awarded in respect of the prior role may be allowed to pay out 
according to its terms, adjusted as relevant to take into account the appointment. In addition, any other ongoing remuneration obligations 
existing prior to appointment may continue.  

The Committee may agree that the Company will meet certain relocation expenses as appropriate. 

SERVICE CONTRACTS AND LOSS OF OFFICE PAYMENT POLICY FOR EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS 
Executive Directors have service contracts with six month notice periods. In the event of termination, the Executive Directors’ contracts  
provide for compensation up to a maximum of base salary plus the value of benefits to which the Executive Directors are contractually entitled  
for the unexpired portion of the notice period. No Executive Director has a contractual right to a bonus for any period of notice not worked.  

The Company seeks to apply the principle of mitigation in the payment of compensation on the termination of the service contract of any 
Executive Director. There are no special provisions in the service contracts for payments to Executive Directors on a change of control of  
the Company. 

66 
66 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
In the event of an exit of an Executive Director, the overriding principle will be to honour contractual remuneration entitlements and  
determine on an equitable basis the appropriate treatment of deferred and performance linked elements of the package, taking account  
of the circumstances. Failure will not be rewarded. 

Depending on the leaver classification, an Executive Director may be eligible for certain payments or benefits continuation after cessation  
of employment. 

If an Executive Director resigns or is summarily dismissed, salary, pension and benefits will cease on the last day of employment and there will  
be no further payments. 

LEAVER ON ARRANGED TERMS OR GOOD LEAVER 
If an Executive Director leaves on agreed terms, including compassionate circumstances, there may be payments after cessation of employment. 
Salary, pension and benefits will be paid up to the length of the agreed notice period or agreed period of gardening leave.  

Subject to performance, a bonus may be payable at the discretion of the Committee pro-rata for the portion of the financial year worked.  

Vested but unexercised deferred bonus shares will remain exercisable. Unvested deferred bonus shares will ordinarily vest in full, relative to  
the normal vesting period. All such vested awards must be exercised within 12 months of the vesting date. The Committee has discretion to  
permit such unvested awards to vest early rather than continue on the normal vesting timetable and also retains discretion, acting fairly and 
reasonably, as to whether or not to apply (or to apply to a lesser extent) the pro-rata reduction to the bonus shares where it feels the reduction 
would be inappropriate. 

Vested but unexercised RSS awards may remain exercisable for 12 months. Unvested awards may vest on the normal vesting date unless the 
Committee determines that such awards shall instead vest at the time of cessation. Unvested awards will only vest to the extent that the 
performance conditions have been satisfied (over the full or curtailed period as relevant). A pro-rata reduction in the size of awards may apply, 
based upon the period of time after the grant date and ending on the date of cessation of employment relative to the three year vesting period.  

Depending upon circumstances, the Committee may consider other payments in respect of an unfair dismissal award, outplacement support  
and assistance with legal fees. 

TERMS OF APPOINTMENT FOR NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS  
The Non-Executive Directors serve subject to the Company’s Bye-laws and under letters of appointment. They are appointed subject to  
re-election at the AGM and are also terminable by either party on six months’ notice except in the event of earlier termination in accordance  
with the Bye-laws. The Non-Executive Directors are typically expected to serve for up to six years, although the Board may invite a Non-Executive 
Director to serve for an additional period. Their letters of appointment are available for inspection at the Company’s registered office and at each 
AGM. The Company encourages share ownership by the Non-Executive Chairman and Non-Executive Directors, and Non-Executive Directors 
who do not own shares are encouraged to use a proportion of their fees to buy shares in the Company and retain such shareholdings for their 
remaining periods of office. 

In accordance with best practice under the Code, the Board proposes to submit the Directors individually for re-election by the shareholders at 
the 2015 AGM.  

ANNUAL REPORT ON REMUNERATION  
This Annual Report on Remuneration together with the Chairman’s Annual Statement, as detailed on page 44 will be subject to an advisory  
vote at the 2015 AGM. The information on page 69 with respect to Directors’ Emoluments and onwards through page 78 has been audited.  

IMPLEMENTATION OF REMUNERATION POLICY FOR 2015 
In relation to the Policy described in the previous section, the following table sets out additional disclosure on the expected application of the 
Policy for 2015. 

BASE SALARY AND FEES 
Executive Directors 
Increases and resulting salaries effective from 1 January 2015 are set out below: 

  CEO – the incoming CEO’s salary was set at $750,000 upon his promotion to CEO on 1 May 2014 and this was significantly lower than his 

predecessor's salary. The CEO's salary for 2015 was increased by 3 per cent to $772,500. 

  CFO – salary increased by 3 per cent to $530,450. 

  For 2015, increases of 3 per cent are in line with the salary increases across the general workforce population. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

67 
67

GOVERNANCE 
  
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

IMPLEMENTATION OF REMUNERATION POLICY FOR 2015 CONTINUED 
Non-Executives 
The Chairman's and Non-Executive Directors' fees remain the same for 2015: 

  The fee for the Chairman is $325,000 per annum and the additional fee for the Chairman of LUK is $100,000. 

  The Non-Executive Director fee is $175,000 per annum.  

ANNUAL BONUS 
For 2015, the CEO will have a target bonus of 150 per cent of salary and, therefore, a maximum opportunity of 300 per cent of salary which is 
within the approved policy limit and represents a 100 per cent of salary maximum opportunity reduction compared with the previous CEO.  
This lower bonus opportunity is driven off a significantly lower salary than the previous CEO's (as highlighted above). The CFO's target bonus 
opportunity will be in line with the policy at 150 per cent of salary (maximum 300 per cent). 

As for 2014, the 2015 bonus will be based 75 per cent on financial performance and 25 per cent on personal performance.  

Financial Performance (75 per cent) 
The Company's most important financial KPI is Return on Equity which is the core indicator of the delivery of our strategic priorities of ensuring 
strong underwriting, effectively balancing risk and return and managing capital nimbly through the insurance cycle (see the strategic overview  
on pages 14 and 15 of this report). Accordingly, for 2015, the financial component comprises two parts – 60 per cent of this element is based on 
the performance of the Group’s absolute RoE (measured as the internal rate of return of the change in the fully converted book value per share 
or ‘FCBVS’) plus dividends accrued and 40 per cent is based on the Group's relative RoE performance against appropriate peer companies  
(peer companies can be located on page 75). The RoE is to be adjusted for the effect of warrant exercises during the year.  

  Absolute RoE: 

A sliding scale range of RoE targets is set with 25 per cent of bonus payable if the threshold level of increase in RoE is achieved (being 9 per 
cent), rising to 100 per cent of bonus target being payable for target growth in RoE of 11 per cent and 200 per cent of bonus target being 
payable for achieving the maximum RoE growth target of 19 per cent or higher. There is linear interpolation between these points. The Board 
considers that these target ranges are appropriately challenging in a difficult market and that the stretch target of 19 per cent would represent 
exceptional performance in the current market, but without encouraging excessive risk taking. 

  Relative RoE:  

Relative performance will be measured against an identified comparator group of companies which can be seen on page 75. Vesting will be 
based on performance against a sliding scale with no vesting for below median performance, 25 per cent payable for achieving a median 
ranking, and up to 100 per cent for upper quartile or better. Vesting for performance in between the median and upper quartiles is determined 
on a proportionate basis. 

Personal Performance (25 per cent) 
This element of the bonus plan is based upon individual achievement of clearly articulated objectives created at the beginning of each year.  
The Committee has chosen not to disclose the personal performance objectives in advance as it considers them to be commercially sensitive.  
As in previous years there will be broad disclosure retrospectively in the 2015 Annual Report on Remuneration. 

RESTRICTED SHARE SCHEME 
Performance Conditions 
2015 RSS awards are subject to RoE and relative TSR performance conditions. These metrics were chosen as RoE provides a focus on the 
Company's underlying financial performance and cycle management, and relative TSR provides an objective reward for stock market 
performance against the Company’s peers. 

Weighting  
For 2015, the TSR/RoE weighting is 25 per cent on TSR and 75 per cent on RoE. 

Target ranges  
The RoE target range for 2015 awards is unchanged from the previous year: 

  threshold – average RoE compared to the 13 week Treasury bill rate + 6 per cent; 

  maximum – average RoE compared to the 13 week Treasury bill rate + 15 per cent; and 

  none of the award will vest if RoE is below threshold, 25 per cent of the award will vest at threshold, and 100 per cent of the award will vest at 

maximum. Performance between threshold and maximum is determined on a straight-line basis. 

  The Board and Committee consider that given current market conditions the stretch target represents exceptional and consistent cross cycle 
out-performance above the Group’s stated strategic cross-cycle return of risk free plus 13 per cent. The target range closely aligns the longer 
term remuneration of our Executive Directors with consistent out-performance and the interests of our shareholders, but is not so stretching as 
to encourage excessive risk taking. 

68 
68 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

TSR target for 2015 awards: 

Lancashire’s TSR is compared against a comparator group comprising 11 peer companies as disclosed on page 75. 

  0 per cent will vest for a below median ranking; 
  25 per cent of the award will vest if Lancashire’s performance is at the median; and  
  100 per cent will vest for upper quartile and above performance. 
  vesting will be on a proportionate basis for performance between median and upper quartile. 

Award levels 
The CEO’s RSS award level is less than his predecessor’s. 2015 RSS award levels are as follows: 

  CEO – 244,208 shares (275 per cent of salary); 
  CFO – 168,149 shares (276 per cent of salary). 

The number of shares awarded was determined based on the share price at 1 January 2015. 

SINGLE FIGURE ON REMUNERATION 
The following table presents the Executive Directors’ emoluments in U.S. Dollars in respect of the year ended 31 December 2014. 

Executive Directors  

Alex Maloney4,5, CEO 

Elaine Whelan4, CFO 

Richard Brindle4,8, Former CEO 

Salary
$ 

Pension
$ 

Taxable    
Benefits1,6
$    

Annual Bonus7
$  

Long-Term    
 Incentives    
 (RSS)2,3 
$    

2014 

2013 

2014 

2013 

2014 

2013 

675,181

453,534

518,117

499,865

368,576

1,110,226

78,573

86,830

51,500

50,000

36,858

111,023

9,620  

1,115,918 

1,205,919   

13,279  

1,366,703 

4,065,805   

95,738  

772,390 

474,119   

107,913  

1,158,675 

1,399,685   

7,127  

1,180,355 

4,690,533   

644,914 

6,928,363 

29,476  

3,541,067 

5,383,381   

– 

10,175,173 

Other9
$  

– 

– 

– 

– 

Total4
$  

3,085,211 

5,986,151 

1,911,864 

3,216,138 

(1)  Benefits comprise Bermudian payroll taxes, social insurance, medical, dental and vision coverage and housing and other allowances paid by the Company for expatriates (as is the case for the CFO), but exclude UK National 

Insurance contributions. 

(2)  For 2014, the long-term incentive values are based on the 2012 RSS awards which vest at 50 per cent on 12 February 2015 and are based on a 3 year performance period that ended on 31 December 2014. The values are based 

on the share price at 31 December 2014 and include the value of dividends accrued on vested shares. 

(3)  For 2013, the long-term incentive values are based on the 2011 RSS awards which vested at 100 per cent on 13 February 2014 and are based on a 3 year performance period that ended on 31 December 2013. The values include 

dividends that have accrued on vested shares. 

(4) Some amounts were paid in pounds sterling and converted at the average exchange rate for the year of 1.6544. 

(5)  Alex Maloney's base salary and pension reflect his UK salary sacrifice pension contributions arrangement and are calculated at 4 months in his post as CUO (at an annual rate of $515,000) and 8 months as CEO (at an annual 

rate of $750,000). 

(6)  Elaine Whelan’s taxable benefits have been restated to reflect the Bermudian payroll tax and social insurance portion that she received in 2013 and 2014, which was paid by the Company and considered an employee benefit. 

All employees in Bermuda are eligible for this benefit. 

(7)  For 2014 the Lancashire Group delivered solid results in a challenging market. Bonus targets were set at the beginning of 2014 and based on a clear split between Company financial performance and personal performance on a 
75:25 (70:30 for the CFO in 2013) basis. Company financial performance had two components, absolute financial performance and relative financial performance weighted 60:40 respectively. The absolute component paid out 
at 138.86 per cent of target as the warrant adjusted RoE was 14.7 per cent against a warrant adjusted budget of 9.9 per cent and the relative component is provisionally cited at 0 per cent pending the final audited results of 
peer companies needed in order to calculate the final bonus payable. For the personal element of Executive Directors’ bonus opportunity the pay-out ranged from 86 per cent to 75 per cent of the maximum. For full details 
 of Executive Directors’ bonuses and the associated performance delivered see pages 70 and 71. 

(8) Richard Brindle retired from the Group and as a Director on 30 April 2014. Mr Brindle was afforded good leaver status and all RSS award interests were agreed to vest upon his departure using estimated TSR and RoE values at 

the time of his retirement. The amounts in the table above reflect all awards vesting in 2014. Further particulars of the vesting appear on page 72. 

(9) For 2014 this includes all payments made to Mr Brindle in lieu of his six month notice period and converted at the exchange rate of 1.6885 as at 30 April 2014. Further particulars of the vesting appear on page 72. 

NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS’ FEES 

Current Non-Executive Directors 

Peter Clarke1 

Emma Duncan 

Simon Fraser 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson 

Martin Thomas 

2014
2013

2014

2013

2014

2013

2014

2013

2014

2013

Fee  
$ 

Other 
$ 

Total 
$ 

98,077 
– 

175,000 

 175,000  

175,000 

 27,178  

175,000 

 150,096  

–
–

–

–

–

–

–

–

98,077
–

175,000

 175,000 

175,000

 27,178 

175,000

 150,096 

325,000 

100,000

425,000

 325,000  

 100,000 

 425,000 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

69 
69

GOVERNANCE 
  
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS’ FEES CONTINUED 

Former Non-Executive Directors 

John Bishop2 

Neil McConachie2 

Ralf Oelssner2 

Robert Spass3 

William Spiegel3 

Fee  
$ 

Other 
$ 

58,333 

 175,000  

58,333 

 175,000  

–

–

–

–

Total 
$ 

58,333

 175,000 

58,333

 175,000 

58,333 

10,000

68,333

 175,000  

 56,000 

 231,000 

175,000 

 175,000  

175,000 

 175,000  

–

–

–

–

175,000

 175,000 

175,000

 175,000

2014

2013

2014

2013

2014

2013

2014

2013

2014

2013

(1)  Peter Clarke was appointed as a Non-Executive Director with effect from 9 June 2014.  

(2)  John Bishop, Neil McConachie, and Ralph Oelssner retired from the Board on 30 April 2014 and were not proposed for re-election at the 2014 AGM.  

(3)  Robert Spass and William Spiegel retired from the Board on 31 December 2014. 

2015 ANNUAL BONUS PAYMENTS IN RESPECT OF 2014 PERFORMANCE 
As detailed in the Policy Report, each Executive Director participates in the annual bonus plan, under which performance is measured over a 
single financial year.  

The target value of bonus is 150 per cent of salary for the current CEO (it was 175 per cent for the period between 1 January 2014 to 30 April 
2014, during his time as Group CUO) and CFO respectively, and the maximum payable was two times the target value. The warrant adjusted  
RoE is 14.7 per cent, which reflects the total impact of warrants of 0.8 per cent on the actual 2014 RoE of 13.9 per cent. In setting the annual 
bonus RoE targets for 2014 the Committee agreed that the effect of warrant exercises should be excluded for annual bonus purposes due to  
the large number of warrants outstanding and potential volatile impact on the annual bonus performance metrics. 

FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE 
75 per cent of the 2014 bonus was based on Company performance conditions and the extent to which they were achieved is as follows:  

Performance Measures 

Absolute RoE 

Relative RoE 

Total 

Weighting  
(of total Company 
 element of 75%) 
% 

60 

40 

Threshold
% 

9

50

Target
% 

12

N/A

Max
% 

19

75

Actual 
performance 
% 

14.7 

0 

100 
(75 per cent of Total Bonus) 

% vesting 

138.86 of Target

0 of Target

83.3 of Target payable in respect 
of Company performance

For 2014, the Lancashire Group delivered solid results in a challenging market. The absolute component paid out at 138.86 per cent of target as 
the warrant adjusted RoE was 14.7 per cent against a warrant adjusted target of 9.9 per cent and the relative component against the results of  
peer companies is provisionally stated below median (0 per cent pay out) pending the final audited results of peer companies needed in order  
to calculate the final bonus payable. 

PERSONAL PERFORMANCE 
25 per cent of the 2014 bonus was based on performance against clearly defined personal objectives set at the start of the year.  

The table below sets out a summary of the 2014 personal objectives for each Executive Director. 

Executive Director 

Personal Performance 

Alex Maloney 

Effective leadership and management of the senior executive team and Group. 

Development of the general business strategy. 

Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Values. 

Elaine Whelan 

Effective leadership and management of the finance function and the Bermuda office. 

Development of the general business strategy. 

Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Values. 

70 
70 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
The personal targets were broadly common among the Executive Directors, with variances being attributable to the specifics of their respective 
roles and the perceived need for areas of personal development within their fields of expertise to be emphasised. 

During the 2014 annual performance reviews of each Executive Director, a performance rating was assigned to determine the level of bonus pay-
out each Executive Director was eligible for.  

As expected for a solid performance year in a challenging market, the Executive Directors each achieved a high performance rating against  
their objectives. For the 2014 performance against personal objectives the following ratings were determined, expressed as a percentage of the 
maximum award for personal performance: CEO – 86 per cent, and CFO – 75 per cent.  

A table of performance measures and total 2014 bonus achievement is set out below:  

Executive Director 

Alex Maloney3 

Elaine Whelan 

Richard Brindle4 

Financial 
performance
 (max % of
 total bonus)
% 

Personal 
performance 
(max % of 
total bonus)
% 

Bonus
% of maximum 
awarded 
for 2014
% 

Total1  
bonus value  
$  

Value of bonus 
paid in cash
 (75 per cent of 
total bonus)
$ 

Value of bonus  
 deferred into RSS  
 (25 per cent of   
total bonus)2
$   

75

75

75

25

25

25

53

50

77

1,115,918 

836,938

278,980  

772,390 

579,292

193,098  

1,180,355 

1,180,355

0  

(1)  For 2014 the Lancashire Group delivered solid results in a challenging market. Bonus targets were set at the beginning of 2014 and based on a clear split between Company financial performance and personal performance on a 
75:25 (70:30 for the CFO in 2013) basis. Company financial performance had two components, absolute financial performance and relative financial performance weighted 60:40 respectively. The absolute component paid  
out at 138.86 per cent of target as the warrant adjusted RoE was 14.7 per cent against a warrant adjusted budget of 9.9 per cent and the relative component is provisionally cited at 0 per cent pending the final audited results 
of peer companies needed in order to calculate the final bonus payable. For the personal element of Executive Directors’ bonus opportunity the pay-out ranged from 86 per cent to 75 per cent of the maximum. For full details 
of Executive Directors’ bonuses and the associated performance delivered see page 70. 

(2)  25 per cent of total bonus award will be deferred into Lancashire shares with one third vesting annually, each year, over a three-year period with the first third becoming exercisable in February 2016, subject to the Company 

being in an ‘open period’. These awards vest on the relevant dates subject to continued employment only. 

(3)  Alex Maloney had a split role in 2014 and his bonus was calculated based on 4 months in his former role of CUO and 8 months of the year in his role as CEO. 

(4) Richard Brindle retired from the Company effective 30 April 2014. Mr Brindle’s annual bonus award was evaluated at the time of his retirement, and his 2013 performance was used as a proxy for the calculation of the 2014 

bonus element and pro-rated for his time in office. Mr Brindle’s total bonus payment was made in cash with no element deferred into RSS.  

LONG-TERM SHARE AWARDS WITH PERFORMANCE PERIODS ENDING IN THE YEAR – 2012 RSS AWARD 
The 2012 RSS awards are based on a three year performance period ending on 31 December 2014 and vest following the determination of 
financial results by the Board. The tables below set out the achievement against the performance conditions attached to the award, resulting in 
aggregate vesting of 50 per cent, and the actual number of awards vesting (with their estimated value). 

Performance level 

Below threshold 

Threshold 

Stretch or above 

Actual achieved 

TSR  
(relative to a comparator group of 11 companies) 

Average annual RoE  
(over 3 years in excess of 13 Week Treasury Bill Rate) 

Performance required 

% vesting 

Performance required (%) 

% vesting 

Below median

Median

Upper quartile or above

0

25

100

0

Below 6

6

15 or above

16.5

0

25

100

100

Details of the performance RSS awards granted on 28 February 2012 and 4 May 2012 with a performance period of 1 January 2012 – 31 December 
2014 vesting for each Director, based on the above vesting, are shown in the table below: 

Executive3 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan  

Number of 
shares at grant 

Number of
 shares to lapse 

Number of  
shares to vest 

Dividend accrual  
on vested shares  
value2 
$  

Value of shares 
 including dividend 
 accrual1
$  

187,165

73,586

93,582

36,793

93,583 

36,793 

391,837 

1,205,919

154,055 

474,119

(1)  The value of the vested shares is based on the share price on the date of vesting, being $8.69 (based on the exchange rate of 1.5534) on 31 December 2014. The vested awards are subject to the claw back provision set out  

on page 65.  

(2)  Dividends accrue on awards at the date of a dividend payment and upon exercise the cash value of the accrued dividends is paid to the employee on the number of vested awards. 

(3) Details of Mr Brindle's award can be found in the Payments for Loss of Office section. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

71 
71

GOVERNANCE 
  
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

SCHEME INTERESTS AWARDED DURING THE YEAR 
The table below sets out the performance RSS share awards that were granted as nil-cost options on 19 February 2014.  

Executive 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan 

Richard Brindle 

Number of awards  
granted during  
the year 

Grant Date2 

Face value    
of awards   
 granted during    
the year1,3
$    

% vesting 
at threshold 
performance 

19 February 2014 

 124,333  

1,523,328    

19 February 2014 

 102,989  

1,261,821   

19 February 2014 

207,938 

2,547,656   

25

25

25

(1)  The share price on the date of performance awards grant was $12.25, when the RSS share awards were granted as nil-cost options. 

(2)  These awards are due to vest subject to performance conditions being met at the end of the performance period ending 31 December 2016 and becoming exercisable after the meeting of the Board in February 2017. 

(3)  The exercise share price is determined once an award has vested on the basis of the share price on the date an award is exercised. 

LOSS OF OFFICE PAYMENTS 
RETIREMENT ARRANGEMENTS FOR RICHARD BRINDLE 
Richard Brindle retired from the Group as a Director on 30 April 2014 (the “departure date”), being the date his employment ceased and the 
date he relinquished his Executive Director responsibilities, although restrictive covenants based on those in his service contracts remained in 
effect. The details of Mr Brindle’s retirement arrangements are included in the section below, as previously set forth in the FAQs on the Company 
website since 2 June 2014. As part of the terms of his retirement arrangements, Mr Brindle was paid the GBP equivalent (after the deduction  
of income tax and employee's national insurance contributions) of:  

  $572,887 salary in lieu of his entitlement to six months' notice as specified in his employment contract. 

  $57,289 in respect of his entitlement to pension contribution during the notice period. 

  $14,738 in respect of his entitlement to benefits during the notice period. 

  $1,180,355 being the pro-rated bonus for the period he was employed in 2014. The bonus amount was calculated based on the Committee’s 

assessment of the extent to which the performance targets had been met for which it used as a proxy Mr Brindle’s 2013 annual bonus  
(which was then pro-rated to the period of the year under review worked). Mr Brindle did not receive a performance rating in 2014 as he  
was no longer an Executive Director at the end of the evaluation period. 

  The Company also provided assistance with legal and advisor fees, paying the advisor firms directly. The amounts paid are below a de  

minimis threshold. 

Mr Brindle also held interests in RSS awards. As a retiring CEO and in recognition of Mr Brindle’s significant contribution as a founder of the 
Company, the Remuneration Committee agreed that Mr Brindle should be treated as a good leaver and that awards should not be prorated for 
time but should be subject to performance conditions, where relevant. Accordingly, and in line with the plan rules: 

  176,654 vested but unexercised RSS awards and vested but unexercised Deferred Bonus RSS awards were exercisable for 12 months following 

his departure date. 

  132,643 unvested Deferred Bonus RSS awards were released in full on the departure date. 

  668,910 outstanding Performance RSS awards vested early on the departure date and were tested for performance at that date. The relative  
TSR condition was measured up to the departure date and the RoE condition was based on the first quarter RoE for 2014 and projected for  
the rest of that financial year. The future years of vesting conditions were based on the Company’s internal projected budget. Details of the  
TSR and RoE targets for Performance RSS can be found on page 75. Accordingly, awards vested as follows: 

–  120,132 vested under the 2012 award –  0 per cent for the TSR element, 100 per cent for RoE; overall vesting of 50 per cent 

–  156,556 vested under the 2013 award –  0 per cent for the TSR element, 94.6 per cent for RoE; overall vesting of 70.9 per cent 

–  129,442 vested under the 2014 award –  0 per cent for the TSR element, 83.0 per cent for RoE; overall vesting of 62.3 per cent 

Dividend equivalents up to the departure date have accrued to Mr Brindle on vested awards. 

72 
72 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
LEAVING ARRANGEMENTS FOR NEIL MCCONACHIE 
Neil McConachie was an Executive Director in 2012 until he resigned from his Executive Director position and remained in a Non-Executive 
Director capacity with the Company. No awards were made to Mr McConachie in his capacity as a Non-Executive Director. At its meeting held  
on 4 February 2014 the Remuneration Committee decided that in light of Mr McConachie’s decision to resign from the Board as a Non-Executive 
Director at the 2014 AGM, it was appropriate to afford him ‘good leaver’ status for all vested and unvested RSS awards, subject to a non-compete 
requirement, to vest on the usual vesting date with no pro-rata calculation applied. His fees for 2014 are disclosed on page 70 and he did not 
receive any payment for loss of office.  

OTHER LEAVING ARRANGEMENTS 
John Bishop and Ralph Oelssner retired from the Board effective from the 2014 AGM and Robert Spass and William Spiegel retired from the  
Board on 31 December 2014. Their fees are disclosed on page 70 and no retiring Non-Executive Director received any payment for loss of office.  

DETAILS OF ALL OUTSTANDING SHARE AWARDS 
In addition to awards made during the 2014 financial year, the table below sets out details of all outstanding RSS awards held by Directors. 

PERFORMANCE AND DEFERRED BONUS AWARDS UNDER THE NIL-COST OPTION RESTRICTED SHARE SCHEME (RSS) 

Grant date1 

Exercise 
price 

Awards held 
at 1-Jan-14 

Awards 
granted 
during the 
period 

Awards vested 
during the 
period 

Awards lapsed 
during the 
period 

Awards 
exercised 
during the 
period  

Awards
 held at 
31-Dec-14 

End of 
performance 
period 

 236,198

 187,165 

 8,969 

 131,969 

 17,543 

 –

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 124,333 

 29,430 

 236,198

 – 

4,484

 – 

5,847

 – 

 – 

 – 

 –  

 –  

 –  

 –  

 –  

 –  

 236,198 

– 31-Dec-13

 –  

 187,165  31-Dec-14

4,484 

 4,485 

 –  

 131,969  31-Dec-15

5,848 

 11,695 

 –  

 –  

 124,333  31-Dec-16

 29,430 

 581,844 

 153,763 

246,529

–   246,530 

 489,077 

Alex Maloney, Group 
CEO 

Performance RSS 

Performance RSS  

Total 

Elaine Whelan, 
Group CFO  
& LICL CEO 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS  

Performance RSS  

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS  

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS – 
Interim 

Performance RSS 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

24-Feb-11 

28-Feb-12 

5-Mar-12 

28-Feb-13 

5-Mar-13 

19-Feb-14 

5-Mar-14 

25-Mar-10 

24-Feb-11 

24-Feb-11 

28-Feb-12 

5-Mar-12 

4-May-12 

28-Feb-13 

5-Mar-13 

19-Feb-14 

5-Mar-14 

–

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

– 

–

–

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

45,581

81,313

3,005

 48,586 

 12,897 

 25,000 

 116,087 

 15,120 

–

–

–

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

102,989 

 23,956 

–

81,313

–

 – 

 5,159 

 – 

 – 

 5,040 

 – 

 – 

Total 

 347,589 

 126,945 

91,512

– 

– 

– 

 –  

 –  

 –  

 –  

 –  

 –  

 –  

– 

45,581 

81,313 

3,005 

– 31-Dec-12

– 31-Dec-13

–

 –  

 48,586  31-Dec-14

7,738 

 5,159 

 –  

 25,000  31-Dec-14

 –  

 116,087  31-Dec-15

5,040  

 10,080 

 –  

–  

 102,989  31-Dec-16

 23,956   

142,677 

 331,857   

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

73 
73

GOVERNANCE 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

PERFORMANCE AND DEFERRED BONUS AWARDS UNDER THE NIL-COST OPTION RESTRICTED SHARE SCHEME (RSS) CONTINUED 

Former Directors 

Richard Brindle6, 
Former Group CEO 

Performance RSS  

Performance RSS7  

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS8 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS9 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS 

Performance RSS 

Deferred bonus RSS5 

Deferred bonus RSS5 

Neil McConachie10, 
Former Non-Executive 
Director 

Grant date1 

Exercise 
price 

Awards held 
at 1-Jan-14 

Awards 
granted 
during the 
period 

Awards vested 
during the 
period 

Awards lapsed 
during the 
period 

Awards 
exercised 
during the 
period  

Awards
 held at 
30-Apr-14 

End of 
performance 
period 

24-Feb-11  

28-Feb-12  

5-Mar-12  

28-Feb-13  

5-Mar-13  

19-Feb-14  

5-Mar-14  

24-Feb-11  

28-Feb-12  

5-Mar-12  

5-Mar-13  

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

– 

– 

– 

– 

312,741

 –  

176,655 

136,086 31-Dec-13 

120,132

120,131  

 – 

 120,132 31-Dec-14 

312,741

240,263

43,414

220,709

56,584

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

43,414

 –  

156,556

64,153  

56,584

 –  

 – 

 – 

207,938

129,442

78,496  

73,213

73,213

 –  

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

 43,414  

 156,556  31-Dec-15 

 56,584  

129,442  

73,213  

873,711

281,151

892,082

262,780 

176,655 

715,427  

261,994

146,833

17,257

7,664

433,748

– 

– 

– 

– 

–

261,994

– 

8,628

2,555

273,177

–  

–  

–  

–  

– 

–  

–  

–  

–  

– 

261,994 31-Dec-13 

146,833 31-Dec-14 

17,257

7,664

433,748

(1)  The market values of the common shares on the dates of grant were: 

(4) The vesting dates of the RSS mainstream awards are subject to being out of a close period and, for the  

  25 March 2010 £4.86 

  24 February 2011 £6.00 

  28 February 2012 £7.90 

  5 March 2012 £7.58  

  4 May 2012 £7.99  

  28 February 2013 £9.09 

  5 March 2013 £9.08 

  19 February 2014 £7.34 

  5 March 2014 £7.26 

2010 to 2014 performance awards, are as follows: 

  2010 – 21 February 2013;  

  2011 – 13 February 2014; 

  2012 – 12 February 2015; 

(2)  The vesting of the RSS performance awards prior to 2013 grants is subject to two performance conditions as 

  2013 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2015 year-end results; and 

follows:  

  Half of each award is subject to a performance condition measuring the TSR performance of the 

Company against the TSR performance of a select group of comparator companies (see page 75 for a list 
of comparator companies for each grant year), over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this 
half of the award vests for median performance by the Company, rising to 100 per cent vesting of this 
half of the award for upper quartile performance by the Company or better (with proportionate vesting 
between these two points). 

  The other half of each award is subject to a performance condition based on average annual RoE over a 
three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this half of the award will vest if average annual RoE over 
the performance period exceeds the criteria set out in the table on page 75, whilst all of this part of the 
award will vest if the Company’s average RoE is equal to the more stringent criteria set out in the table 
on page 75. Between these two points vesting will take place on a straight-line basis from 25 per cent to 
100 per cent for RoE performance. 

(3)  The vesting of the RSS performance awards from 2013 grants forward is subject to two performance 

conditions as follows:  

  25 per cent of each award is subject to a performance condition measuring the TSR performance of the 

Company against the TSR performance of a select group of comparator companies (see page 75 for a list 
of comparator companies for each grant year), over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this 
half of the award vests for median performance by the Company, rising to 100 per cent vesting of this 
half of the award for upper quartile performance by the Company or better (with proportionate vesting 
between these two points). 

  The other 75 per cent of each award is subject to a performance condition based on average annual RoE 
over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this half of the award will vest if average annual 
RoE over the performance period exceeds the criteria set out in the table on page 75, whilst all of this 
part of the award will vest if the Company’s average RoE is equal to the more stringent criteria set out  
in the table on page 75. Between these two points vesting will take place on a straight-line basis from  
25 per cent to 100 per cent for RoE performance.  

  2014 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2016 year-end results. 

(5)  The vesting dates of the RSS Deferred Bonus awards are subject to being out of a close period and, for the 

2012 to 2014 Deferred Bonus awards, are as follows: 

  2012 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three year period at the first open period following the release of the 

Company’s year-end results 2012, 2013 and 2014; 

  2013 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three year period at the first open period following the release of the 

Company’s year-end results 2013, 2014 and 2015; and 

  2014 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three year period at the first open period following the release of the 

Company’s year-end results 2014, 2015 and 2016. 

(6)  Richard Brindle retired from the Group and as a Director on 30 April 2014. Mr Brindle was afforded good 
leaver status and all RSS award interests were agreed to vest upon his departure using estimated TSR and 
RoE values at the time of his retirement. The amounts in the table above reflect all awards vesting in 2014. 
Further particulars of the vesting appear on page 72. 

(7)  Mr Brindle’s 2012 performance award was vested in line with the plan rules using estimated TSR and RoE 
values at the time of his retirement. Vesting was based on 0 per cent vesting for the TSR element and 100 
per cent for the RoE element; an overall vesting of 50 per cent.  

(8) Mr Brindle’s 2013 performance award was vested in line with the plan rules using estimated TSR and RoE 
values at the time of his retirement. Vesting was based on 0 per cent vesting for the TSR element and  
94.6 per cent for the RoE element; an overall vesting of 70.9 per cent.  

(9)  Mr Brindle’s 2014 performance award was vested in line with the plan rules using estimated TSR and RoE 
values at the time of his retirement. Vesting was based on 0 per cent vesting for the TSR element and  
83 per cent for the RoE element; an overall vesting of 62.3 per cent. 

(10) Neil McConachie was an Executive Director until 30 June 2012. No awards have been made to Mr 

McConachie in his capacity as a Non-Executive Director. At its meeting held on 4 February 2014 the 
Remuneration Committee decided that in light of Mr McConachie’s decision to resign from the Board  
as a Non-Executive Director at the 2014 AGM, it was appropriate to afford him ‘good leaver’ status for  
all vested and unvested RSS awards, subject to a non-compete requirement. Pro-ration remains subject  
to a final determination by the Remuneration Committee. 

74 
74 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

Former Directors 

Grant date1 

price 

at 1-Jan-14 

period 

period 

period 

period  

30-Apr-14 

period 

Exercise 

Awards held 

during the 

during the 

during the 

Awards 

granted 

Awards vested 

Awards lapsed 

Awards 

exercised 

during the 

Awards

 held at 

End of 

performance 

Richard Brindle6, 

Performance RSS  

Former Group CEO 

Performance RSS7  

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS8 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Performance RSS9 

Deferred Bonus RSS5 

Neil McConachie10, 

Performance RSS 

Former Non-Executive 

Performance RSS 

Director 

Deferred bonus RSS5 

Deferred bonus RSS5 

24-Feb-11  

28-Feb-12  

5-Mar-12  

28-Feb-13  

5-Mar-13  

19-Feb-14  

5-Mar-14  

24-Feb-11  

28-Feb-12  

5-Mar-12  

5-Mar-13  

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

– 

– 

– 

– 

312,741

240,263

43,414

220,709

56,584

 – 

 – 

261,994

146,833

17,257

7,664

433,748

207,938

129,442

78,496  

73,213

73,213

873,711

281,151

892,082

262,780 

176,655 

715,427  

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

– 

– 

– 

– 

–

43,414

56,584

261,994

– 

8,628

2,555

273,177

312,741

 –  

176,655 

136,086 31-Dec-13 

120,132

120,131  

 – 

 120,132 31-Dec-14 

156,556

64,153  

 156,556  31-Dec-15 

 –  

 –  

 –  

–  

–  

–  

–  

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

–  

–  

–  

–  

– 

 43,414  

 56,584  

129,442  

73,213  

261,994 31-Dec-13 

146,833 31-Dec-14 

17,257

7,664

433,748

(1)  The market values of the common shares on the dates of grant were: 

(4) The vesting dates of the RSS mainstream awards are subject to being out of a close period and, for the  

  25 March 2010 £4.86 

  24 February 2011 £6.00 

  28 February 2012 £7.90 

  5 March 2012 £7.58  

  4 May 2012 £7.99  

  28 February 2013 £9.09 

  5 March 2013 £9.08 

  19 February 2014 £7.34 

  5 March 2014 £7.26 

2010 to 2014 performance awards, are as follows: 

  2010 – 21 February 2013;  

  2011 – 13 February 2014; 

  2012 – 12 February 2015; 

(2)  The vesting of the RSS performance awards prior to 2013 grants is subject to two performance conditions as 

  2013 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2015 year-end results; and 

follows:  

  Half of each award is subject to a performance condition measuring the TSR performance of the 

Company against the TSR performance of a select group of comparator companies (see page 75 for a list 

of comparator companies for each grant year), over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this 

half of the award vests for median performance by the Company, rising to 100 per cent vesting of this 

half of the award for upper quartile performance by the Company or better (with proportionate vesting 

between these two points). 

  The other half of each award is subject to a performance condition based on average annual RoE over a 

three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this half of the award will vest if average annual RoE over 

the performance period exceeds the criteria set out in the table on page 75, whilst all of this part of the 

  2014 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2016 year-end results. 

(5)  The vesting dates of the RSS Deferred Bonus awards are subject to being out of a close period and, for the 

2012 to 2014 Deferred Bonus awards, are as follows: 

  2012 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three year period at the first open period following the release of the 

Company’s year-end results 2012, 2013 and 2014; 

  2013 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three year period at the first open period following the release of the 

Company’s year-end results 2013, 2014 and 2015; and 

  2014 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three year period at the first open period following the release of the 

Company’s year-end results 2014, 2015 and 2016. 

award will vest if the Company’s average RoE is equal to the more stringent criteria set out in the table 

(6)  Richard Brindle retired from the Group and as a Director on 30 April 2014. Mr Brindle was afforded good 

on page 75. Between these two points vesting will take place on a straight-line basis from 25 per cent to 

leaver status and all RSS award interests were agreed to vest upon his departure using estimated TSR and 

100 per cent for RoE performance. 

RoE values at the time of his retirement. The amounts in the table above reflect all awards vesting in 2014. 

(3)  The vesting of the RSS performance awards from 2013 grants forward is subject to two performance 

Further particulars of the vesting appear on page 72. 

conditions as follows:  

  25 per cent of each award is subject to a performance condition measuring the TSR performance of the 

Company against the TSR performance of a select group of comparator companies (see page 75 for a list 

(7)  Mr Brindle’s 2012 performance award was vested in line with the plan rules using estimated TSR and RoE 

values at the time of his retirement. Vesting was based on 0 per cent vesting for the TSR element and 100 

per cent for the RoE element; an overall vesting of 50 per cent.  

of comparator companies for each grant year), over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this 

(8) Mr Brindle’s 2013 performance award was vested in line with the plan rules using estimated TSR and RoE 

half of the award vests for median performance by the Company, rising to 100 per cent vesting of this 

values at the time of his retirement. Vesting was based on 0 per cent vesting for the TSR element and  

half of the award for upper quartile performance by the Company or better (with proportionate vesting 

94.6 per cent for the RoE element; an overall vesting of 70.9 per cent.  

between these two points). 

(9)  Mr Brindle’s 2014 performance award was vested in line with the plan rules using estimated TSR and RoE 

  The other 75 per cent of each award is subject to a performance condition based on average annual RoE 

values at the time of his retirement. Vesting was based on 0 per cent vesting for the TSR element and  

over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this half of the award will vest if average annual 

83 per cent for the RoE element; an overall vesting of 62.3 per cent. 

RoE over the performance period exceeds the criteria set out in the table on page 75, whilst all of this 

part of the award will vest if the Company’s average RoE is equal to the more stringent criteria set out  

in the table on page 75. Between these two points vesting will take place on a straight-line basis from  

25 per cent to 100 per cent for RoE performance.  

(10) Neil McConachie was an Executive Director until 30 June 2012. No awards have been made to Mr 

McConachie in his capacity as a Non-Executive Director. At its meeting held on 4 February 2014 the 

Remuneration Committee decided that in light of Mr McConachie’s decision to resign from the Board  

as a Non-Executive Director at the 2014 AGM, it was appropriate to afford him ‘good leaver’ status for  

all vested and unvested RSS awards, subject to a non-compete requirement. Pro-ration remains subject  

to a final determination by the Remuneration Committee. 

74 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

PERFORMANCE AND DEFERRED BONUS AWARDS UNDER THE NIL-COST OPTION RESTRICTED SHARE SCHEME (RSS) CONTINUED 

TSR TARGETS FOR RSS 

100% 

25% 

Nil 

ROE TARGETS FOR RSS 

100% 

25% 

Nil 

2011 

2012 

2013* 

2014* 

2015* 

 75th percentile

75th percentile

75th percentile 

75th percentile  

75th percentile  

= median

< median

= median

< median

= median 

< median 

 = median  

< median  

= median  

< median  

2011 

2012 

2013* 

2014* 

2015* 

13 week Tr + 15%

13 week Tr + 15%

13 week Tr +15%  

13 week Tr +15%  

13 week Tr +15%  

13 week Tr + 6%

13 week Tr + 6%

13 week Tr + 6%  

13 week Tr + 6%  

13 week Tr + 6%  

<13 week Tr + 6% <13 week Tr + 6% <13 week Tr + 6%  

<13 week Tr + 6%  

<13 week Tr + 6%  

*  From 2013 onwards the split of targets has changed from 50 per cent RoE / 50 per cent TSR to 75 per cent RoE and 25 per cent TSR. 

Peer Companies 

Amlin plc  

Argo Limited1 

Aspen Insurance Holdings Limited 

Axis Capital Holdings Limited 

Beazley plc 

Catlin Group Ltd. 

Endurance Specialty Holdings Ltd. 

Flagstone Reinsurance Holdings Limited2 

Hiscox Ltd. 

Montpelier Re Holdings Ltd. 

Renaissance Re Holdings Ltd. 

Validus Holdings Ltd. 

2011 awards 

2012 awards 

2013 awards  

2014 awards 

2015 awards 

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

(1)  Argo was used as a comparator company from the fourth quarter of 2012. 

(2)  Flagstone was acquired by Validus with effect from 30 November 2012 and so was used as a comparator company for 2012 up to 30 September 2012. 

DIRECTORS' SHAREHOLDINGS AND SHARE INTERESTS 
A policy for formal shareholding guidelines was introduced in 2012. This requires the CEO to build and maintain a shareholding in the Company 
worth two-times annual salary and for the CFO to build and maintain a shareholding of one times annual salary as set out in the Policy Report. 

Details of the Directors' interests in shares are shown in the table below.  

Director 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan 

Peter Clarke 

Emma Duncan  

Simon Fraser 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson  

Robert Spass 

William Spiegel 

Martin Thomas  

At 1 January 2014 

At 31 December 2014 

Number of Ordinary Shares 

Legally owned 

Legally owned 

Subject to 
deferral 
under the RSS 

Subject to 
performance 
conditions 
under the RSS 

Vested but 
unexercised 
awards under 
other share  
based plans 

191,415

94,225

321,841

233,820

45,610

39,195

443,467

292,662

–

–

–

3,947

153,679

–

6,950

–

–

–

3,947

–

–

6,950

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

– 

– 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

Total 

810,918

565,677

–

–

–

3,947

–

–

6,950

Shareholding
guideline
achieved? 

Yes

Yes

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

75 
75

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

Former Director 

John Bishop2 

Richard Brindle2 

Neil McConachie2 

Ralf Oelssner2 

At 1 January 2014 

Legally owned 

Legally owned 

–

–

858,022

858,022

–

–

–

–

Number of Ordinary Shares 

At 30 April 2014 

Subject to 
deferral 
under the RSS 

Subject to 
performance 
conditions 
under the RSS3 

Vested but 
unexercised 
awards under 
other share  
based plans 

N/A

173,211

24,921

N/A

N/A

N/A 

542,216

6,413,442 

7,986,891

408,827

N/A

– 

433,748

N/A 

–

Total 

–

Shareholding
guideline
achieved? 

N/A

Yes

N/A

N/A

(1)  For the purpose of the shareholding guideline, legally owned shares are counted together with the net of tax value of deferred bonus and vested (but unexercised) long-term incentive awards. 

(2)  Richard Brindle retired from the Group and as a Director and John Bishop, Neil McConachie and Ralph Oelssner retired as Non-Executive Directors on 30 April 2014, therefore legal ownership of shares has only been tracked  

and reported for the relevant period. 

(3)  The awards for Richard Brindle reflect the performance conditions that were applied at the time of his retirement. Further details of the vesting can be found on page 72. 

Warrants over the Company's shares were awarded to the Company's founders and management prior to the admission of the Company's  
shares to trading on AIM. Details of the Former CEO’s awards, which were granted on 16 December 2005, are set out as below. Other Executive 
Directors had exercised their warrants prior to 2012. 

Richard Brindle’s Warrants held at 1 January 20142 

Warrants 
exercised during 
the period 

Warrants 
sold during 
the period 

Warrants held at 
30 April 
2014 

Exercise price 
$ 

Date from  
which first  
exercisable1 

Expiry date 

46,260  

3,718,912  

288,843  

1,906,305  

47,155  

405,967  

6,413,442  

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

46,260

3,718,912

288,843

1,906,305

47,155

405,967

6,413,442

5.00 

5.00 

5.00 

3.90 

3.90 

2.60 

16 Dec 2005 

16 Dec 2015

16 Dec 2005 

16 Dec 2015

31 Dec 2007 

16 Dec 2015

16 Dec 2008 

16 Dec 2015

31 Dec 2008 

16 Dec 2015

31 Dec 2009 

16 Dec 2015

(1)  There is a contractual obligation to make a dividend equivalent payment on each vested warrant. The value of dividend equivalents paid in respect of the above warrants to Richard Brindle in 2014 was £1,165,727  

(2013 – £6,822,340). 

(2)  The market value of the common shares on 16 December 2005, the date of warrant grant, was £3.21.  

PERFORMANCE GRAPH  
The following graph shows the Company’s performance, measured by TSR, compared with the performance of the FTSE 250 Index.  
The Company’s common shares commenced trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009 and the Company joined the  
FTSE 250 Index on 22 June 2009 and is currently a constituent of this. 

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN

£

400

350

300

250

200

150

100

50

0

2008

2009

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

LRE

FTSE 250 Index

Source: Thomson Reuters

76 
76 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

Former Director 

John Bishop2 

Richard Brindle2 

Neil McConachie2 

Ralf Oelssner2 

At 1 January 2014 

Legally owned 

Legally owned 

under the RSS 

Number of Ordinary Shares 

At 30 April 2014 

Subject to 

performance 

conditions 

under the RSS3 

Vested but 

unexercised 

awards under 

other share  

based plans 

N/A

N/A 

858,022

858,022

542,216

6,413,442 

7,986,891

408,827

N/A

– 

433,748

N/A 

Subject to 

deferral 

N/A

173,211

24,921

N/A

–

–

–

Shareholding

guideline

achieved? 

Total 

–

–

N/A

Yes

N/A

N/A

(1)  For the purpose of the shareholding guideline, legally owned shares are counted together with the net of tax value of deferred bonus and vested (but unexercised) long-term incentive awards. 

(2)  Richard Brindle retired from the Group and as a Director and John Bishop, Neil McConachie and Ralph Oelssner retired as Non-Executive Directors on 30 April 2014, therefore legal ownership of shares has only been tracked  

and reported for the relevant period. 

(3)  The awards for Richard Brindle reflect the performance conditions that were applied at the time of his retirement. Further details of the vesting can be found on page 72. 

Warrants over the Company's shares were awarded to the Company's founders and management prior to the admission of the Company's  

shares to trading on AIM. Details of the Former CEO’s awards, which were granted on 16 December 2005, are set out as below. Other Executive 

Directors had exercised their warrants prior to 2012. 

Richard Brindle’s Warrants held at 1 January 20142 

Warrants 

exercised during 

the period 

Warrants 

sold during 

the period 

Exercise price 

Date from  

which first  

exercisable1 

Expiry date 

46,260  

3,718,912  

288,843  

1,906,305  

47,155  

405,967  

6,413,442  

Warrants held at 

30 April 

2014 

46,260

3,718,912

288,843

1,906,305

47,155

405,967

6,413,442

–

–

–

–

–

–

$ 

5.00 

5.00 

5.00 

3.90 

3.90 

2.60 

16 Dec 2005 

16 Dec 2015

16 Dec 2005 

16 Dec 2015

31 Dec 2007 

16 Dec 2015

16 Dec 2008 

16 Dec 2015

31 Dec 2008 

16 Dec 2015

31 Dec 2009 

16 Dec 2015

(1)  There is a contractual obligation to make a dividend equivalent payment on each vested warrant. The value of dividend equivalents paid in respect of the above warrants to Richard Brindle in 2014 was £1,165,727  

(2013 – £6,822,340). 

(2)  The market value of the common shares on 16 December 2005, the date of warrant grant, was £3.21.  

PERFORMANCE GRAPH  

The following graph shows the Company’s performance, measured by TSR, compared with the performance of the FTSE 250 Index.  

The Company’s common shares commenced trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009 and the Company joined the  

FTSE 250 Index on 22 June 2009 and is currently a constituent of this. 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

This graph shows the value, by 31 December 2014, of £100 invested in Lancashire Holdings Limited on 31 December 2008 compared with the 
value of £100 invested in the FTSE 250 Index. The other points plotted are the values at intervening financial year-ends. 

TOTAL REMUNERATION HISTORY FOR CEO 
The table below sets out the total single figure remuneration for the CEOs over the last six years with the annual bonus paid as a percentage of the 
maximum and the percentage of long-term share awards vesting in the year. It should be noted that the current CEO was appointed 1 May 2014. 

Total remuneration ($000s) 

Annual bonus (%) 

LTI vesting (%) 

2009 

7,244 

68 

N/A 

2010 

9,945

94

99.57

2011 

9,623

73

100

2012 

10,460

73

99

2013 

10,175 

80 

100 

Richard Brindle 
20141 

Alex Maloney 
20142 

9,391 

80 

613

2,169 

53 

50 

(1)  Richard Brindle retired from the Group and as a Director on 30 April 2014.  

(2)  Alex Maloney was appointed CEO effective 1 May 2014, after the retirement of Mr Brindle. 

(3)  Mr Brindle was afforded good leaver status and all RSS award interests were agreed to vest upon his departure, using estimated TSR and RoE values at the time of his retirement. The amounts in the table above reflect all 

awards vesting in 2014. Further particulars of the vesting appear on page 72. 

The table above shows the total remuneration figure for the former CEO during each of those financial years; the current CEO is reflected for  
the current year only, from 1 May 2014, being the only year he has held the post to-date. The total remuneration figure includes the annual bonus 
and LTI awards which vested based on performance in those years. The annual bonus and LTI percentages show the pay-out for each year as a 
percentage of the maximum. 

PERCENTAGE CHANGE IN CEO REMUNERATION 
The following table sets out the percentage change in the aggregate value of salary, benefits and bonus for the Chief Executive from the preceding 
year and the average percentage change in respect of the employees of the Company taken as a whole. 

Base salary 

Benefits3 

Bonus 

Year on 
 year change 
CEO1
%  

Average year 
on year change 
employees2
%  

-22

-29

-44

-22

-70

-16

(1) A blended CEO rate is used for 2014 to account for CEO changes through the year.  

(2) Employee numbers were calculated on a per head count basis as at 31 December 2013 and 31 December 2014. 2013 annual costs include the Lloyd’s segment of the Company’s costs from 7 November 2013 only, the date  

the acquisition of Cathedral completed.  

(3)  Fluctuations in foreign exchange rates and the Company’s share price have attributed to the decrease in benefit costs in 2014, specifically to payroll taxes on equity compensation. 

RELATIVE IMPORTANCE OF THE SPEND ON PAY 
The following table sets out the percentage change in dividends and overall spend on pay in the year ending 31 December 2014 compared to the year 
ending 31 December 2013. The increase in employee remuneration costs is mainly attributed to inclusion of Cathedral employee remuneration costs 
being reported for the full year of 2014. 

Employee remuneration costs 

Dividends 

2014  
$m1 

77.4  

321.0  

2013
$m 

59.4

325.6

Percentage
 change
% 

30.3

-1.4

(1)  The total employee remuneration costs for 2013 includes the Lloyd’s segment of the Company’s costs from 7 November 2013, the date the acquisition of Cathedral completed.  

76 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

77 
77

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

COMMITTEE MEMBERS, ATTENDEES AND ADVICE 
The Remuneration Committee comprised the following members during the year and to the date of this Report (all of whom are independent 
Non-Executive Directors): 

Remuneration Committee Members 

Position 

Comments 

Simon Fraser 

Peter Clarke 

Emma Duncan 

Former Members 

Ralf Oelssner 

William Spiegel 

(1) See note 7 on page 50. 

LHL Remuneration Committee Chairman 

Independent; Attended 6 of a potential maximum meetings of 6 in 2014  

Member from 4 November 2014 

Independent; No meetings held subsequent to appointment 

Member from 5 November 2010 

Independent; Attended 6 of a potential maximum meetings of 6 in 2014 

Retired from Committee 30 April 2014 

Independent; Attended 0 of a potential maximum meetings of 4 in 20141 

Retired from Committee 31 December 2014 

Independent; Attended 5 of a potential maximum meetings of 6 in 2014 

The Remuneration Committee’s responsibilities are contained in its Terms of Reference, a copy of which is available on the Company’s website. 
These responsibilities include determining the framework for the remuneration, including pension arrangements, for all Executive Directors,  
the Chairman and senior executives. The Committee is also responsible for approving employment contracts for senior executives. 

REMUNERATION COMMITTEE ADVISER 
The Remuneration Committee is advised by NBS, a trading name of Aon Hewitt, being a subsidiary of Aon plc. NBS was appointed by the 
Remuneration Committee in 2007. NBS has discussions with the Remuneration Committee Chairman regularly on Committee process and topics 
which are of particular relevance to the Company.  

Aon Benfield (which is part of Aon but is a separate business division to Aon Hewitt) provides reinsurance broking services to Lancashire.  

The primary role of NBS is to provide independent and objective advice and support to the Committee's Chairman and members. In order to 
manage any possible conflict of interest, NBS operates as a distinct business within the Aon Group and there is a robust separation between the 
business activities and management of NBS and all other parts of Aon Hewitt and the wider Aon Group. The Committee is satisfied that the advice 
that it receives is objective and independent. NBS is also a signatory to the Remuneration Consultants Group ('RCG') Code of Conduct which sets 
out guidelines for managing conflicts of interest, and has confirmed to the Committee its compliance with the RCG Code.  

The total fees paid to NBS in respect of its services to the Committee for the year ending 31 December 2014 were $160,691 (2013 – $174,004). 
Fees are predominantly charged on a 'time spent' basis.  

ENGAGEMENT WITH SHAREHOLDERS 
Details of votes cast for and against the resolution to approve last year’s Remuneration Report and the Remuneration Policy are shown below and 
any matters discussed with shareholders during the year are provided in the Implementation Report starting on page 67. 

Vote to approve Directors’ 
Remuneration Policy 

Vote to approve Annual Report  
on Remuneration 

Total number 
of votes 

% of 
 votes cast 

Total number 
of votes 

% of
 votes cast 

132,963,855

90.1 

102,131,849

14,530,236

9.9  44,035,683

147,494,091

100.0 

146,167,532

554,388

1,880,947

69.9

30.1

100.0

For  

Against 

Total 

Abstentions 

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board 

SIMON FRASER 
LHL REMUNERATION COMMITTEE CHAIRMAN 
11 February 2015 

78 
78 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT 

OVERVIEW OF THE GROUP 
Lancashire Holdings Limited (the Company) is a Bermuda incorporated company with operating subsidiaries in Bermuda, London and Lloyd’s.  

The Company’s common shares were admitted to trading on AIM in December 2005 and were subsequently moved up to the Official List and  
to trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009. The shares have been included in the FTSE 250 index since 22 June 2009. 

PRINCIPAL ACTIVITIES 
The Company’s principal activity, through its wholly owned subsidiaries, is the provision of global specialty insurance and reinsurance products. 
On 7 November 2013, the Company completed the acquisition of Cathedral Capital Limited, an established Lloyd’s insurer, and in July 2013 set 
up Kinesis, a third-party capital and underwriting management facility, to complement Lancashire’s longstanding specialty insurance activities.  
An analysis of the Group’s business performance can be found in the Business review on pages 24 to 32. 

DIVIDENDS  
For the year ended 31 December 2014, the following dividends were declared:  

  an interim dividend of $0.05 per common share and warrant was declared on 23 July 2014 and paid on 24 September 2014 in pounds sterling  

at the pound/U.S. dollar exchange rate of 1.6592 or £0.0301 per common share and warrant;  

  a special dividend of $1.20 per common share and warrant was declared on 4 November 2014 and paid on 19 December 2014 in pounds 

sterling at the pound/U.S. dollar exchange rate of 1.5705 or £0.7641 per common share and warrant; 

  a final dividend of $0.10 per common share and warrant was declared on 11 February 2015; and 

  an additional special dividend of $0.50 per common share and warrant was declared on 11 February 2015. 

Both the final dividend and the additional special dividend are to be paid on 15 April 2015 in pounds sterling at the pound/U.S. dollar  
exchange rate on the record date of 20 March 2015 or approximately £0.39 in the aggregate, per common share and warrant.  

DIVIDEND POLICY 
Lancashire intends to maintain a strong balance sheet at all times, while generating an attractive risk-adjusted total return for shareholders.  
We actively manage capital to achieve those aims. Capital management is expected to include the payment of a sustainable annual (interim and 
final) dividend, supplemented by special dividends from time to time. Dividends will be linked to past performance and future prospects. 

Under most scenarios, the annual dividend is not expected to reduce from one year to the next. Special dividends are expected to vary 
substantially in size and in timing. 

DIRECTORS 
CURRENT DIRECTORS 
  Peter Clarke (Non-Executive Director) (appointed effective 9 June 2014) 

  Emma Duncan (Non-Executive Director) 

  Simon Fraser (Senior Independent Non-Executive Director) (appointed SID effective 30 April 2014) 

  Samantha Hoe-Richardson (Non-Executive Director)  

  Alex Maloney (Chief Executive Officer) (appointed CEO effective 30 April 2014) 

  Tom Milligan (Non-Executive Director) (appointed effective 3 February 2015) 

  Martin Thomas (Non-Executive Chairman) 

  Elaine Whelan (Chief Financial Officer) 

DIRECTORS WHO RETIRED DURING THE YEAR  
  John Bishop (Non-Executive Director) (retired effective 30 April 2014) 

  Richard Brindle (Chief Executive Officer) (retired effective 30 April 2014) 

  Neil McConachie (Non-Executive Director) (retired effective 30 April 2014)  

  Ralf Oelssner (Senior Independent Non-Executive Director) (retired effective 30 April 2014) 

  Robert Spass (Non-Executive Director) (retired effective 1 January 2015) 

  William Spiegel (Non-Executive Director) (retired effective 1 January 2015) 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

79 
79

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT CONTINUED 

DIRECTORS’ INTERESTS 
The Directors’ beneficial interests in the Company’s common shares as at 31 December 2014 and 2013 including interests held by family members 
were as follows: 

Details of the Directors’ remuneration are set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 61 to 78. 

Director 

Peter Clarke 

Emma Duncan 

Simon Fraser 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson 

Alex Maloney1 

Martin Thomas 

Elaine Whelan2 

Former Director 

John Bishop 

Richard Brindle3 

Neil McConachie 

Ralf Oelssner 

Robert Spass4 

William Spiegel 

Common shares 
held at
31 December 2014 

Common shares 
held at 
31 December 2013 

–

–

–

3,947

321,841

6,950

233,820

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

–

–

–

–

–

3,947

191,415

6,950

94,225

–

858,022

–

–

153,679

–

There have been no changes in Directors’ shareholdings between the end of the financial year and the date of this Report. 

(1)  Includes 100,000 shares owned by his spouse, Amanda Maloney. Alex Maloney conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2014: 

  7 May – exercise of 236,198 RSS awards and 10,332 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 116,104 shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £6.68 realising £775,269. 

(2)   Includes 2,600 shares owned by her spouse, Kilian Whelan. Elaine Whelan conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2014: 

  7 May – exercise of 126,894 RSS awards and 15,783 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 3,082 shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £6.68 realising £20,580. 

(3)  Richard Brindle conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2014, prior to his retirement: 

  13 February – exercise of 176,655 RSS awards and subsequent sale of 176,655 shares at a price of £7.29 realising £1,287,902. 

(4) Robert Spass conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2014: 

  24/25 February – sold 153,679 shares at a price of $12.11 realising $1,860,385; 

  6 May – cashless exercise of 150,000 Founder warrants resulting in the acquisition of 85,536 shares; and 

  14 May – sold 85,536 shares at a price of £6.62 realising £566,077. 

Two former Directors held warrants over the Company’s shares which were awarded prior to the Company’s admission to AIM in December  
2005 along with other warrants awarded to the Company’s founders and employees. At the time of his retirement on 31 December 2014 Robert 
Spass was the beneficial owner of 410,000 Founder warrants. Richard Brindle also held warrants at the time of his retirement on 30 April 2014  
and further details of the Executive Directors’ warrants are included in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on page 76. 

In November 2014, Richard Brindle sold the entirety of his 5.5 per cent shareholding in KCML to LHL and other existing KCML shareholders 
pursuant to the terms of the KCML subscripted shareholders’ agreement. At the same time, Alex Maloney increased his shareholding in KCML 
from 1.1 per cent to 1.2 per cent. Following the transaction LHL owns 92.7 per cent of KCML, with the balance of the shares owned by senior 
Lancashire and KCML employees. 

TRANSACTION IN OWN SHARES 
The Company repurchased 2,498,433 of its own common shares from 8 September 2014 through 20 November 2014 for a total consideration  
of approximately $25.0 million. These repurchases were made pursuant to resolutions of the shareholders passed at the AGM held on 30 April 
2014 granting authority for the repurchase of up to 18,544,580 shares. All of the repurchased shares were initially held in treasury. 

The Group’s current repurchase programme has 16,046,147 common shares remaining to be purchased at 31 December 2014 (approximately 
$139.6 million at the 31 December 2014 share price). The purpose of the Company’s repurchase programme is to acquire shares to use in the 
future towards satisfying its obligations under both its RSS awards and the Company's warrants. The shares repurchased have been held as  
treasury shares. Further details of the share repurchase authority and programme are set out in note 23 to the consolidated financial statements 
on page 153. The repurchase programme is subject to renewal at the 2015 AGM in an amount of up to 10 per cent of the then issued common 
share capital.  

The Company did not repurchase any of its own common shares during 2013. 

80  
80 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION 

SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS 

Name 

Invesco Limited 

Setanta Asset Management Limited 

Woodford Investment Management LLP 

Legal & General Group Plc 

Franklin Mutual Advisers, LLC 

Standard Life Investments (Holdings) Limited 

Alken Luxembourg S.A. 

BlackRock, Inc. 

the Code. 

DONATIONS 

in respect of 2014. 

As at 11 February 2015, the Company was aware of the following interests of 3 per cent or more in the Company’s issued share capital: 

Number of 

shares as at 

11 February 

2015 

27,364,567

15,225,288

13,286,694

10,457,693

9,772,203

8,655,337

6,632,554

6,279,133

% of shares

 in issue 

14.4

8.0

7.0

5.5

5.2

4.6

3.5

3.3

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE – COMPLIANCE STATEMENT 

The Company’s compliance with the Code is summarised in the Corporate Governance section of this Report on pages 49 to 51.  

The Company confirms, in accordance with the principle of ‘comply or explain’, that there are no areas of material non-compliance with 

In November 2013, the Board of Directors approved a cash donation of $2,000,000 (2013 – $1,400,000) to the Lancashire Foundation, payable  

Lancashire established the Lancashire Foundation as a Bermuda charitable trust in 2007, with the aim of creating a trust for the benefit of 

charitable causes in Bermuda, the UK and worldwide. During 2012, the assets of the Lancashire Foundation were transferred to the Lancashire 

Foundation charitable trust established in England and Wales and registered with the Charity Commission. The Lancashire Foundation’s trustees 

are two senior employees, one former employee, a subsidiary non-executive director and the Group Chairman. The Trustees make donations 

following recommendations made by the Company’s Donations Committee consisting of the Group’s employees.  

A summary of the work of the Lancashire Foundation during 2014 can be found in the Corporate Responsibility section on pages 38 to 41. 

The Group did not make any political donations or expenditure during 2014 or 2013. 

HEALTH AND SAFETY 

The Group considers the health and safety of its employees to be a management responsibility equal to that of any other function.  

The Group operates in compliance with health and safety legislative requirements in Bermuda and the UK.  

GREENHOUSE GAS EMISSIONS 

The Group’s greenhouse gas emissions are detailed in the Corporate Responsibility section on pages 39 to 40. 

EMPLOYEES 

Lancashire is an equal opportunity employer, and does not tolerate unfair discrimination of any kind in any area of employment or corporate  

life. The Group believes that education and training for employees is a continuous process and employees are encouraged to discuss training 

needs with their managers. The Group’s health and safety, equal opportunities, training and other policies are available to all employees in  

the staff handbook which is available on the Group’s intranet. 

CREDITOR PAYMENT POLICY 

The Group aims to pay all creditors promptly and in accordance with contractual and legal obligations. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

81 

 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT CONTINUED 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson 

were as follows: 

Director 

Peter Clarke 

Emma Duncan 

Simon Fraser 

Alex Maloney1 

Martin Thomas 

Elaine Whelan2 

Former Director 

John Bishop 

Richard Brindle3 

Neil McConachie 

Ralf Oelssner 

Robert Spass4 

William Spiegel 

–

–

–

3,947

321,841

6,950

233,820

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

3,947

191,415

6,950

94,225

858,022

153,679

There have been no changes in Directors’ shareholdings between the end of the financial year and the date of this Report. 

(1)  Includes 100,000 shares owned by his spouse, Amanda Maloney. Alex Maloney conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2014: 

  7 May – exercise of 236,198 RSS awards and 10,332 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 116,104 shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £6.68 realising £775,269. 

(2)   Includes 2,600 shares owned by her spouse, Kilian Whelan. Elaine Whelan conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2014: 

  7 May – exercise of 126,894 RSS awards and 15,783 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 3,082 shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £6.68 realising £20,580. 

(3)  Richard Brindle conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2014, prior to his retirement: 

  13 February – exercise of 176,655 RSS awards and subsequent sale of 176,655 shares at a price of £7.29 realising £1,287,902. 

(4) Robert Spass conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2014: 

  24/25 February – sold 153,679 shares at a price of $12.11 realising $1,860,385; 

  6 May – cashless exercise of 150,000 Founder warrants resulting in the acquisition of 85,536 shares; and 

  14 May – sold 85,536 shares at a price of £6.62 realising £566,077. 

Two former Directors held warrants over the Company’s shares which were awarded prior to the Company’s admission to AIM in December  

2005 along with other warrants awarded to the Company’s founders and employees. At the time of his retirement on 31 December 2014 Robert 

Spass was the beneficial owner of 410,000 Founder warrants. Richard Brindle also held warrants at the time of his retirement on 30 April 2014  

and further details of the Executive Directors’ warrants are included in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on page 76. 

In November 2014, Richard Brindle sold the entirety of his 5.5 per cent shareholding in KCML to LHL and other existing KCML shareholders 

pursuant to the terms of the KCML subscripted shareholders’ agreement. At the same time, Alex Maloney increased his shareholding in KCML 

from 1.1 per cent to 1.2 per cent. Following the transaction LHL owns 92.7 per cent of KCML, with the balance of the shares owned by senior 

Lancashire and KCML employees. 

TRANSACTION IN OWN SHARES 

The Company repurchased 2,498,433 of its own common shares from 8 September 2014 through 20 November 2014 for a total consideration  

of approximately $25.0 million. These repurchases were made pursuant to resolutions of the shareholders passed at the AGM held on 30 April 

2014 granting authority for the repurchase of up to 18,544,580 shares. All of the repurchased shares were initially held in treasury. 

The Group’s current repurchase programme has 16,046,147 common shares remaining to be purchased at 31 December 2014 (approximately 

$139.6 million at the 31 December 2014 share price). The purpose of the Company’s repurchase programme is to acquire shares to use in the 

future towards satisfying its obligations under both its RSS awards and the Company's warrants. The shares repurchased have been held as  

treasury shares. Further details of the share repurchase authority and programme are set out in note 23 to the consolidated financial statements 

on page 153. The repurchase programme is subject to renewal at the 2015 AGM in an amount of up to 10 per cent of the then issued common 

share capital.  

The Company did not repurchase any of its own common shares during 2013. 

80  

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

DIRECTORS’ INTERESTS 

The Directors’ beneficial interests in the Company’s common shares as at 31 December 2014 and 2013 including interests held by family members 

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION 
Details of the Directors’ remuneration are set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 61 to 78. 

Common shares 

Common shares 

held at

held at 

31 December 2014 

31 December 2013 

SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS 
As at 11 February 2015, the Company was aware of the following interests of 3 per cent or more in the Company’s issued share capital: 

Name 

Invesco Limited 

Setanta Asset Management Limited 

Woodford Investment Management LLP 

Legal & General Group Plc 

Franklin Mutual Advisers, LLC 

Standard Life Investments (Holdings) Limited 

Alken Luxembourg S.A. 

BlackRock, Inc. 

Number of 
shares as at 
11 February 
2015 

27,364,567

15,225,288

13,286,694

10,457,693

9,772,203

8,655,337

6,632,554

6,279,133

% of shares
 in issue 

14.4

8.0

7.0

5.5

5.2

4.6

3.5

3.3

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE – COMPLIANCE STATEMENT 
The Company’s compliance with the Code is summarised in the Corporate Governance section of this Report on pages 49 to 51.  

The Company confirms, in accordance with the principle of ‘comply or explain’, that there are no areas of material non-compliance with 
the Code. 

DONATIONS 
In November 2013, the Board of Directors approved a cash donation of $2,000,000 (2013 – $1,400,000) to the Lancashire Foundation, payable  
in respect of 2014. 

Lancashire established the Lancashire Foundation as a Bermuda charitable trust in 2007, with the aim of creating a trust for the benefit of 
charitable causes in Bermuda, the UK and worldwide. During 2012, the assets of the Lancashire Foundation were transferred to the Lancashire 
Foundation charitable trust established in England and Wales and registered with the Charity Commission. The Lancashire Foundation’s trustees 
are two senior employees, one former employee, a subsidiary non-executive director and the Group Chairman. The Trustees make donations 
following recommendations made by the Company’s Donations Committee consisting of the Group’s employees.  

A summary of the work of the Lancashire Foundation during 2014 can be found in the Corporate Responsibility section on pages 38 to 41. 

The Group did not make any political donations or expenditure during 2014 or 2013. 

HEALTH AND SAFETY 
The Group considers the health and safety of its employees to be a management responsibility equal to that of any other function.  

The Group operates in compliance with health and safety legislative requirements in Bermuda and the UK.  

GREENHOUSE GAS EMISSIONS 
The Group’s greenhouse gas emissions are detailed in the Corporate Responsibility section on pages 39 to 40. 

EMPLOYEES 
Lancashire is an equal opportunity employer, and does not tolerate unfair discrimination of any kind in any area of employment or corporate  
life. The Group believes that education and training for employees is a continuous process and employees are encouraged to discuss training 
needs with their managers. The Group’s health and safety, equal opportunities, training and other policies are available to all employees in  
the staff handbook which is available on the Group’s intranet. 

CREDITOR PAYMENT POLICY 
The Group aims to pay all creditors promptly and in accordance with contractual and legal obligations. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

81 
81

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT CONTINUED 

STATEMENT OF DIRECTORS’ RESPONSIBILITIES 

FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK EXPOSURES  
Information regarding the Group’s risk exposure is included in the risk disclosures section on pages 100 to 126 of the consolidated financial 
statements. The Group’s use of derivative financial instruments can be found on pages 115 to 116. 

ACCOUNTING STANDARDS 
The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS as  
adopted by the European Union. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of the measurement of insurance products, the IFRS framework allows 
reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Board determines appropriate measurement bases,  
to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using their judgement and considering U.S. GAAP.  

ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 
The notice of the 2015 AGM, to be held on 29 April 2015 at the Company’s head office, 29th Floor, 20 Fenchurch Street, London EC3M 3BY,  
UK, is contained in a separate circular to shareholders enclosed with this Annual Report and Accounts. The notice of the AGM is also available  
on the Company’s website. 

ELECTRONIC AND WEB COMMUNICATIONS 
Provisions of the Bermuda Companies Act 1981 enable companies to communicate with shareholders by electronic and/or website 
communications. The Company will notify shareholders (either in writing or by other permitted means) when a relevant document  
or other information is placed on the website and a shareholder may request a hard copy version of the document or information. 

GOING CONCERN AND VIABILITY STATEMENT 
The Business Review section on pages 24 to 32 sets out details of the Group’s financial performance, capital management, business environment 
and outlook. In addition, further discussion of the principal risks and material uncertainties affecting Lancashire can be found on pages 36  
to 37. Starting on page 100 the risk disclosures section of the consolidated financial statements set out the principal risks the Group is exposed  
to, including insurance, market, liquidity, credit, operational and strategic, together with the Group’s policies for monitoring, managing and 
mitigating its exposures to these risks. The Board considers annually and on a rolling basis a three year strategic plan for the business which  
the Company progressively implements. The three-year strategic plan was last approved by the Board on 30 April 2014. The Board receives 
quarterly reports from the Chief Risk Officer and sets and approves risk tolerances for the business.  

During 2014, the Board carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its business 
model, future performance, solvency or liquidity. The Directors believe that the Group is well placed to manage its business risks successfully, 
having taken into account the current economic outlook. Accordingly, the Board believes that, taking into account the Group’s current position, 
and subject to the principal risks faced by the business, the Group will be able to continue in operation and to meet its liabilities as they fall due  
for the period up to 31 December 2016, being the period considered under the Group’s current three-year strategic plan. 

After making enquiries, the Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue its operational existence 
for the foreseeable future and for a period of at least twelve months from the date of this report. Accordingly, the Board continues to adopt and 
consider appropriate the going concern basis in preparing the Annual Report and Accounts. 

AUDITORS 
Resolutions will be proposed at the Company’s 2015 AGM to re-appoint Ernst & Young LLP as the Company’s auditors and to authorise  
the Directors to set the auditors’ remuneration. Ernst & Young have served as the Company’s auditors since 2005. 

The Company plans to perform an audit tender process during 2016 and to recommend an auditor to the shareholders to vote on at the  
2017 AGM. 

DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION TO THE AUDITORS 
Each of the persons who is a Director at the date of approval of this Annual Report confirms that: 

  so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Company’s auditors are unaware; and  

  the Director has taken all the steps that he or she ought to have taken as a Director in order to make himself or herself aware of any relevant 

audit information and to establish that the Company’s auditors are aware of that information. 

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board. 

CHRISTOPHER HEAD 
COMPANY SECRETARY 
11 February 2015 

82  
82 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and the Group’s consolidated financial statements in accordance with applicable 

law and regulations. 

Company law requires the Directors to prepare financial statements for each financial year that give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of  

the Company and the Group and of the profit or loss of the Group for that period. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in 

accordance with IFRS. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of the measurement of insurance products, U.S. GAAP is considered. Further detail 

on the basis of preparation is described in the consolidated financial statements. In preparing the consolidated financial statements, the Directors 

are required to: 

  select suitable accounting policies and apply them consistently; 

  make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable and prudent; 

  state whether they have been prepared in accordance with IFRS; 

  state whether applicable accounting standards have been followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the  

Group’s consolidated financial statements;  

  provide additional disclosures where compliance with the specific requirements of IFRS are considered to be insufficient to enable users  

to understand the impact of particular transactions, events and conditions on the financial position and performance; and 

  prepare the consolidated financial statements on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Company and 

 the Group will continue in business. 

The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the Company’s and the Group’s 

transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the Company and the Group, and enable them to ensure 

that the consolidated financial statements comply with applicable laws and regulations. They are also responsible for safeguarding the assets  

of the Group and hence for taking reasonable steps for the prevention and detection of fraud and other irregularities. 

DIRECTORS’ RESPONSIBILITY STATEMENT 

The Directors confirm that to the best of their knowledge: 

1.  the consolidated financial statements, prepared in accordance with IFRS, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities,  

financial position and profit of the Group;  

2.  the Board considers the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, are fair, balanced and understandable and provide  

the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Company’s performance, business model and strategy; and  

3.  the Strategy and the Business review include a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position  

of the Group, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that the Group faces. 

Legislation in Bermuda governing the preparation and dissemination of the consolidated financial statements may differ from legislation  

in other jurisdictions. In addition, the rights of shareholders under Bermuda law may differ from those for shareholders of companies 

incorporated in other jurisdictions. 

By order of the Board 

11 February 2015 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

83 

 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT CONTINUED 

STATEMENT OF DIRECTORS’ RESPONSIBILITIES 

FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK EXPOSURES  

Information regarding the Group’s risk exposure is included in the risk disclosures section on pages 100 to 126 of the consolidated financial 

statements. The Group’s use of derivative financial instruments can be found on pages 115 to 116. 

ACCOUNTING STANDARDS 

The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS as  

adopted by the European Union. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of the measurement of insurance products, the IFRS framework allows 

reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Board determines appropriate measurement bases,  

to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using their judgement and considering U.S. GAAP.  

ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 

on the Company’s website. 

The notice of the 2015 AGM, to be held on 29 April 2015 at the Company’s head office, 29th Floor, 20 Fenchurch Street, London EC3M 3BY,  

UK, is contained in a separate circular to shareholders enclosed with this Annual Report and Accounts. The notice of the AGM is also available  

ELECTRONIC AND WEB COMMUNICATIONS 

Provisions of the Bermuda Companies Act 1981 enable companies to communicate with shareholders by electronic and/or website 

communications. The Company will notify shareholders (either in writing or by other permitted means) when a relevant document  

or other information is placed on the website and a shareholder may request a hard copy version of the document or information. 

GOING CONCERN AND VIABILITY STATEMENT 

The Business Review section on pages 24 to 32 sets out details of the Group’s financial performance, capital management, business environment 

and outlook. In addition, further discussion of the principal risks and material uncertainties affecting Lancashire can be found on pages 36  

to 37. Starting on page 100 the risk disclosures section of the consolidated financial statements set out the principal risks the Group is exposed  

to, including insurance, market, liquidity, credit, operational and strategic, together with the Group’s policies for monitoring, managing and 

mitigating its exposures to these risks. The Board considers annually and on a rolling basis a three year strategic plan for the business which  

the Company progressively implements. The three-year strategic plan was last approved by the Board on 30 April 2014. The Board receives 

quarterly reports from the Chief Risk Officer and sets and approves risk tolerances for the business.  

During 2014, the Board carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its business 

model, future performance, solvency or liquidity. The Directors believe that the Group is well placed to manage its business risks successfully, 

having taken into account the current economic outlook. Accordingly, the Board believes that, taking into account the Group’s current position, 

and subject to the principal risks faced by the business, the Group will be able to continue in operation and to meet its liabilities as they fall due  

for the period up to 31 December 2016, being the period considered under the Group’s current three-year strategic plan. 

After making enquiries, the Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue its operational existence 

for the foreseeable future and for a period of at least twelve months from the date of this report. Accordingly, the Board continues to adopt and 

consider appropriate the going concern basis in preparing the Annual Report and Accounts. 

AUDITORS 

2017 AGM. 

Resolutions will be proposed at the Company’s 2015 AGM to re-appoint Ernst & Young LLP as the Company’s auditors and to authorise  

the Directors to set the auditors’ remuneration. Ernst & Young have served as the Company’s auditors since 2005. 

The Company plans to perform an audit tender process during 2016 and to recommend an auditor to the shareholders to vote on at the  

DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION TO THE AUDITORS 

Each of the persons who is a Director at the date of approval of this Annual Report confirms that: 

  so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Company’s auditors are unaware; and  

  the Director has taken all the steps that he or she ought to have taken as a Director in order to make himself or herself aware of any relevant 

audit information and to establish that the Company’s auditors are aware of that information. 

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board. 

CHRISTOPHER HEAD 

COMPANY SECRETARY 

11 February 2015 

82  

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and the Group’s consolidated financial statements in accordance with applicable 
law and regulations. 

Company law requires the Directors to prepare financial statements for each financial year that give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of  
the Company and the Group and of the profit or loss of the Group for that period. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in 
accordance with IFRS. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of the measurement of insurance products, U.S. GAAP is considered. Further detail 
on the basis of preparation is described in the consolidated financial statements. In preparing the consolidated financial statements, the Directors 
are required to: 

  select suitable accounting policies and apply them consistently; 

  make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable and prudent; 

  state whether they have been prepared in accordance with IFRS; 

  state whether applicable accounting standards have been followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the  

Group’s consolidated financial statements;  

  provide additional disclosures where compliance with the specific requirements of IFRS are considered to be insufficient to enable users  

to understand the impact of particular transactions, events and conditions on the financial position and performance; and 

  prepare the consolidated financial statements on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Company and 

 the Group will continue in business. 

The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the Company’s and the Group’s 
transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the Company and the Group, and enable them to ensure 
that the consolidated financial statements comply with applicable laws and regulations. They are also responsible for safeguarding the assets  
of the Group and hence for taking reasonable steps for the prevention and detection of fraud and other irregularities. 

DIRECTORS’ RESPONSIBILITY STATEMENT 
The Directors confirm that to the best of their knowledge: 

1.  the consolidated financial statements, prepared in accordance with IFRS, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities,  

financial position and profit of the Group;  

2.  the Board considers the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, are fair, balanced and understandable and provide  

the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Company’s performance, business model and strategy; and  

3.  the Strategy and the Business review include a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position  

of the Group, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that the Group faces. 

Legislation in Bermuda governing the preparation and dissemination of the consolidated financial statements may differ from legislation  
in other jurisdictions. In addition, the rights of shareholders under Bermuda law may differ from those for shareholders of companies 
incorporated in other jurisdictions. 

By order of the Board 

11 February 2015 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

83 
83

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

At Lancashire, 

we adapt to

advance

We have taken some significant 
strategic steps in response to changes 
in a challenging market, both cyclical 
and secular. Thanks to our foresight, 
we have been able to adapt to  
our environment.

PROBABLE MAXIMUM LOSS
Although it can be a simplistic measure, 
and we don’t place over-reliance on 
models, the PMLs are a reasonable proxy 
for the relative amounts of risk we are 
retaining across the cycle. In the current 
depressed markets we have brought risk 
levels down, largely through the use  
of additional reinsurance.

$235.2m

400

300

200

100

0

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

84 
84 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

5 Year average

 $269.1m

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

85
85

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS’ REPORT TO THE MEMBERS OF LANCASHIRE HOLDINGS LIMITED 

OPINION ON FINANCIAL STATEMENTS  
In our opinion the consolidated financial statements:  

  give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s affairs as at 31 December 2014 and of its profit for the year then ended; and 

  have been properly prepared in accordance with IFRSs as adopted by the European Union.  

WHAT WE HAVE AUDITED 
We have audited the consolidated financial statements of Lancashire Holdings Limited and its subsidiaries (collectively “the Group”)  
for the year ended 31 December 2014, which comprise: 

  the consolidated statement of comprehensive income;  

  the consolidated balance sheet;  

  the consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity; 

  the statement of consolidated cash flows; and  

  the accounting policies, the risk disclosures, and the related notes to the accounts 1 to 31.  

The financial reporting framework that has been applied in their preparation is applicable law and International Financial Reporting 
Standards (IFRSs) as adopted by the European Union.  

This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with our engagement letter dated 26 November 2013.  
Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company’s members those matters we are required to state to them in 
an auditors’ report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone 
other than the Company and the Company’s members as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed. 

OUR ASSESSMENT OF RISKS OF MATERIAL MISSTATEMENT AND RESPONSE TO THAT RISK  
The table below shows the risks we identified that have had the greatest effect on the overall audit strategy, the allocation of resources  
in the audit and directing the efforts of the engagement team together with our audit response to the risk.  

In 2013, we identified a risk relating to the fair value adjustments recognised and the valuation of intangible assets on the acquisition  
of the Cathedral Group. This year we have considered the risk of impairment of those intangible assets as we comment on below. 

VALUATION OF LOSS RESERVES 
Refer to page 53 (Audit Committee report), page 97 (accounting policy) and page 108 (disclosures) 

Risk 

  Response 

The valuation of loss reserves 
incorporates a significant amount of 
judgement. It is reasonably possible 
that uncertainties inherent in the 
reserving process, delays in insureds 
or ceding companies reporting 
losses to the Group, together with 
the potential for unforeseen adverse 
developments, could lead to the 
ultimate amount paid varying 
materially from the amount 
estimated at this reporting date. 

We understood, assessed and tested the design and operational effectiveness of the key controls  
in Lancashire’s reserving process, including the review and approval of the reserves, and controls 
over the extraction of data from the claims systems.  

Supported by our actuarial specialists, we evaluated management’s methodology against market 
practice and challenged management’s assumptions and their assessment of major sensitivities, 
based on our market knowledge and industry data where available. 

Using management’s data, we independently re-projected the loss and loss adjustment expense 
reserves for LUK, LICL, and Cathedral on both a gross and net basis, investigating significant 
differences between our projections and management’s booked reserves. Using our own valuation 
we then considered whether the loss and loss adjustment expense reserves held at the year-end fall 
within a reasonable range of possible estimates. 

We considered the results of the third party actuarial review of the loss and loss adjustment  
reserves as at the reporting date, presented to the Audit Committee, again, specifically to identify 
and understand any significant differences in projections.  

In light of our work outlined above, we considered the adequacy of disclosures of the judgements 
and uncertainties being made by the Directors in the insurance risk note on page 108 and note 13 
related to loss and loss adjustment expense reserves. 

86 
86 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS 
Refer to page 53 (Audit Committee report), page 96 (accounting policy) and page 148 (disclosures) 

Risk 

  Response 

The acquisition of Cathedral in  
2013 resulted in the recognition of 
goodwill and indefinite life syndicate 
participation rights with a fair value  
of $71.2 million and $82.6 million 
respectively. During 2014 we 
considered the risk that these  
assets may be impaired. 

In testing for impairment judgement 
is applied by management in deriving: 

Management’s impairment assessment of the recorded value of goodwill and the syndicate 
participation rights was performed as at 30 September 2014. We evaluated and challenged  
this assessment, including: 

  validating that the cash flows used are consistent with the three year forecast approved by  

the Board; 

  challenging the three year plan, having regard to back testing performed by management  
to support the robustness of the forecast process and having regard to market conditions; 

  satisfied ourselves whether the pre-tax discount rate applied is appropriate by assessing the  

cost of capital for the group and comparable businesses; 

  the forecast cash flows; and 

  assessing whether long term growth assumptions are consistent with economic and industry 

  the pre-tax discount rates applied 

to those cash flows. 

forecasts; and 

  challenging the adequacy of sensitivity analysis performed by management, by re-performing 
our own stress tests of assumptions in isolation and in combination to consider reasonably 
possible alternative scenarios. 

REVENUE RECOGNITION – PREMIUM ESTIMATES 
Refer to page 53 (Audit Committee report) and page 96 (accounting policy)  

Risk 

  Response 

We evaluated and tested the key controls over the premium estimation process, which include  
the periodic review by management of estimated premiums, taking into account any third party 
information received from brokers or insureds.  

For a sample of policies we verified the year end estimated premium income, including 
considering the basis of estimation and corroborating evidence such as information from brokers. 

We have analysed the development, during the period, of estimates recognised as at 31 December 
2013 to identify if there was any indication of management bias. 

For certain contracts written, 
premium is initially recognised based 
on estimates of ultimate premiums. 
This occurs for contracts where 
pricing is based on variables which 
are not known with certainty at the 
point of binding the contract. 
Subsequent adjustments to those 
estimates, which arise as updated 
information relating to those pricing 
variables becomes available, are 
recorded in the period in which they 
are determined.  

These estimates are judgemental  
and therefore could result in 
misstatements of revenue recognised 
in the financial statements. 

SCOPE OF THE AUDIT OF THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
An audit involves obtaining evidence about the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements sufficient to give reasonable  
assurance that the financial statements are free from material misstatement, whether caused by fraud or error. This includes an  
assessment of: whether the accounting policies are appropriate to the Group’s circumstances and have been consistently applied  
and adequately disclosed; the reasonableness of significant accounting estimates made by the Directors; and the overall presentation  
of the financial statements.  

In addition, we read all the financial and non-financial information in the Annual Report and Accounts to identify material 
inconsistencies with the audited financial statements and to identify any information that is apparently materially incorrect based  
on, or materially inconsistent with, the knowledge acquired by us in the course of performing the audit. If we become aware of any 
apparent material misstatements or inconsistencies we consider the implications for our report.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

87 
87

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS’ REPORT TO THE MEMBERS OF LANCASHIRE HOLDINGS LIMITED CONTINUED 

OUR APPLICATION OF MATERIALITY  
We apply the concept of materiality both in planning and performing our audit, and in evaluating the effect of identified misstatements 
on our audit and of uncorrected misstatements, if any, on the financial statements and in forming our opinion in the Audit Report.  

When establishing our overall audit strategy, we determined a magnitude of uncorrected misstatements that we judged would be material 
for the financial statements as a whole.  

We determined materiality for the Group to be $10.0 million (2013: $10.0 million), which is approximately 5 per cent of pre-tax profit. 
This provided a basis for determining the nature, timing and extent of risk assessment procedures, identifying and assessing the risk  
of material misstatement and determining the nature, timings and extent of further audit procedures. 

On the basis of our risk assessments, together with our assessment of the Group’s overall control environment, our judgement is that 
overall performance materiality (i.e. our tolerance for misstatement in an individual account or balance) for the Group should be  
50 per cent of materiality, namely $5.0 million (2013: $5.0 million). Our objective in adopting this approach is to ensure that total 
uncorrected and undetected audit differences do not exceed our materiality of $10.0 million for the financial statements as whole. 

We evaluate any uncorrected misstatements against both the quantitative measures of materiality discussed above and in the light of  
other relevant qualitative considerations. 

We agreed with the Audit Committee that we would report to the Committee all audit differences in excess of $0.5 million  
(2013: $0.5 million), as well as differences below that threshold that, in our view, warranted reporting on qualitative grounds. 

OVERVIEW OF THE SCOPE OF OUR AUDIT  
Following our assessment of the risk of material misstatement to the Group financial statements, our audit scope focused on the  
insurance components, LUK, LICL and Cathedral, which are all subject to full scope audit procedures for the year ended 31 December 
2014. These components accounted for: 

  100 per cent of the Group’s insurance losses for the year (refer ‘Valuation of insurance contract liabilities’ risk and related audit 

response above);  

  100 per cent of the Group’s gross premiums written (refer ‘Revenue recognition – premium estimates’ risk and related audit response 

above); and 

  97 per cent of the Group’s pre-tax profit. 

Audits of these components are performed at a performance materiality level calculated by reference to a proportion of Group materiality 
appropriate to the relative scale of the component concerned, ranging from $4.0 million to $1.2 million.  

The Group audit team visited all of the full scope components, reviewing key working papers and participating in the component  
teams’ planning and execution of the audit of those risks as applicable to those components.  

RESPECTIVE RESPONSIBILITIES OF DIRECTORS AND AUDITORS  
As explained more fully in the Directors’ Responsibilities Statement set out on page 83, the Directors are responsible for the preparation 
of the consolidated financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view. Our responsibility is to audit and  
express an opinion on the consolidated financial statements in accordance with applicable law and International Standards on  
Auditing (UK and Ireland). Those standards require us to comply with the Auditing Practices Board’s Ethical Standards for Auditors.  

The Company has also instructed us to audit the section of Directors’ Remuneration Report that has been described as audited  
and state whether it has been properly prepared in accordance with the basis of preparation described therein. 

88 
88 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
OPINION ON OTHER MATTERS 
In our opinion the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report that is described as having been audited has been properly prepared  
in accordance with the basis of preparation as described therein. 

MATTERS ON WHICH WE ARE REQUIRED TO REPORT BY EXCEPTION  
We have nothing to report in respect of the following:  

Under the ISAs (UK and Ireland), we are required to report to you if, in our opinion, information in the annual report is:  

  materially inconsistent with the information in the audited financial statements; or  

  apparently materially incorrect based on, or materially inconsistent with, our knowledge of the Group acquired in the course  

of performing our audit; or  

  is otherwise misleading.  

In particular, we are required to consider whether we have identified any inconsistencies between our knowledge acquired during  
the audit and the Directors’ statement that they consider the annual report is fair, balanced and understandable and whether the  
annual report appropriately discloses those matters that we communicated to the Audit Committee which we consider should have  
been disclosed.  

Under the Listing Rules we are required to review:  

  the part of the Corporate Governance Statement relating to the Company’s compliance with the nine provisions of the UK Corporate 

Governance Code specified for our review. 

ERNST & YOUNG LLP 
London 

11 February 2015 

(1)  The maintenance and integrity of the Lancashire Holdings Limited website is the responsibility of the Directors; the work carried out by the auditors does not involve consideration of these matters  

and, accordingly, the auditors accept no responsibility for any changes that may have occurred to the financial statements since they were initially presented on the website. 

(2) Legislation in the United Kingdom governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

89 
89

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME 
For the year ended 31 December 2014 

Gross premiums written 

Outwards reinsurance premiums 

Net premiums written 

Change in unearned premiums  

Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded 

Net premiums earned 

Net investment income 

Net other investment income  

Net realised (losses) gains and impairments 

Share of profit of associates 

Other income 

Net foreign exchange (losses) gains  

Total net revenue 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 

Net insurance losses 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Other operating expenses 

Equity based compensation 

Total expenses 

Results of operating activities 

Financing costs 

Profit before tax 

Tax credit 

Profit for the year 

Profit (loss) for the year attributable to: 

Equity shareholders of LHL 

Non-controlling interests 

Profit for the year 

Other comprehensive loss to be reclassified to 
profit or loss in subsequent periods 

Net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments 

Tax provision on net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments 

Other comprehensive loss 

Total comprehensive income for the year 

Total comprehensive income (loss) attributable to: 

Equity shareholders of LHL 

Non-controlling interests 

Total comprehensive income for the year 

Earnings per share 

Basic 

Diluted 

90 
90 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Notes 

2 

2 

2 

2 

3 

3 

3 

17 

27 

2, 13 

2, 13 

2, 4 

2, 4 

5, 6, 25 

6 

7 

8 

3, 10 

10 

10 

2014 
$m

907.6

(164.8)

742.8

(37.0)

9.8

715.6

28.6

1.4

(5.9)

5.9

19.3

(0.1)

764.8

237.9

(11.4)

226.5

161.8

(8.4)

111.3

23.3

514.5

250.3

23.8

226.5

3.1

229.6

229.3

0.3

229.6

(2.2)

0.1

(2.1)

227.5

227.2

0.3

227.5

26 

26 

$1.24

$1.16

2013 
$m

679.7

(122.1)

557.6

24.3

(13.8)

568.1

25.4

1.4

12.6

9.2

4.1

21.8

642.6

250.0

(61.9)

188.1

135.1

(9.3)

85.0

16.7

415.6

227.0

8.9

218.1

3.8

221.9

222.5

(0.6)

221.9

(33.3)

0.8

(32.5)

189.4

190.0

(0.6)

189.4

$1.31

$1.17

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET 
As at 31 December 2014 

Assets 
Cash and cash equivalents 
Accrued interest receivable  
Investments  
Reinsurance assets 
– Unearned premiums on premiums ceded 
– Reinsurance recoveries 
– Other receivables  
Deferred acquisition costs  
Other receivables  
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants 
Corporation tax receivable 
Investment in associates 
Property, plant and equipment 
Intangible assets 

Total assets 

Liabilities 
Insurance contracts 
– Losses and loss adjustment expenses 
– Unearned premiums 
– Other payables 
Amounts payable to reinsurers  
Deferred acquisition costs ceded 
Other payables 
Deferred tax liability 
Interest rate swap 
Long-term debt 

Total liabilities 

Shareholders’ equity 
Share capital 
Own shares 
Share premium 
Contributed surplus 
Accumulated other comprehensive income 
Other reserves 
Retained earnings  

Total shareholders' equity attributable to equity shareholders of LHL 
Non-controlling interests 

Total shareholders’ equity 
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity 

Notes 

9, 22 

10, 11, 22 

2014 
$m

2013 
$m

303.5
7.7

1,986.9

403.0
8.9

2,016.0

12 

13 

12, 14 

15 

14 

11, 17 

18 

19, 28 

13 

20 

20, 21 

12, 21 

15 

21 

16 

22 

22 

23 

23 

10 

24 

27 

24.7
112.4

5.3
104.6

36.6
316.2

4.3
52.7

9.1
153.8

14.9
183.0

10.8
73.8

18.7
288.4

5.6
64.7
2.8
177.2

3,117.8

3,267.8

752.6

479.1
40.8

34.2
0.1

83.5
38.7

4.9
326.6

1,760.5

96.1
(43.3)

–
855.9

0.8
31.2

416.1

1,356.8
0.5
1,357.3
3,117.8

853.4
442.1
28.9
30.9
0.2
80.7
38.7
0.2
332.3

1,807.4

92.7
(36.8)

192.2
645.7
2.9
55.2

507.8

1,459.7
0.7
1,460.4
3,267.8

The consolidated financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 11 February 2015 and signed on its behalf by: 

MARTIN THOMAS 
DIRECTOR/CHAIRMAN 

ELAINE WHELAN 
DIRECTOR/CFO 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

91 
91

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accumulated 
other 
comprehensive 
income 
$m

35.4

(32.5)

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

2.9

(2.1)

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

2.4

–

189.8

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

654.4

–

–

–

(38.7)

12.8

–

–

(1.1)

–

18.3

–

–

(0.6)

(28.3)

8.1

–

–

33.1

(9.8)

–

15.5

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

855.9

0.8

Shareholders’ 
equity 
attributable 
to equity 
shareholders 
of LHL  
$m 

Non-
controlling 
interests 
$m

Total 
shareholders’ 
equity 
$m

Other 
reserves 
$m

Retained 
earnings  
$m 

57.1

610.9 

1,387.4 

–

1,387.4

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(1.9)

1.6

(18.3)

16.7

55.2

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(27.4)

–

(4.4)

(15.5)

23.3

31.2

222.5 

– 

– 

– 

– 

190.0 

198.2 

– 

(8.6)

– 

(276.7)

(276.7)

(48.9)

(48.9)

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

1.6 

– 

16.7 

507.8 

1,459.7 

229.3 

227.2 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

(25.0)

(0.6)

(6.7)

– 

(288.9)

(288.9)

(32.1)

(32.1)

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

14.1 

(9.8)

(4.4)

– 

23.3 

(0.6)

–

1.3

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

189.4

198.2

1.3

(8.6)

–

(276.7)

(48.9)

–

1.6

–

16.7

0.7

0.3

–

–

1,460.4

227.5

–

(25.0)

(0.5)

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(1.1)

(6.7)

–

(288.9)

(32.1)

14.1

(9.8)

(4.4)

–

23.3

416.1 

1,356.8 

0.5

1,357.3

92.7 

(36.8)

192.2

645.7

–

–

–

–

(192.2)

192.2

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
For the year ended 31 December 2014 

Share 
capital  
$m 

Own
 shares 
$m

Share 
premium 
$m

Contributed 
surplus 
$m

Notes 

Balance as at 31 December 2012 

84.3 

(57.1)

Total comprehensive income for the year 

Issue of shares 

Issue of shares to non-controlling 
interests 

Distributed by trust 

Shares donated to trust 

Dividends on common shares 

Dividend equivalents on warrants 

Warrant exercises – Founder 

Equity based compensation – tax 

10 

23 

27 

23 

23, 27 

 23 

 24 

24 

8 

Equity based compensation – exercises  6, 23, 24 

Equity based compensation – expense 

Balance as at 31 December 2013 

Total comprehensive income for the year 

Share premium reclassification 

Share repurchases 

Purchase of shares from non-controlling 
interests 

Distributed by trust 

Shares donated to trust 

Dividends on common shares 

Dividend equivalents on warrants 

Warrant exercises  

RSS compensation 

Equity based compensation – tax 

6 

10 

29 

23 

27 

23 

23, 27 

23 

24 

6 

8 

Equity based compensation – exercises  6, 23, 24 

Equity based compensation – expense 

6 

– 

8.4 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

–

–

–

30.1

(12.8)

–

–

3.0

–

–

–

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

(25.0)

–

21.6

(8.1)

–

–

– 

– 

– 

– 

–

–

–

–

23, 24 

3.4 

5.0

Balance as at 31 December 2014 

96.1 

(43.3)

92 
92 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
STATEMENT OF CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOWS 
For the year ended 31 December 2014 

Cash flows from operating activities 

Profit before tax 

Tax paid 

Depreciation 

Amortisation of intangible asset 

Interest expense on long-term debt 

Interest and dividend income 

Net amortisation of fixed income securities 

Equity based compensation 

Foreign exchange losses (gains)  

Share of profit of associates 

Net other investment income  

Net realised losses (gains) and impairments 

Net unrealised losses (gains) on interest rate swaps 

Changes in operational assets and liabilities 

– Insurance and reinsurance contracts 

– Other assets and liabilities 

Net cash flows from operating activities 

Cash flows from investing activities 

Interest and dividends received 

Net purchase of property, plant and equipment  

Investment in associates 

Acquisition of subsidiaries, net of cash acquired 

Purchase of investments 

Proceeds on sale of investments 

Net cash flows from investing activities 

Cash flows used in financing activities 

Interest paid 

Proceeds from issue of shares, net of share issue costs 

Dividends paid 

Share repurchases 

Warrant exercises 

RSS compensation 

Distributions by trust 

(Repurchase) issue of shares to non-controlling interests 

Net cash flows used in financing activities 

Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents 

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year 

Effect of exchange rate fluctuations on cash and cash equivalents 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year 

Notes 

5 

19 

7 

6 

17 

3 

3 

28 

23 

23 

27 

9 

2014 
$m

226.5

1.0

2.1

23.4

15.5

(50.5)

9.9

23.3

7.3

(5.9)

(1.4)

5.9

4.7

(35.5)

(13.8)

212.5

52.0

(8.7)

17.9

–

(2,153.7)

2,159.0

66.5

(15.5)

–

(321.0)

(25.0)

14.1

(9.8)

(6.7)

(1.1)

(365.0)

(86.0)

403.0

(13.5)

303.5

2013 
$m

218.1

(0.4)

1.4

13.2

13.2

(43.9)

12.9

16.7

(11.8)

(9.2)

(1.4)

(12.6)

(7.8)

(26.1)

5.4

167.7

44.4

(0.1)

26.6

(227.2)

(1,277.9)

1,521.2

87.0

(12.0)

198.2

(325.6)

–

–

–

(8.6)

1.3

(146.7)

108.0

295.8

(0.8)

403.0

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

93 
93

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ACCOUNTING POLICIES 
For the year ended 31 December 2014 

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES 
The basis of preparation, consolidation principles and significant accounting policies adopted in the preparation of LHL and the Group’s 
consolidated financial statements are set out below.  

BASIS OF PREPARATION 
The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS  
as adopted by the European Union.  

Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of the measurement of insurance products, the IFRS framework allows reference to another 
comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Group determines appropriate measurement bases, to provide  
the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using their judgement and considering U.S. GAAP.  

All amounts, excluding share data or where otherwise stated, are in millions of U.S. dollars.  

While a number of new or amended IFRS and IFRIC standards have been issued there are no standards issued that have had a material 
impact on the Group.  

IFRS 4, Insurance Contracts, issued in March 2004, specifies the financial reporting for insurance contracts by an insurer. The current 
standard is Phase I in the IASB’s insurance contract project and, as noted above, does not specify the recognition or measurement of 
insurance contracts. This will be addressed in Phase II of the IASB’s project and is expected to include a number of significant changes 
regarding the measurement and disclosure of insurance contracts. The Group will continue to monitor the progress of the project in 
order to assess the potential impacts the new standard will have on its results and the presentation and disclosure thereof.  

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement, has been issued but is not yet effective, and therefore has not yet been 
adopted by the Group. The Group continues to apply IAS 39, Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement and classifies its fixed 
income and equity securities as AFS or FVTPL. The new standard is effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018 and 
is not expected to have a material impact on the results and disclosures reported in the consolidated financial statements. It will, however, 
result in a reclassification of fixed income securities from AFS to FVTPL and a reclassification of the net change in unrealised gains and 
losses on investments from accumulated other comprehensive income to profit or loss.  

IFRS 10, Consolidated Financial Statements, issued in May 2011, redefines the principle of control and establishes control as the basis  
for determining which entities are consolidated in an entity’s financial statements. IFRS 12, Disclosure of Involvement with Other Entities, 
was issued concurrently and sets out the disclosure requirements for consolidated financial statements. Both standards were effective from 
1 January 2014 and did not have a material impact on the Group’s results or disclosure requirements. 

The consolidated balance sheet of the Group is presented in order of decreasing liquidity.  

USE OF ESTIMATES 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires the Group to make estimates and assumptions that affect  
the reported and disclosed amounts at the balance sheet date and the reported and disclosed amounts of revenues and expenses  
during the reporting period. Actual results may differ materially from the estimates made. 

The most significant estimate made by management is in relation to losses and loss adjustment expenses. This is discussed on page 97  
and also in the risk disclosures section from page 108. Estimates in relation to losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable are 
discussed on page 97. 

Estimates are also made in determining the estimated fair value of certain financial instruments and equity compensation plans. The 
estimation of the fair value of financial instruments is discussed on pages 97 and 98 and in note 10. Management judgement is applied  
in determining impairment charges. The estimation of the fair value of equity based compensation awards granted is discussed in note 6.  

Intangible assets are recognised on the acquisition of a subsidiary. The fair value of intangible assets arising from the acquisition of a 
subsidiary is largely based on the estimated expected cash flows of the business acquired and the contractual rights of that business.  
The Group determines whether indefinite life intangible assets are impaired at least on an annual basis. This requires an estimation  
of the recoverable amount of the CGU to which the intangible assets are allocated. The assumptions made by management in performing 
impairment tests of intangible assets are subject to estimation uncertainty. Details of the key assumptions used in the estimation of the 
recoverable amounts of the CGU are contained in note 19.  

94 
94 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
BASIS OF CONSOLIDATION 
The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of the Group and its subsidiaries as at 31 December 2014. Control 
is achieved when the Group is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee and has the ability to affect 
those returns through its power over the investee. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date of acquisition, being the date on which 
the Group obtains control, and continue to be consolidated until the date when such control ceases. Intercompany balances, profits and 
transactions are eliminated. The Group participates on the syndicates at Lloyd’s, which are managed by the Group’s managing agent 
subsidiary. In view of the several liability of underwriting members at Lloyd’s, the Group recognises its proportion of all the transactions 
undertaken by the syndicates in which it participates within its consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Similarly, the Group’s 
proportion of the syndicates’ assets and liabilities has been reflected in its balance sheet. This proportion is calculated by reference to  
the Group’s participation as a percentage of each syndicate’s total capacity for each year of account. 

Subsidiaries’ accounting policies are generally consistent with the Group’s accounting policies. Where they differ, adjustments are made 
on consolidation to bring accounting policies in line. 

ASSOCIATES 
Investments, in which the Group has significant influence over the operational and financial policies of the investee, are recognised at  
cost and thereafter accounted for using the equity method. Under this method, the Group records its proportionate share of income  
and loss from such investments in its statement of comprehensive income for the period. Adjustments are made to associates’ accounting 
policies, where necessary, in order to be consistent with the Group’s accounting policies. 

FOREIGN CURRENCY TRANSLATION 
The functional currency, which is the currency of the primary economic environment in which operations are conducted, for all Group 
entities is U.S. dollars. Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s entities are measured using the functional 
currency. The consolidated financial statements are also presented in U.S. dollars. 

Foreign currency transactions are recorded in the functional currency for each entity using the exchange rates prevailing at the  
dates of the transactions, or at the average rate for the period when this is a reasonable approximation. Monetary assets and liabilities 
denominated in foreign currencies are translated at period end exchange rates. The resulting exchange differences on translation  
are recorded in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Non-monetary assets and liabilities carried at historical cost 
denominated in a foreign currency are translated at historic rates. Non-monetary assets and liabilities carried at estimated fair value 
denominated in a foreign currency are translated at the exchange rate at the date the estimated fair value was determined, with resulting 
exchange differences recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity.  

BUSINESS COMBINATIONS 
Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method. The cost of an acquisition is measured as the aggregate of the fair 
value of consideration transferred at the acquisition date. On acquisition of a business the Group assesses the financial assets acquired and 
liabilities assumed for appropriate classification and designation in accordance with the contractual terms, economic circumstances and 
pertinent conditions at the acquisition date. Unpaid loss reserves and loss reserves recoverable assumed through a business combination 
are initially measured at fair value, using an applicable risk-free discount rate and having regard to the expected settlement dates of the 
claims. Unearned premiums and unearned premiums ceded acquired through a business combination are initially measured in 
accordance with the Group’s existing accounting policies. The difference between the acquired amount and the fair value of these assets 
and liabilities is recognised as a separately identifiable intangible asset and recorded as the value of in-force business. Other identifiable 
assets acquired and liabilities and contingent liabilities assumed, which meet the conditions for recognition under IFRS 3, Business 
Combinations, are recognised at their fair value at the acquisition date. The excess of the fair value of consideration transferred over  
the fair value of the Group’s share of the identifiable net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. Costs directly related to an acquisition  
are expensed in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income when incurred. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

95 
95

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
ACCOUNTING POLICIES CONTINUED 

INTANGIBLE ASSETS 
The cost of intangible assets acquired in a business combination is their fair value as at the date of acquisition. Following initial 
recognition, intangible assets are carried at cost less any accumulated amortisation and any accumulated impairment losses. The useful 
lives of intangible assets are assessed to be either finite or indefinite depending on the nature of the asset. Intangible assets with finite  
lives are amortised over the useful economic life and assessed for impairment whenever there is an indication that the intangible asset  
may be impaired. Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are tested for impairment at least annually at the CGU level by comparing 
the net present value of the future earnings stream of the CGU to the carrying value of the intangible asset and the related net assets.  
Such intangibles are not amortised. The useful life of an intangible asset with an indefinite life is reviewed annually to determine whether  
the indefinite life assessment continues to be supportable. 

GOODWILL 
Goodwill is deemed to have an indefinite life and, after initial recognition, is measured at cost less any accumulated impairment  
losses. Goodwill is tested for impairment annually, or when events or changes in circumstance indicate that it might be impaired.  

SYNDICATE PARTICIPATION RIGHTS 
Syndicate participation rights purchased in a business combination are initially measured at fair value and are subsequently measured  
at cost less any impairment. Syndicate participation rights are considered to have an indefinite life as they will provide benefits over an 
indefinite future period and are therefore not subject to an annual amortisation charge. The value of the syndicate participation rights  
is reviewed for impairment at least annually. 

VALUE OF IN-FORCE BUSINESS 
The value of in-force business acquired in a business combination is initially recognised as the difference between the fair value of the  
net unearned premiums acquired and the measurement of the net unearned premiums acquired using the Group’s existing accounting 
policies. The value of in-force business has a finite useful life and subsequent to initial recognition it is carried at cost less accumulated 
amortisation and is amortised over the remaining life of the acquired insurance contracts. The portion of the value of in-force business 
which replaced the deferred acquisition costs carried on Cathedral’s historical balance sheet was amortised in net acquisition costs in  
the statement of comprehensive income. The remaining amortisation was charged to other operating expenses.  

INSURANCE CONTRACTS 
CLASSIFICATION 
Insurance contracts are those contracts that transfer significant insurance risk at the inception of the contract. Contracts that do  
not transfer significant insurance risk are accounted for as investment contracts. Insurance risk is transferred when an insurer agrees  
to compensate a policyholder if a specified uncertain future event adversely affects the policyholder.  

PREMIUMS AND ACQUISITION COSTS 
Premiums are first recognised as written at the later of a contract’s binding or inception date. The Group writes both excess of loss and 
pro-rata (proportional) contracts. For the majority of excess of loss contracts, premiums written are recorded based on the minimum  
and deposit or flat premium, as defined in the contract. Subsequent adjustments to the minimum and deposit premium are recognised  
in the period in which they are determined. For pro-rata contracts and excess of loss contracts where no deposit is specified in the 
contract, premiums written are recognised based on estimates of ultimate premiums provided by the insureds or ceding companies.  
Initial estimates of premiums written are recognised in the period in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract  
is bound if later. Subsequent adjustments, based on reports of actual premium by the insureds or ceding companies, or revisions in 
estimates, are recorded in the period in which they are determined.  

Premiums written are earned rateably over the term of the underlying risk period of the insurance contract, except where the period of 
risk differs significantly from the contract period. In these circumstances, premiums are recognised over the period of risk in proportion 
to the amount of insurance protection provided. The portion of the premium related to the unexpired portion of the risk period is 
reflected in unearned premiums. 

Where contract terms require the reinstatement of coverage after an insured’s or ceding company’s loss, the estimated mandatory 
reinstatement premiums are recorded as premiums written when a specific loss event occurs. Reinstatement premiums are not recorded 
for losses included within the provision for IBNR which do not relate to a specific loss event. 

96 
96 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants are recorded net of commissions, brokerage, premium taxes and other levies  
on premiums, unless the contract specifies otherwise. These balances are reviewed for impairment, with any impairment loss recognised  
as an expense in the period in which it is determined.  

Acquisition costs represent commissions, brokerage, profit commissions and other variable costs that relate directly to the successful 
securing of new contracts and the renewing of existing contracts. They are generally deferred over the period in which the related 
premiums are earned to the extent they are recoverable out of expected future revenue margins. All other acquisition costs are  
recognised as an expense when incurred.  

OUTWARDS REINSURANCE  
Outwards reinsurance premiums comprise the cost of reinsurance contracts entered into. Outwards reinsurance premiums are accounted 
for in the period in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract is bound if later. The provision for reinsurers’ share  
of unearned premiums represents that part of reinsurance premiums ceded which are estimated to be earned in future financial periods. 
Unearned reinsurance commissions are recognised as a liability using the same principles.  

Any amounts recoverable from reinsurers are estimated using the same methodology as the underlying losses. The Group monitors  
the creditworthiness of its reinsurers on an ongoing basis and assesses any reinsurance assets for impairment, with any impairment  
loss recognised as an expense in the period in which it is determined.  

LOSSES 
Losses comprise losses and loss adjustment expenses paid in the period and changes in the provision for outstanding losses, including  
the provision for IBNR and related expenses. Losses and loss adjustment expenses are charged to income as they are incurred.  

A portion of the Group’s business is in classes with high attachment points of coverage, including property catastrophe excess of loss. 
Reserving for losses in such programmes is inherently complicated in that losses in excess of the attachment level of the Group’s policies 
are characterised by high severity and low frequency and other factors which could vary significantly as losses are settled. This limits the 
volume of industry loss experience available from which to reliably predict ultimate losses following a loss event.  

Losses and loss adjustment expenses represent the estimated ultimate cost of settling all losses and loss adjustment expenses arising from 
events which have occurred up to the balance sheet date, including a provision for IBNR. The Group does not discount its liabilities for 
unpaid losses. Outstanding losses are initially set on the basis of reports of losses received from third parties. ACRs are determined where 
the Group’s best estimate of the reported loss is greater than that reported. Estimated IBNR reserves may also consist of a provision for 
additional development in excess of losses reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for losses which have occurred 
but which have not yet been reported by insureds or ceding companies. IBNR reserves are set on a best estimate basis and are estimated  
by management using various actuarial methods as well as a combination of own loss experience, historical insurance industry loss 
experience, underwriters’ experience, estimates of pricing adequacy trends and management’s professional judgement.  

The estimation of the ultimate liability arising is a complex process which incorporates a significant amount of judgement. It is reasonably 
possible that uncertainties inherent in the reserving process, delays in insureds or ceding companies reporting losses to the Group, 
together with the potential for unforeseen adverse developments, could lead to a material change in losses and loss adjustment expenses.  

LIABILITY ADEQUACY TESTS 
At each balance sheet date, the Group performs a liability adequacy test using current best estimates of future cash outflows generated  
by its insurance contracts, plus any investment income thereon. If, as a result of these tests, the carrying amount of the Group’s insurance 
liabilities is found to be inadequate, the deficiency is charged to income for the period, initially by writing off deferred acquisition costs 
and subsequently by establishing a provision.  

FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS 
Cash and cash equivalents are carried in the consolidated balance sheet at amortised cost and include cash in hand, deposits held on  
call with banks and other short-term highly liquid investments with a maturity of three months or less at the date of purchase. Carrying 
amounts approximate fair value due to the short-term nature and high liquidity of the instruments.  

Interest income earned on cash and cash equivalents is recognised on the effective interest rate method. The carrying value of accrued 
interest income approximates estimated fair value due to its short-term nature and high liquidity. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

97 
97

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
ACCOUNTING POLICIES CONTINUED 

INVESTMENTS  
The Group’s fixed income and equity securities are quoted investments that are classified as AFS or at FVTPL and are carried at estimated 
fair value. The classification is determined at the time of initial purchase and depends on the category of investment. Fixed income 
investments in principal protected equity linked notes are designated as at FVTPL.  

The Group’s hedge funds are unquoted investments classified at FVTPL and are carried at estimated fair value. Estimated fair values are 
determined using a combination of the most recent NAVs provided by each fund’s independent administrator and the estimated 
performance provided by each hedge fund manager. 

Regular way purchases and sales of investments are recognised at estimated fair value including transaction costs on the trade date and  
are subsequently carried at estimated fair value. The estimated fair values of quoted investments are determined based on bid prices  
from recognised exchanges, broker-dealers, recognised indices or pricing vendors. Investments are derecognised when the Group  
has transferred substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership. Realised gains and losses are included in income in the period  
in which they arise. Unrealised gains and losses from changes in estimated fair value of AFS investments are included in accumulated 
other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity.  

On derecognition of an investment, previously recorded unrealised gains and losses are removed from accumulated other comprehensive 
income in shareholders’ equity and included in current period income. Changes in estimated fair value of investments classified as at 
FVTPL are recognised in current period income. 

Amortisation and accretion of premiums and discounts on AFS fixed income securities are calculated using the effective interest rate 
method and are recognised in current period net investment income. Interest income is recognised on the effective interest rate method. 
The carrying value of accrued interest income approximates estimated fair value due to its short-term nature and high liquidity. Dividends 
on equity securities are recorded as revenue on the date the dividends become payable to the holders of record. 

The Group regularly reviews the carrying value of its AFS investments for evidence of impairment. An investment is impaired if its  
carrying value exceeds the estimated fair value and there is objective evidence of impairment to the asset. Such evidence would include  
a prolonged decline in estimated fair value below cost or amortised cost, where other factors, such as expected cash flows, do not support 
a recovery in value. If an impairment is deemed appropriate, the difference between cost or amortised cost and estimated fair value is 
removed from accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity and charged to current period income. Impairment 
losses on fixed income securities may be subsequently reversed through income while impairment losses on equity securities are not 
subsequently reversed through income. 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 
Derivatives are recognised at estimated fair value on the date a contract is entered into, the trade date, and are subsequently carried at 
estimated fair value. Derivative instruments with a positive estimated fair value are recorded as derivative financial assets and those with  
a negative estimated fair value are recorded as derivative financial liabilities.  

Derivative financial instruments include exchange-traded future and option contracts, forward foreign currency contracts, interest rate 
swaps, credit default swaps and interest rate swaptions. They derive their value from the underlying instrument and are subject to the  
same risks as that underlying instrument, including liquidity, credit and market risk. Estimated fair values are based on exchange or 
broker-dealer quotations, where available, or discounted cash flow models, which incorporate the pricing of the underlying instrument, 
yield curves and other factors. Changes in the estimated fair value of instruments that do not qualify for hedge accounting are recognised 
in current period income. The Group does currently not hold any derivatives classified as hedging instruments. For discounted cash  
flow techniques, estimated future cash flows are based on management’s best estimates and the discount rate used is an appropriate 
market rate. 

Derivative financial assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount is reported in the consolidated balance sheet only to the  
extent there is a legally enforceable right of offset and there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realise the assets and liabilities 
simultaneously. Derivative financial assets and liabilities are derecognised when the Group has transferred substantially all of the risks  
and rewards of ownership or the liability is discharged, cancelled or expired. 

OTHER INCOME 
Managing agent’s fees and commissions and underwriting service fees are recognised in line with services provided. Contingent  
profit commissions are recognised when it is virtually certain that they will be realised. 

LONG-TERM DEBT 
Long-term debt is recognised initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Thereafter it is held at amortised cost, with the 
amortisation calculated using the effective interest rate method. Derecognition occurs when the obligation has been extinguished. 

98 
98 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT 
Property, plant and equipment is carried at historical cost, less accumulated depreciation and any impairment in value. Depreciation  
is calculated to write off the cost over the estimated useful economic life on a straight-line basis as follows: 

IT equipment 

Office furniture and equipment 
Leasehold improvements 

33% per annum  

20% to 33% per annum  
20% per annum 

The assets’ residual values, useful lives and depreciation methods are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date. 

An item of property, plant or equipment is derecognised on disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from  
the continued use of the asset.  

Gains and losses on the disposal of property, plant and equipment are determined by comparing proceeds with the carrying amount  
of the asset, and are included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Costs for repairs and maintenance are charged  
to income as incurred. 

LEASES 
Rentals payable under operating leases are charged to income on a straight-line basis over the lease term. 

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS 
EQUITY COMPENSATION PLANS 
The Group currently operates an RSS under which nil-cost options have been granted. The Group has also operated a management 
warrant plan and an LTIP option plan in the past. The fair value of the equity instruments granted is estimated on the date of grant.  
The estimated fair value is recognised as an expense pro-rata over the vesting period of the instrument, adjusted for the impact of any  
non-market vesting conditions. No adjustment to vesting assumptions is made in respect of market vesting conditions.  

At each balance sheet date, the Group revises its estimate of the number of RSS nil-cost options that are expected to become exercisable.  
It recognises the impact of the revision of original estimates, if any, in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, and a  
corresponding adjustment is made to other reserves in shareholders’ equity over the remaining vesting period.  

On exercise, the differences between the expense charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income and the actual cost  
to the Group, if any, is transferred to contributed surplus. Where new shares are issued, the proceeds received are credited to share  
capital and share premium. 

PENSIONS 
The Group operates a defined contribution plan. On payment of contributions to the plan there is no further obligation for the Group. 
Contributions are recognised as employee benefits in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income in the period to which they relate. 

TAX 
Income tax represents the sum of the tax currently payable and any deferred tax. The tax payable is calculated based on taxable profit  
for the period. Taxable profit for the period can differ from that reported in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income due  
to certain items which are not tax deductible or which are deferred to subsequent periods. 

Deferred tax is recognised on all temporary differences between the assets and liabilities in the consolidated balance sheet and their tax 
base, except when the deferred tax liability arises from the initial recognition of goodwill. Deferred tax assets or liabilities are accounted 
for using the balance sheet liability method. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through 
future taxable profits is likely.  

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets against current tax liabilities 
and when the deferred income taxes relate to the same fiscal authority. 

Where the current estimated fair value of equity based compensation awards exceeds the estimated fair value at the time of grant, adjusted 
where applicable for dividends, the related corporation tax and deferred tax charge or credit is recognised directly in other reserves. 

OWN SHARES 
Own shares include shares repurchased under share repurchase authorisations and held in treasury plus shares repurchased and held in trust  
for the purposes of employee equity based compensation schemes. Own shares are deducted from shareholders' equity. No gain or loss is 
recognised on the purchase, sale, cancellation or issue of own shares and any consideration paid or received is recognised directly in equity. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

99 
99

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES 
For the year ended 31 December 2014 

RISK DISCLOSURES: INTRODUCTION 
The Group is exposed to risks from several sources. These include insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, operational  
risk and strategic risk. The primary risk to the Group is insurance risk.  

The primary objective of the Group’s ERM is to ensure that the capital resources held are matched to the risk profile of the Group and 
that the balance between risk and reward is considered as part of all key business decisions. The Group has formulated, and keeps under 
review, a risk appetite which is set by the Board of Directors. The Group’s appetite for risk will vary marginally from time to time to reflect 
the potential risks and rewards that present themselves. However, protecting the Group’s capital and providing investors with a superior 
risk-adjusted return over the long term are constants. The risk appetite of the Group is central to how the business is run and permeates 
into the risk appetites that the individual operating entity Boards of Directors have adopted. These risk appetites are expressed through 
detailed risk tolerances at both a Group and an operating entity level. Risk tolerances represent the maximum amount of capital, generally 
on a modeled basis, that the Group and its entities are prepared to expose to certain risks.  

The Board of Directors is responsible for setting and monitoring the Group’s risk appetite and tolerances, whereas the individual  
entity Boards of Directors are responsible for setting and monitoring entity level risk tolerances. All risk tolerances are subject to at least 
 an annual review and consideration by the respective Boards of Directors. The LHL and individual entity Boards of Directors review 
actual risk levels versus tolerances, emerging risks and any risk learning events at least quarterly. In addition, on at least a monthly basis, 
management reviews the output from BLAST in order to assess modeled potential losses against risk tolerances and ensure that risk  
levels are managed in accordance with them. 

RISK AND RETURN COMMITTEE 
The RRC seeks to optimise risk-adjusted return and facilitate the appropriate use of the Internal Model, including considering its 
effectiveness. It ensures that all key areas of risk are discussed according to a schedule that covers fortnightly, monthly, quarterly,  
semi-annual and annual reviews. The RRC meets fortnightly and is responsible for coordinating and overseeing ERM activities within  
the risk profile, appetites and tolerances set by the Group and individual entity Boards of Directors. The RRC includes the Group CEO 
and members from the finance, actuarial and underwriting functions and includes representation from Cathedral. The CRO attends the 
meetings and reports on the RRC’s activities to the Group and individual entity Boards of Directors and the Risk Committee of Cathedral.  

CHIEF RISK OFFICER 
The primary role of the CRO is to facilitate the effective operation of ERM throughout the Group at all levels. The role includes but  
is not limited to the following responsibilities: 

  drive ERM culture, ownership and execution on three levels: Board, executive management, and operationally within the business; 

  facilitate the identification, assessment and evaluation of existing and emerging risks by management and the Board; 

  ensure that these risks are given due consideration and are embedded within management’s and the Board’s oversight and decision 

making process; 

  be consulted, and opine on, policy in areas such as, but not limited to, underwriting, claims, investments, operations and capital 

management; and 

  provide timely, accurate, reliable, factual, objective and accessible information and analysis to guide, coach and support  

decision making.  

Responsibility for the management of individual risks has been assigned to, and may form part of the performance objectives of, the  
risk owners within the business. Risk owners ensure that these risks and controls are consistent with their day-to-day processes and the 
entries made in the Group risk registers, which are a direct input into BLAST. The CRO provides regular reports to the business outlining 
the status of the Group’s ERM activities and strategy, as well as formal reports to the Boards of Directors of the Group and the individual 
operating entities in this regard including the Risk Committee of Cathedral. The CRO ultimately has the right to report directly to the 
Group and entity regulators if he feels that management is not appropriately addressing areas of concern. 

100 
100 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
INTERNAL AUDIT 
Internal Audit plays a key role in the Group’s ERM by providing an independent opinion regarding the accuracy and completeness  
of risks, in addition to verification of the effectiveness of controls and the consistency of their operation. Internal Audit’s roles and 
responsibilities are clearly defined through the Internal Audit Charter. The Head of Internal Audit reports directly to the Group  
Audit Committee. The CRO receives a copy of each Internal Audit report and considers the findings and agreed actions in the context  
of the risk appetites and tolerances, plus the risk policies and risk management strategy of each area. The integration of Internal Audit 
and ERM into the business helps facilitate the Group’s protection of its assets and reputation.  

ECONOMIC CAPITAL MODEL 
The foundation of the Lancashire Companies and Kinesis’ risk-based capital approach to decision making is its economic capital model, 
BLAST, which is based on the widely accepted economic capital modeling tool, ReMetrica. Management uses BLAST primarily for 
monitoring its insurance risks. However, BLAST is also used to monitor other risks including market, credit and operational risks.  

BLAST produces data in the form of a stochastic distribution for all classes, including non-elemental classes. The distribution includes  
the mean outcome and the result at various return periods, including very remote events. BLAST calculates projected financial outcomes 
for each insurance class, as well as the overall portfolio including diversification credit. Diversification credit arises as individual risks are 
generally not strongly correlated and are unlikely to all produce profits or losses at the same time. BLAST also measures the Group’s 
aggregate insurance exposures. It therefore helps senior management and the Board of Directors to determine the level of capital 
required to meet the combined risk from a wide range of categories. Assisted by BLAST, the Group seeks to achieve an improved  
risk-adjusted return over time. 

BLAST is used in strategic underwriting decisions, as part of the Group’s annual business planning process and to assist in portfolio 
optimisation, taking account of inwards business and all major reinsurance purchases. Management also utilises BLAST in assessing  
the impact of strategic decisions on individual classes of business that the Group writes, or is considering writing, as well as the overall 
resulting financial impact to the Group. BLAST output, covering all of the risk groups to which the Group is exposed, is reviewed, 
including the anticipated loss curves, combined ratios and risk-adjusted profitability, to determine profitability and risk tolerance 
headroom by class.  

BLAST covers the risks for LICL, LUK and Kinesis but does not cover Cathedral’s risk. Owing to the particular requirements of Lloyd’s 
regulations, Cathedral has its own Internal Model which is vetted by Lloyd’s as part of its own capital and solvency regulations. To 
formulate an overall Group view of risk, exposures from Cathedral are combined with LICL, LUK and Kinesis using Lancashire’s 
proprietary internal models.  

The six primary risk categories, insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, operational risk and strategic risk, are discussed  
in detail on pages 102 to 126. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

101 
101

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

A. INSURANCE RISK 
The Group underwrites worldwide, predominantly short-tail, insurance and reinsurance contracts that transfer insurance risk, including 
risks exposed to both natural and man-made catastrophes. The Group’s exposure in connection with insurance contracts is, in the event  
of insured losses, whether premiums will be sufficient to cover the loss payments and expenses. Insurance and reinsurance markets are 
cyclical and premium rates and terms and conditions vary by line of business depending on market conditions and the stage of the cycle. 
Market conditions are impacted by capacity and recent loss events, and broader economic cycle impacts amongst other factors. The 
Group’s underwriters assess likely losses using their experience and knowledge of past loss experience, industry trends and current 
circumstances. This allows them to estimate the premiums sufficient to meet likely losses and expenses and desired levels of profitability 
consistent with the Group’s risk-adjusted RoE targets.  

The Group considers insurance risk at an individual contract level, at a sector level, a geographic level and at an aggregate portfolio level. This 
ensures careful risk selection, limits on concentration and appropriate portfolio diversification are accomplished. The four principle classes of 
business for the Group, excluding the Lloyd’s segment, are Property, Energy, Marine and Aviation. These classes, plus the Group’s Lloyd’s segment, 
are deemed to be the Group’s five operating segments. The level of insurance risk tolerance per peril is set by the respective Boards of Directors at 
both the LHL and entity level. 

A number of controls are deployed to manage the amount of insurance exposure assumed: 

  the Group has a rolling three-year strategic plan that helps establish the over-riding business goals that the Board of Directors aims  

to achieve; 

  a detailed business plan is produced annually which includes expected premiums and combined ratios by class and considers risk-
adjusted profitability, capital usage and requirements. The plan is approved by the Board of Directors and is monitored, reviewed 
 and updated on an ongoing basis; 

  for Cathedral the Syndicate Budget Forecast and Business Plan are subject to review and approval by Lloyd’s; 

  BLAST and SHARP are used to measure occurrence risks, aggregate risks and correlations between classes and other non-insurance 

risks, and the outputs and assumptions are reviewed periodically by the RRC; 

  each authorised class has a predetermined normal maximum line structure; 

  each underwriter has a clearly defined limit of underwriting authority; 

  the Group and individual operating entities have predetermined tolerances on probabilistic and deterministic losses of capital  

for certain single events; 

  risk levels versus tolerances are monitored on a regular basis; 

  a daily underwriting call is held for LICL and LUK to peer review insurance proposals, opportunities and emerging risks;  

  a daily post-binding review process with exception reporting to management based on underwriting authority operates at Cathedral; 

  sophisticated pricing and aggregation models are utilised in certain areas of the underwriting process, and are updated frequently; 

  BLAST and other modeling tools are deployed to model catastrophes and resultant losses to the portfolio and the Group; and 

  reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate both frequency and severity of losses on a treaty or facultative basis and to improve  

risk-adjusted RoE as modeled in BLAST. 

Some of the Group’s business provides coverage for natural catastrophes (e.g. hurricanes, earthquakes and floods) and is subject  
to potential seasonal variation. A proportion of the Group's business is exposed to large catastrophe losses in North America, Europe  
and Japan as a result of windstorms. The level of windstorm activity, and landfall thereof, during the North American, European and 
Japanese wind seasons may materially impact the Group's loss experience. The North American and Japanese wind seasons are typically 
June to November and the European wind season November to March. The Group also bears exposure to large losses arising from other 
non-seasonal natural catastrophes, such as earthquakes, tsunamis, droughts, floods and tornadoes, from risk losses throughout the year 
and from war, terrorism and political risk and other events. The Group’s associate bears exposure to catastrophe losses and any significant 
loss event could potentially result in impairment in the value of the Group’s investment in associates. 

102 
102 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
The Group’s exposures to certain peak zone elemental losses, as a percentage of tangible capital, including long-term debt, are  
shown below. Net loss estimates are before income tax and net of reinstatement premiums and outwards reinsurance. The exposure  
to catastrophe losses that would result in an impairment in the investment in associates is included in the figures below. 

As at 31 December 2014 

Zones 
Gulf of Mexico1 

Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S. 

California 

Pan-European 

Japan 

Japan 

Pacific North West 

(1) Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas. 

As at 31 December 2013 

Zones 
Gulf of Mexico1 

Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S. 

California 

Pan-European 

Japan 

Japan 

Pacific North West 

(1) Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas. 

100 year return period  
estimated net loss 

250 year return period  
estimated net loss 

$m  % of tangible capital 

$m  % of tangible capital

254.2

254.0

154.8

133.2

116.0

61.2

39.5

16.6 

16.6 

10.1 

8.7 

7.6 

4.0 

2.6 

377.2

455.8

247.5

205.0

184.8

94.6

123.3

24.7

29.8

16.2

13.4

12.1

6.2

8.1

100 year return period estimated net loss 

250 year return period estimated net loss 

$m  % of tangible capital 

$m  % of tangible capital

307.6

227.8

130.6

210.7

154.8

132.9

49.4

19.0 

14.1 

8.1 

13.0 

9.6 

8.2 

3.1 

440.2

451.4

239.0

319.3

266.9

249.0

176.4

27.3

28.0

14.8

19.8

16.5

15.4

10.9

Perils 

Hurricane 

Hurricane 

Earthquake 

Windstorm 

Earthquake 

Typhoon 

Earthquake 

Perils 

Hurricane 

Hurricane 

Earthquake 

Windstorm 

Earthquake 

Typhoon 

Earthquake 

There can be no guarantee that the modeled assumptions and techniques deployed in calculating these figures are accurate. There  
could also be an unmodeled loss which exceeds these figures. In addition, any modeled loss scenario could cause a larger loss to capital 
than the modeled expectation. 

Details of annual gross premiums written by geographic area of risks insured are provided below:  

Worldwide offshore 

Europe 

U.S. and Canada 

Far East 

Middle East 
Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1 
Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2 

Rest of world 

Total 

2014 

$m

287.4

221.7

172.5

59.6

42.7

23.2

9.5

91.0

907.6

% 

31.7 

24.4 

19.0 

6.6 

4.7 

2.6 

1.0 

10.0 

100.0 

2013 

$m

253.3

38.4

101.5

39.9

16.7

151.0

19.4

59.5

679.7

%

37.3

5.6

14.9

5.9

2.5

22.2

2.9

8.7

100.0

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.  

(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

103 
103

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

Details of annual gross premiums written by business segment are provided below: 

Lloyd’s 

Property 

Energy 

Marine 

Aviation 

Total 

 2014 

$m

284.3

263.0

239.4

67.7

53.2

907.6

% 

31.3 

28.9 

26.4 

7.5 

5.9 

100.0 

 2013 

$m

24.5

333.4

209.9

63.0

48.9

679.7

%

3.6

49.0

30.9

9.3

7.2

100.0

Further details of the gross premiums written and the risks associated with each of these five principal business segments are described  
on the following pages. 

I. LLOYD’S 
Gross premiums written, for the year:  

Property reinsurance 

Property direct and facultative 

Marine cargo 

Aviation and satellite  

Energy 

Contingency 

Terrorism 

Total 

2014
$m

104.3

80.7

37.5

27.6

25.9

4.8

3.5

284.3

2013 
$m

3.4

13.0

5.0

2.6

–

0.5

–

24.5

Property reinsurance predominantly includes property catastrophe excess of loss, per risk excess of loss and property retrocession lines of 
business. Property catastrophe excess of loss and per risk excess of loss provide protection for elemental and non-elemental risks and are 
written on an excess of loss treaty basis within the U.S. and internationally. The U.S. property catastrophe excess of loss book is particularly 
focused on regional clients. Property retrocession is written on an excess of loss basis through treaty arrangements. It provides coverage 
for elemental risks when sold on a catastrophe basis and both elemental and non-elemental risks when sold on a per risk retrocession 
basis. Protection is generally given on a regional basis and may cover specific property risks or all catastrophe perils. It is also generally 
written on an UNL basis, meaning loss payments are linked to the ceding company’s own loss. 

Property direct and facultative is a worldwide book of largely commercial property business, written both in the open market and under 
delegated authorities. The account spans small individual locations to Fortune 500 accounts but with a bias towards small to medium  
sized risks. Policies are generally provided both for non-elemental and elemental perils, although not all risks include both elemental  
and non-elemental coverage. Coverage is generally written on a full value, primary or excess of loss basis, although the very largest 
accounts are currently seldom written at the primary level.  

Marine cargo is an international account and is written either on a direct basis or by way of reinsurance. It covers the (re)insurance of 
commodities or goods in transit. Typically, transit cover is provided on an all-risks basis for marine perils for the full value of the goods 
concerned, although higher value or capacity business may be written on a layered basis. Static cover is also provided for losses to cargo, 
from both elemental and non-elemental causes, whilst static at points along its route. In addition, the cargo account can include specie 
and fine art, vault risks, artwork on exhibition and marine war business relating to cargo in transit.  

Aviation and satellite includes aviation reinsurance, aviation war, general aviation and aviation satellite lines of business. Aviation 
reinsurance provides excess of loss catastrophe cover to the insurers of the world’s major airlines and aircraft and aircraft manufacturers. 
This includes cover for the aircraft themselves as well as losses arising from passenger and third party liability claims against airlines 
and/or manufacturers. Aviation war covers loss or damage to aviation assets from war, terrorism and similar causes. General aviation 
covers fixed wing and rotor wing aircraft typically with 50 passenger seats or less and covers both commercial and private clients. A 
significant part of the aviation satellite account is written through Satec, a specialist underwriting agency, to which underwriting authority 
is delegated. Satellite insurance is purchased by launch operators, satellite manufacturers and satellite operators to protect against launch 
or deployment failure or subsequent failure in orbit. Policies are typically written for launch plus one year in orbit. Thereafter orbit cover 
is normally provided on an annual basis.  

104 
104 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
Energy risks are written mostly on a direct basis and may be ground-up or for primary or excess layers on either a first loss or full value 
basis. Worldwide offshore energy policies are typically package policies which may include physical damage, well control, business 
interruption and third-party liability sections. Coverage can include fire and explosion and elemental risks. Individual assets covered  
can be high-value and are therefore mostly written on a subscription basis, meaning that coverage is placed with multiple underwriters. 
Construction energy contracts generally cover all risks of platforms, FPSO and drilling units under construction at yard and offshore, 
during towing and installation. Onshore construction contracts are generally not written.  

Contingency focuses on the sports, leisure and entertainment industries, with a significant emphasis on the music industry. It provides 
coverage for non-appearance and event cancellation. Generally business is written on a full value basis. 

Terrorism business can be written either ground-up or for primary or excess layers, with cover provided for U.S. and worldwide property 
risks, but typically excluding nuclear, chemical and biological coverage in most territories. Cover is generally provided to medium to large 
commercial and industrial enterprises. Policies are typically written for scheduled locations and exposure is controlled by setting limits  
on aggregate exposure within a ‘blast zone’ radius. The term of these contracts may be multi-year reflecting the term of the underlying 
exposures. Reinsurance may be purchased on a facultative or treaty basis. 

II. PROPERTY 
Gross premiums written, for the year: 

Property catastrophe excess of loss 

Terrorism 

Property political risk 

Property retrocession 

Property direct and facultative 

Other property 

Total 

2014 
$m

124.2

55.2

44.4

18.1

1.0

20.1

2013 
$m

97.5

67.8

66.4

80.8

10.0

10.9

263.0

333.4

Property catastrophe excess of loss covers elemental risks and is written on an excess of loss treaty basis. The property catastrophe excess  
of loss portfolio is written within the U.S. and also internationally. Cover is offered for specific perils and regions or countries.  

Terrorism business can be written either ground-up or for primary or excess layers, with cover provided for U.S. and worldwide property 
risks, but typically excluding nuclear, chemical and biological coverage in most territories. Cover is generally provided to medium to large 
commercial and industrial enterprises. Policies are typically written for scheduled locations and exposure is controlled by setting limits  
on aggregate exposure within a ‘blast zone’ radius. The term of these contracts is often multi-year reflecting the term of the underlying 
exposures. Some national pools are also written, which may include nuclear, chemical and biological coverage and may have an element 
of life coverage. 

Property political risk cover is written either ground-up or on an excess of loss basis. Coverage that the Group provides in the political  
risk book is split between confiscation perils coverage and sovereign/quasi-sovereign obligor coverage. Confiscation perils coverage 
protects against CEND (Confiscation, Expropriation, Nationalisation, and Deprivation) and may be extended to include other perils. 
Sovereign/quasi-sovereign obligors coverage protects against the non-payment or non-honouring of an obligation by a sovereign or  
quasi-sovereign entity. Cover is provided to medium to large commercial and industrial clients as well as bank and commodity trading 
clients. The term of these contracts is often multi-year reflecting the term of the underlying exposures. The Group does not provide  
cover against purely private obligor credit risk. 

Property retrocession is written on an excess of loss basis through treaty arrangements and covers elemental risks. Cover may be on a 
worldwide or regional basis and may cover specific risks or all catastrophe perils. Coverage may be given on a UNL basis, meaning that  
loss payments are linked directly to the ceding company’s own loss, or on an ILW basis, meaning that loss payments are linked to the 
overall industry insured loss as measured by independent third-party loss index providers. 

A small number of property direct and facultative risks continue to be written with modest lines mostly to support client relationships  
in other classes of business. Cover is generally provided to medium to large commercial and industrial enterprises with high-value 
locations for non-elemental perils, including fire and explosion, and elemental (natural catastrophe) perils which can include flood, 
windstorm, earthquake, brush fire, tsunami and tornado.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

105 
105

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The Group is exposed to large natural catastrophe losses, such as windstorm and earthquake loss, primarily from assuming property 
catastrophe excess of loss and property retrocession portfolio risks. Exposure to such events is controlled and measured by setting limits 
on aggregate exposures in certain classes per geographic zone and through loss modeling. The accuracy of the latter exposure analysis  
is limited by the quality of data and the effectiveness of the modeling. It is possible that a catastrophic event significantly exceeds the 
expected modeled event loss. The Group’s appetite and exposure guidelines for large losses are set out on pages 102 and 103.  

Reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate exposures to large natural catastrophe losses in the U.S., Canada and worldwide with certain 
exclusions. Reinsurance may also be purchased to reduce the Group’s worldwide exposure to large risk losses. Reinsurance is typically 
purchased on an excess of loss basis, however ILWs or quota share arrangements may be entered into. 

III. ENERGY 
Gross premiums written, for the year:  

Worldwide offshore energy 

Gulf of Mexico offshore energy 

Energy liabilities 

Construction energy 

Other energy 

Total 

2014 
$m

149.9

69.9

8.5

6.5

4.6

239.4

2013 
$m

149.2

34.4

8.8

12.9

4.6

209.9

Energy risks are written mostly on a direct basis and may be ground-up or for primary or excess layers on either a first loss or full value 
basis. Worldwide offshore energy policies are typically package policies which may include physical damage, business interruption and 
third-party liability sections. Coverage can include fire and explosion and elemental risks. Individual assets covered can be high-value  
and are therefore mostly written on a subscription basis, meaning that coverage is placed with multiple underwriters. 

Gulf of Mexico offshore energy programmes cover elemental and non-elemental risks. Most policies have sub-limits on coverage for 
elemental losses. These programmes are exposed to Gulf of Mexico windstorms. Exposure to such events is controlled and measured 
through loss modeling. The accuracy of this exposure analysis is limited by the quality of data and the effectiveness of the modeling.  
It is possible that a catastrophic event significantly exceeds the expected modeled event loss. The Group’s appetite and exposure 
guidelines to large losses are set out on pages 102 and 103. 

The Group also writes energy liability business on a stand-alone basis. Unlike the liability contained within the energy packages that 
Lancashire writes, stand-alone energy liability is written on an excess of loss basis only. Coverage is worldwide and provides coverage  
for all kinds of damages and loss to third parties. Coverage is generally restricted to offshore assets. 

Construction energy contracts generally cover all risks of platform and drilling units under construction at yards and offshore,  
during towing and installation. Onshore construction contracts are generally not written. 

Reinsurance protection may be purchased to protect a portion of loss from elemental and non-elemental energy claims, and from  
the accumulation of smaller, attritional losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis but, from time to time,  
quota share arrangements may be entered into. Reinsurance may be purchased on a facultative or treaty basis. 

106 
106 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
IV. MARINE 
Gross premiums written, for the year: 

Marine hull and total loss 

Marine P&I clubs 

Marine builders risk 

Marine hull war 

Other marine 

Total 

2014 
$m

29.6

12.8

12.2

10.3

2.8

67.7

2013 
$m

24.8

10.7

10.3

15.0

2.2

63.0

With the exception of the marine P&I clubs, where excess layers are written, most policies are written on a ground-up basis. Marine hull 
and total loss is generally written on a direct basis and covers marine risks on a worldwide basis, primarily for physical damage. Marine  
P&I clubs is mostly the reinsurance of the International Group of Protection and Indemnity Clubs and covers marine liabilities. Marine 
builders risk covers the building of ocean going vessels in specialised yards worldwide and their testing and commissioning. Marine hull 
war is mostly direct insurance of loss of vessels from war, piracy or terrorist attack, with a very limited amount of facultative reinsurance.  

The largest expected exposure in the marine class is from physical loss rather than from elemental loss events, although there is exposure 
to elemental perils and to the costs for removal of wreck. 

Reinsurance may be purchased to reduce the Group’s exposure to both large risk losses and an accumulation of smaller, attritional  
losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on a treaty excess of loss basis. 

V. AVIATION 
Gross premiums written, for the year:  

AV52 

Aviation satellite 

Other aviation 

Total 

2014 
$m

25.9

24.8

2.5

53.2

2013 
$m

26.5

16.8

5.6

48.9

AV52 is written on a risk attaching excess of loss basis and provides coverage for third-party liability, excluding own passenger liability, 
resulting from acts of war or hijack of aircraft. Cover excludes countries whose governments provide a backstop coverage, but does,  
since 2014, include some U.S. commercial airlines. 

Aviation satellite cover is written on a full value, primary or excess of loss basis and can provide cover for satellite launch, satellite in-orbit 
or both satellite launch and in-orbit. Coverage for in-orbit can be provided on an annual or multi-year basis and both launch and in-orbit 
can cover loss of earnings as well as physical damage. 

Reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate exposures to an AV52 event loss. Reinsurance is typically purchased on a treaty excess  
of loss basis. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

107 
107

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

REINSURANCE 
The Group, in the normal course of business and in accordance with its risk management practices, seeks to reduce certain types of  
loss that may arise from events that could cause unfavourable underwriting results, and to improve the modeled risk-adjusted RoE by 
entering into reinsurance arrangements. Reinsurance does not relieve the Group of its obligations to policyholders. Under the Group’s 
reinsurance security policy, reinsurers are assessed and approved as appropriate security based on their financial strength ratings, amongst 
other factors. The RRC has defined limits by reinsurer by rating. The RRC considers reinsurers that are not rated or do not fall within the 
predefined rating categories on a case-by-case basis, and would usually require collateral to be posted to support such obligations. There 
are specific guidelines for these collateralised contracts. The RRC monitors the creditworthiness of its reinsurers on an ongoing basis and 
formally reviews the Group’s reinsurance arrangements at least quarterly.  

Reinsurance protection is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis, however it may also include ILW covers or quota share 
arrangements. The mix of reinsurance cover is dependent on the specific loss mitigation requirements, market conditions and available 
capacity. Reinsurance may also be purchased to optimise the risk-adjusted return of the underwriting portfolio. The structure varies 
between types of peril and sub-class. The Group regularly reviews its catastrophe exposures and may purchase reinsurance in order  
to reduce the Group’s net exposure to a large natural catastrophe loss and/or to reduce net exposures to other large losses. The Group  
can purchase both facultative and treaty reinsurance. There is no guarantee that reinsurance coverage will be available to meet all 
potential loss circumstances, as it is possible that the cover purchased is not sufficient to transfer the totality of the Group’s exposure.  
Any loss amount which exceeds the programme would be retained by the Group. Some parts of the reinsurance programme have  
limited reinstatements, therefore the number of claims which may be recovered from second or subsequent losses in those particular 
circumstances is limited.  

INSURANCE LIABILITIES 
For most insurance and reinsurance companies, the most significant judgement made by management is the estimation of loss and  
loss adjustment expense reserves. The estimation of the ultimate liability arising from claims made under insurance and reinsurance 
contracts is a critical estimate for the Group particularly given the nature of the business written. 

Under generally accepted accounting principles, loss reserves are not permitted until the occurrence of an event which may give rise  
to a claim. As a result, only loss reserves applicable to losses incurred up to the reporting date are established, with no allowance for the 
provision of a contingency reserve to account for expected future losses or for the emergence of new types of latent claims. Claims arising 
from future events can be expected to require the establishment of substantial reserves from time to time. All reserves are reported on an 
undiscounted basis.  

Loss and loss adjustment expense reserves are maintained to cover the Group’s estimated liability for both reported and unreported 
claims. Reserving methodologies that calculate a point estimate for the ultimate losses are utilised, and then a range is developed around 
these point estimates. The point estimate represents management’s best estimate of ultimate loss and loss adjustment expenses. The 
Group’s internal actuaries review the reserving assumptions and methodologies on a quarterly basis with loss estimates being subject  
to a semi-annual corroborative review by independent actuaries, using U.S. generally accepted actuarial principles. This independent 
review is presented to the Group’s Audit Committee. The Group has also established Reserve Committees at the operating entity level, 
which have responsibility for the review of large claims and IBNR levels, their development and any changes in reserving methodology  
and assumptions.  

The extent of reliance on management’s judgement in the reserving process differs as to whether the business is insurance or reinsurance, 
whether it is short-tail or long-tail and whether the business is written on an excess of loss or on a pro-rata basis. Over a typical annual 
period, the Group expects to write the large majority of programmes on a direct excess of loss basis. The Group does not currently write 
 a significant amount of long-tail business. 

INSURANCE VERSUS REINSURANCE 
Loss reserve calculations for direct insurance business are not precise in that they deal with the inherent uncertainty of assumptions 
regarding future reporting and development patterns, frequency and severity trends, claims settlement practices, potential changes in  
the legal environment and other factors, such as inflation. These estimates and judgements are based on numerous factors and may be 
revised as additional experience or other data becomes available or reviewed as new or improved methodologies are developed or as 
current laws or regulations change.  

Furthermore, as a broker market reinsurer, management must rely on loss information, reported to brokers by other insurers and  
their loss adjusters, who must estimate their own losses at the policy level, often based on incomplete and changing information.  
The information management receives varies by cedant and may include paid losses, estimated case reserves and an estimated provision 
for IBNR reserves. Additionally, reserving practices and the quality of data reporting may vary among ceding companies which adds 
further uncertainty to the estimation of the ultimate losses.  

108 
108 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
SHORT-TAIL VERSUS LONG-TAIL 
In general, claims relating to short-tail risks, such as the majority of risks underwritten by the Group, are reported more promptly  
than those relating to long-tail risks, including the majority of casualty risks. However, the timeliness of reporting can be affected by  
such factors as the nature of the event causing the loss, the location of the loss, and whether the losses are from policies in force with 
insureds, primary insurers, reinsurers or vendor binding authorities. 

EXCESS OF LOSS VERSUS PROPORTIONAL 
For excess of loss contracts, which make up the majority of the Group’s business, management are aided by the fact that each policy has  
a defined limit of liability arising from one event. Once that limit has been reached, there is no further exposure to additional losses from 
that policy for the same event. For proportional business, an initial estimated loss and loss expense ratio is generally used. This is based 
upon information provided by the insured or ceding company and/or their broker and management’s historical experience of that treaty, 
if any, and the estimate is adjusted as actual experience becomes known.  

TIME LAGS 
There is a time lag inherent in reporting from the original claimant to the primary insurer or binding authority holder to the broker  
and then to the reinsurer. Also, the combination of low claims frequency and high severity makes the available data more volatile and  
less useful for predicting ultimate losses. In the case of proportional contracts, reliance is placed on an analysis of a contract’s historical 
experience, industry information, and the professional judgement of underwriters in estimating reserves for these contracts. In addition,  
if available, reliance is placed partially on ultimate loss ratio forecasts as reported by insureds or cedants, which are normally subject to  
a quarterly or six-month lag. 

UNCERTAINTY 
As a result of the time lag described above, an estimation must be made of IBNR reserves, which consist of a provision for additional 
development in excess of the case reserves reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for claims which have  
occurred but which have not yet been reported by insureds or ceding companies. Due to the degree of reliance that is necessarily  
placed on insureds or ceding companies for claims reporting, the associated time lag, the low frequency/high severity nature of much  
of the business that the Group underwrites, and the varying reserving practices among ceding companies, reserve estimates are highly 
dependent on management judgement and are therefore uncertain. During the loss settlement period, which may be years in duration, 
additional facts regarding individual claims and trends often will become known, and current laws and case law may change as well as 
regulatory directives, with a consequent impact on reserving. The claims count on the types of insurance and reinsurance that the Group 
writes, which are low frequency and high severity in nature, is generally low.  

For certain catastrophic events there are greater uncertainties underlying the assumptions and associated estimated reserves for losses  
and loss adjustment expenses. Complexity resulting from problems such as policy coverage issues, multiple events affecting one 
geographic area and the resulting impact on claims adjusting (including the allocation of claims to the specific event and the effect  
of demand surge on the cost of building materials and labour) by, and communications from, insureds or ceding companies, can cause 
delays to the timing with which the Group is notified of changes to loss estimates. 

As at 31 December 2014, management’s estimates for IBNR represented 31.6 per cent of total net loss reserves (31 December  
2013 – 31.8 per cent). The majority of the estimate relates to potential claims on non-elemental risks where timing delays in insured  
 or cedant reporting may mean losses could have occurred which the Group was not made aware of by the balance sheet date.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

109 
109

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

B. MARKET RISK 
The Group is at risk of loss due to movements in market factors. The main risks include: 

Insurance risk;  
i. 
ii.  Investment risk;  

iii.  Debt risk; and  
iv.  Currency risk.  

These risks, and the management thereof, are described below. 

I. INSURANCE RISK 
The Group is exposed to insurance market risk from several sources, including the following: 

  the advent or continuation of a soft market, which may result in a stabilisation or decline in premium rates and/or terms and conditions 

for certain lines, or across all lines; 

  the actions and reactions of key competitors, which may directly result in volatility in premium volumes and rates, fee levels and  

other input costs;  

  market events which may cause a limit in the availability of cover, including unusual inflation in rates, causing political intervention  

or national remedies;  

  failure to maintain broker, binding authority and client relationships, leading to a limited or substandard choice of risks inconsistent 

with the Group’s risk appetite; and 

  changes in regulation including capital, governance or licensing requirements.  

The most important method to mitigate insurance market risk is to maintain strict underwriting standards. The Group manages insurance 
market risk in numerous ways, including the following: 

  reviews and amends underwriting plans and outlook as necessary; 

  reduces exposure to market sectors where conditions have reached unattractive levels; 

  purchases appropriate, cost-effective reinsurance cover to mitigate exposures; 

  closely monitors changes in rates and terms and conditions;  

  ensures through continuous capital management that it does not allow surplus capital to drive underwriting appetite; 

  holds a daily underwriting meeting for LICL and LUK to discuss, inter alia, market conditions and opportunities; 

  reviews all new and renewal business post-underwriting for Cathedral; 

  regularly reviews output from BLAST to assess up-to-date profitability of classes and sectors;  

  holds a quarterly Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee meeting to review underwriting strategy;  

  holds a fortnightly RRC meeting to monitor estimated exposures to peak zone elemental losses and RDS; and 

  holds regular documented meetings with regulators.  

Insurance contract liabilities are not directly sensitive to the level of market interest rates, as they are undiscounted and contractually  
non-interest bearing.  

110 
110 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
II. INVESTMENT RISK 
Movements in investments resulting from changes in interest and inflation rates and currency exchange rates, amongst other factors,  
may lead to an adverse impact on the value of the Group’s investment portfolio. Investment guidelines are established by the Investment 
Committee of the Board of Directors to manage this risk. Investment guidelines set parameters within which the Group’s external 
investment managers must operate. Important parameters include guidelines on permissible assets, duration ranges, credit quality, 
currency, maturity, sectors, geographical, sovereign and issuer exposures. Compliance with guidelines is monitored on a monthly basis. 
Any adjustments to the investment guidelines are approved by the IRRC and the Board of Directors.  

The Group’s fixed income portfolios are managed by four external investment managers. The Group also has a diversified portfolio of 
multi-strategy low volatility hedge funds, and a small equity portfolio. The performance of the managers is monitored on an ongoing basis. 

Within the Group guidelines is a subset of guidelines for the portion of funds required to meet near-term obligations and cash flow  
needs following an extreme event. The subset of guidelines adds a further degree of requirements, including fewer allowable asset classes, 
higher credit quality, shorter duration and higher liquidity. The primary objectives for this portion of assets are capital preservation  
and providing liquidity to meet insurance and other near-term obligations. In addition to cash managed internally, funds held in the 
investment portfolio to cover this potential liability are designated as the ‘core‘ portfolio and the portfolio duration is matched to the 
duration of the insurance liabilities, within an agreed range. The core portfolio is invested in fixed income securities, fixed income funds 
and cash and cash equivalents. The core portfolio may, at times, contain assets significantly in excess of those required to meet insurance 
liabilities or other defined funding needs.  

Assets in excess of those required to be held in the core portfolio are typically held in the ‘core plus’ or the ‘surplus’ portfolios. The  
core plus portfolio is invested in fixed income securities and cash and cash equivalents. The surplus portfolio is invested in fixed income 
securities, principal protected equity linked notes, derivative instruments, cash and cash equivalents, equity securities and hedge funds. 
The assets in the core plus and surplus portfolios are not matched to specific insurance liabilities. In general, the duration of the surplus 
portfolio is slightly longer than the core or core plus portfolio, while maintaining a focus on high quality assets.  

The Group reviews the composition, duration and asset allocation of its investment portfolio on a regular basis in order to respond  
to changes in interest rates and other market conditions. If certain asset classes are anticipated to produce a higher return within 
management’s risk tolerance, an adjustment in asset allocation may be made. Conversely, if the risk profile is expected to move outside  
of tolerance levels, adjustments may be made to reduce the risks in the portfolio. 

The investment portfolio is currently structured to perform better in a risk-on environment in order to mitigate the impact of a potential 
rise in interest rates. The Group endeavours to limit losses in risk-on, risk-off, and interest rate hike scenarios. The Group models various 
periods of significant stress in order to better understand the investment portfolio’s risks and exposures. The scenarios represent what 
could, and most likely will occur (albeit not in the exact form of the scenarios, which are based on historic periods of volatility).  
The Group also monitors the portfolio impact of more severe disaster scenarios consisting of extreme shocks. 

The IRRC meets at least quarterly to ensure that the Group’s strategic and tactical investment actions are consistent with investment  
risk preferences, appetite, risk and return objectives and tolerances. The IRRC also helps further develop the risk tolerances to be 
incorporated into the ERM framework. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

111 
111

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The investment mix of the fixed income portfolios is as follows: 

Core 

Core plus 

Surplus 

Total 

As at 31 December 2014 

–   Short-term investments  

–   Fixed income funds 

–   U.S. treasuries 

–   Other government bonds 

–   U.S. municipal bonds 

–   U.S. government agency debt 

–   Asset backed securities 

–   U.S. government agency 

mortgage backed securities 

–   Non-agency mortgage backed 

securities 

–   Agency commercial mortgage 

backed securities 

–   Non-agency commercial 

mortgage backed securities 

–   Bank loans 

–   Corporate bonds  

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Total fixed income securities  

As at 31 December 2013 

–   Short-term investments  

–   Fixed income funds 

–   U.S. treasuries 

–   Other government bonds 

–   U.S. municipal bonds 

–   U.S. government agency debt 

–   Asset backed securities 

–   U.S. government agency 

mortgage backed securities 

–   Non-agency mortgage backed 

securities 

–   Agency commercial mortgage 

backed securities 

–   Non-agency commercial 

mortgage backed securities 

–   Bank loans 

–   Corporate bonds  

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Total fixed income securities  

$m 

0.1 

15.4 

145.3 

49.5 

0.9 

1.4 

89.1 

40.6 

9.5 

– 

4.6 

– 

307.9 

664.3 

– 

664.3 

Core 

$m 

145.4 

26.3 

98.7 

45.5 

2.3 

11.0 

66.6 

39.3 

3.8 

1.6 

7.1 

– 

271.7 

719.3 

– 

719.3 

%

–

0.8

8.0

2.7

–

0.1

4.9

2.2

0.5

–

0.3

–

17.0

36.5

–

36.5

%

7.3

1.3

4.9

2.3

0.1

0.5

3.3

2.0

0.2

0.1

0.4

–

13.6

36.0

–

36.0

112 
112 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

$m

30.3

–

129.0

1.7

0.3

–

28.8

41.9

4.0

0.3

14.3

–

153.5

404.1

–

404.1

%

1.7

–

7.1

0.1

–

–

1.6

2.3

0.2

–

0.8

–

8.5

22.3

–

22.3

$m

–

–

88.7

32.8

27.7

16.1

66.2

85.5

7.3

2.1

20.7

127.9

243.7

718.7

31.2

749.9

Core plus 

Surplus 

$m

75.8

–

53.1

13.6

3.4

3.5

30.6

71.3

1.8

0.9

11.8

–

173.4

439.2

–

439.2

%

3.8

–

2.7

0.7

0.2

0.2

1.5

3.6

0.1

–

0.6

–

8.7

22.1

–

22.1

$m

9.8

–

65.5

48.8

15.7

83.7

54.2

141.4

3.2

1.7

19.0

107.8

256.8

807.6

29.6

837.2

% 

– 

– 

4.9 

1.8 

1.5 

0.9 

3.6 

$m

30.4

15.4

363.0

84.0

28.9

17.5

184.1

4.7 

168.0

0.4 

0.1 

1.1 

7.0 

13.5 

39.5 

1.7 

41.2 

% 

0.5 

– 

3.3 

2.4 

0.8 

4.2 

2.7 

7.0 

0.2 

0.1 

0.9 

5.4 

12.9 

40.4 

1.5 

41.9 

20.8

2.4

39.6

127.9

705.1

1,787.1

31.2

1,818.3

Total 

$m

231.0

26.3

217.3

107.9

21.4

98.2

151.4

252.0

8.8

4.2

37.9

107.8

701.9

1,966.1

29.6

1,995.7

%

1.7

0.8

20.0

4.6

1.5

1.0

10.1

9.2

1.1

0.1

2.2

7.0

39.0

98.3

1.7

100.0

%

11.6

1.3

10.9

5.4

1.1

4.9

7.5

12.6

0.5

0.2

1.9

5.4

35.2

98.5

1.5

100.0

 
 
 
 
 
Corporate bonds, fixed income securities at FVTPL, bank loans and other government bonds by country are as follows: 

As at 31 December 2014 

United States 

United Kingdom 

Canada 

Australia 

France 

Netherlands 

Germany 

Norway 

Japan 

Switzerland 

Sweden 

Luxembourg 

Mexico 

Hong Kong 

United Arab Emirates 

Other 

Total 

As at 31 December 2013 

United States 

Canada 

United Kingdom 

Australia 

France 

Germany 

Norway 

Netherlands 

Sweden 

Switzerland 

Belgium 

Supranationals 

Japan 

Emerging market corporates 

Emerging market sovereign 

Emerging market agency 

Other 

Total 

Financials 
$m

141.5

49.8

29.7

34.1

10.3

13.2

2.8

15.5

10.2

15.6

13.9

–

–

–

–

4.6

341.2

Financials 
$m

121.3

53.8

41.3

22.9

7.4

3.8

29.0

14.1

19.8

11.7

–

7.2

2.6

4.8

–

–

14.2 

864.2 

12.3

84.0

26.5

948.2

Other
 industries
 $m

382.5

Total  
corporate bonds  
and bank loans  
$m  

524.0 

37.4

19.7

7.5

14.6

11.4

15.8

0.8

7.7

0.7

–

7.2

3.0

4.9

0.2

9.6

523.0

Other
 industries
 $m

331.4

16.0

52.2

9.7

24.4

13.3

0.8

10.9

–

4.2

7.4

–

2.6

11.3

–

–

87.2 

49.4 

41.6 

24.9 

24.6 

18.6 

16.3 

17.9 

16.3 

13.9 

7.2 

3.0 

4.9 

0.2 

Total  
corporate bonds  
and bank loans  
$m  

452.7 

69.8 

93.5 

32.6 

31.8 

17.1 

29.8 

25.0 

19.8 

15.9 

7.4 

7.2 

5.2 

16.1 

– 

– 

Other 
government
 bonds 
$m

Total corporate
 bonds, bank loans 
and other 
government bonds 
$m

–

0.4

24.6

9.8

8.4

6.4

9.8

5.0

–

–

0.2

–

3.6

–

3.5

524.0

87.6

74.0

51.4

33.3

31.0

28.4

21.3

17.9

16.3

14.1

7.2

6.6

4.9

3.7

Other 
government
 bonds 
$m

Total corporate
 bonds, bank loans 
and other 
government bonds 
$m

–

26.1

0.4

10.0

6.6

15.3

2.0

5.8

1.3

–

–

–

–

–

9.9

26.9

3.6

107.9

452.7

95.9

93.9

42.6

38.4

32.4

31.8

30.8

21.1

15.9

7.4

7.2

5.2

16.1

9.9

26.9

19.0

947.2

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

113 
113

4.0

343.7

11.4

495.6

15.4 

839.3 

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The sector allocation of the corporate bonds, fixed income securities at FVTPL and bank loans is as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Industrial 

Financial 

Utility 

Supranationals 

Total 

2014 

 $m

487.3

338.3

35.7

2.9

864.2

 % 

56.5 

39.1 

4.1 

0.3 

100.0 

2013 

 $m

452.8

336.5

42.8

7.2

839.3

%

53.9

40.1

5.1

0.9

100.0

The Group’s net asset value is directly impacted by movements in the value of investments held. Values can be impacted by movements  
in interest rates, credit ratings, exchange rates and economic environment and outlook.  

The Group’s investment portfolio is mainly comprised of fixed income securities and cash and cash equivalents. The fixed income funds 
are overseas deposits held by Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 in trust for the benefit of the policyholders in those overseas jurisdictions. 
They consist of high quality, short duration fixed income securities. The Group also has a small equity portfolio. The estimated fair value 
of the Group’s fixed income portfolio is generally inversely correlated to movements in market interest rates. If market interest rates fall, 
the fair value of the Group’s fixed income securities would tend to rise and vice versa.  

The sensitivity of the price of fixed income securities, and certain derivatives, to movements in interest rates is indicated by their duration. 
The greater a security’s duration, the greater its price volatility to movements in interest rates. The sensitivity of the Group’s fixed income 
and derivative investment portfolio to interest rate movements is detailed below, assuming linear movements in interest rates: 

As at 31 December 

Immediate shift in yield (basis points) 

100 

75 

50 

25 

(25) 

(50) 

(75) 

(100) 

2014 

$m

(30.6)

(22.9)

(15.3)

(7.6)

7.6

15.1

22.7

30.2

% 

(1.7)

(1.3)

(0.8)

(0.4)

0.4 

0.8 

1.2 

1.7 

2013 

$m

(23.3)

(18.3)

(12.7)

(6.6)

6.8

14.0

21.3

28.9

The Group mitigates interest rate risk on the investment portfolio by establishing and monitoring duration ranges in its investment 
guidelines. The Group may manage duration through the use of interest rate futures and swaptions from time to time. The duration  
of the core portfolio is matched to the modeled duration of the insurance reserves, within a permitted range. The permitted duration 
range for the core plus portfolio is between zero and four years and the surplus portfolio is between one and five years.  

The durations of the externally managed portfolios are as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Core portfolio 

Core plus portfolio  

Surplus portfolio 

Overall portfolio (including duration overlay) 

2014 
years

1.7

1.9

1.8

1.5

%

(1.2)

(0.9)

(0.6)

(0.3)

0.3

0.7

1.1

1.4

2013 
years

1.2

1.2

1.9

1.1

The overall duration for fixed income, managed cash and cash equivalents and certain derivatives is 1.5 years (2013 – 1.0 year). 

In addition to duration management, the Group uses VaR on a monthly basis to measure potential losses in the estimated fair values of its 
cash and invested assets and to understand and monitor risk. The VaR calculation is performed using variance/covariance risk modeling 
to capture the cash flows and embedded optionality of the portfolio. Securities are valued individually using market standard pricing 
models. These security valuations serve as the input to many risk analytics, including full valuation risk analyses, as well as parametric 
methods that rely on option adjusted risk sensitivities to approximate the risk and return profiles of the portfolio.  

114 
114 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
The principal VaR measure that is produced is an annual VaR at the 99th percentile confidence level. The annual VaR, at the 99th 
percentile confidence level, measures the minimum amount the assets should be expected to lose over a one year time horizon,  
under normal conditions, 1 per cent of the time.  

The Group’s annual VaR calculations are as follows: 

As at 31 December 

99th percentile confidence level 

2014 

2013 

$m

38.1

% of shareholders’ 
equity 

2.8 

$m

32.6

% of shareholders’ 
equity

2.2

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the investment managers to utilise exchange-traded futures and options contracts, and  
OTC instruments including interest rate swaps, credit default swaps, interest rate swaptions and forward foreign currency contracts. 
Derivatives are used for yield enhancement, duration management, interest rate and foreign currency exposure management or to  
obtain an exposure to a particular financial market. These positions are monitored regularly. The Group may also use internally  
managed derivatives to mitigate interest rate risk and foreign currency exposures. The Group principally has exposure to derivatives 
related to the following types of risks: foreign currency risk, interest rate risk and credit risk. 

The Group currently invests in the following derivative financial instruments: 

a.  Futures;  
b.  Options;  
c.  Forward foreign currency contracts;  
d.  Swaps; and 
e.  Swaptions;  

The net gains or losses on the Group’s derivative financial instruments recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive 
income are as follows: 

As at 31 December 2014 

Treasury futures 

Forward foreign currency contracts 

Interest rate swaps – investments 

Interest rate swaps – debt 

Swaptions 

Total 

As at 31 December 2013 

Eurodollar futures 

Treasury futures 

Forward foreign currency contracts 

Interest rate swaps – investments 

Interest rate swaps – debt 

Credit default swaps 

Swaptions 

Total 

Net other 
investment loss
 $m

Net realised  
losses  
$m 

Net foreign 
exchange 
losses
$m 

–

–

(0.1)

–

(2.2)

(2.3)

(6.0)

– 

(0.1)

– 

(2.1)

(8.2)

–

(0.7)

–

–

–

(0.7)

Net other 
investment income 
$m

Net realised  
gains (losses)  
$m 

Net foreign 
exchange 
gains 
$m 

–

–

–

(0.1)

–

(0.3)

2.2

1.8

0.3 

4.8 

– 

(0.3)

– 

0.2 

– 

5.0 

–

–

12.0

–

–

–

–

12.0

Financing 
costs 
$m

–

–

–

(7.4)

–

(7.4)

Financing 
gain 
$m

–

–

–

–

5.2

–

–

5.2

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

115 
115

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The estimated fair values of the Group’s derivative instruments are as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Forward foreign currency 
contracts 

Interest rate swaps – investments  

Interest rate swaps – debt 

Swaptions 

Credit default swaps 

Total 

2014 

Other  
investments  
$m  

Other 
receivables 
$m

Other
payables
$m

Interest 
rate swaps
 $m

Other  
investments  
$m  

2013 

Other 
receivables 
 $m

Interest 
rate swaps 
$m

0.7 

3.8

(1.8)

– 

– 

– 

– 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(4.9)

–

–

0.7 

3.8

(1.8)

(4.9)

– 

(0.1)

– 

4.9 

(0.1)

4.7 

0.1

–

–

–

–

0.1

–

–

(0.2)

–

–

(0.2)

A. FUTURES 
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of futures which provide the Group with participation in market movements, 
determined by the underlying instrument on which the futures contract is based, without holding the instrument itself or the individual 
securities. This approach allows the Group more efficient and less costly access to the exposure than would be available by the exclusive 
use of individual fixed income and money market securities. Exchange-traded futures contracts may also be used as substitutes for 
ownership of the physical securities. 

All futures contracts are held on a non-leveraged basis. An initial margin is provided, which is a deposit of cash and/or securities in  
an amount equal to a prescribed percentage of the contract value. The fair value of futures contracts is estimated daily and the margin  
is adjusted accordingly with unrealised gains and/or losses settled daily in cash and/or securities. A realised gain or loss is recognised 
when the contract is closed. 

Futures contracts expose the Group to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the estimated fair values of the underlying 
securities. Exchange-traded futures are, however, subject to a number of safeguards to ensure that obligations are met. These include  
the use of clearing houses (thus reducing counterparty credit risk), the posting of margins and the daily settlement of unrealised gains 
and losses. The amount of credit risk is therefore considered low. The investment guidelines restrict the maximum notional futures 
position as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value. 

As at 31 December, the Group had the following exposure to treasury futures: 

As at 31 December 

Treasury futures 

Total 

Notional 
long 
$m 

89.1

89.1

2014 

Notional 
short 
$m

169.9

169.9

Net notional 
long (short) 
$m

(80.8)

(80.8)

Notional  
long  
$m 

80.5 

80.5 

2013 

Notional
 short
 $m

86.2

86.2

Net notional 
long (short) 
$m

(5.7)

(5.7)

A Eurodollar futures contract is an exposure to 3 month LIBOR, based on a commitment to a $1.0 million deposit. The estimated fair 
value is based on expectations of 3 month LIBOR, is determined using exchange-traded prices and was negligible as at 31 December  
2014 and 2013. The contracts currently held by the Group will expire in 2015. 

The sensitivity of the Group’s Eurodollar futures position to interest rate movements is not material as at 31 December 2014 and 2013. 

B. OPTIONS 
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of exchange-traded options on U.S. treasury futures and Eurodollar futures, which  
are used to manage exposure to interest rate risk and also to hedge duration. Exchange-traded options are held on a similar basis  
to futures and are subject to similar safeguards. Options are contractual arrangements that give the purchaser the right, but not the 
obligation, to either buy or sell an instrument at a specific set price at a predetermined future date. The Group may enter into option 
contracts that are secured by holdings in the underlying securities or by other means which permit immediate satisfaction of the Group’s 
obligations. The notional amount of options is not material as at 31 December 2014 and 2013. 

The investment guidelines also restrict the maximum notional options exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated 
fair value. 

116 
116 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
C. FORWARD FOREIGN CURRENCY CONTRACTS 
A forward foreign currency contract is a commitment to purchase or sell a foreign currency at a future date, at a defined rate. The Group 
may utilise forward foreign currency contracts to gain exposure to a certain currency or market rate or manage the impact of fluctuations 
in foreign currencies on the value of its foreign currency denominated investments, debt and/or insurance related currency exposures. 

Forward contracts expose the Group to credit, market and liquidity risks. Credit risk arises from the potential inability of counterparties to perform 
under the terms of the contract. The Group is exposed to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the exchange rate of the 
underlying foreign currency. Liquidity risk represents the possibility that the Group may not be able to rapidly adjust the size of its forward positions 
at a reasonable price in times of high volatility and financial stress. These risks are mitigated by requiring a minimum counterparty credit quality, 
restricting the maximum notional exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value and restricting exposures to foreign 
currencies, individually and in aggregate, as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value.  

The notional amount of a derivative contract is the underlying quantity upon which payment obligations are calculated. A long position  
is equivalent to buying the underlying currency whereas a short position is equivalent to having sold the underlying currency. 

The Group has the following open forward foreign currency contracts: 

As at 31 December 

Canadian Dollar 

Australian Dollar 

British Pound  

Brazilian Real 

Chinese Renminbi 

Malaysian Ringgit 

Euro 

Japanese Yen 
Other(1) 

Total 

Notional 
long 
$m 

0.4

10.0

–

–

–

3.7

43.2

5.1

–

62.4

2014 

Notional 
short 
$m

Net notional 
long (short) 
$m

Notional  
long  
$m 

2013 

Notional
 short
 $m

Net notional 
long (short) 
$m

20.7

26.3

8.1

–

–

–

26.4

5.1

–

86.6

(20.3)

(16.3)

(8.1)

–

–

3.7

16.8

–

–

(24.2)

0.5 

10.5 

– 

3.9 

0.3 

3.9 

52.6 

– 

0.3 

72.0 

–

28.5

9.4

6.6

0.3

–

24.5

–

0.3

69.6

0.5

(18.0)

(9.4)

(2.7)

–

3.9

28.1

–

–

2.4

(1) Individual currencies included in ‘other’ have a notional payable and receivable of less than $2.0 million for 2013. 

D. SWAPS 
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of interest rate swaps and credit default swaps which are primarily traded OTC. Swaps 
are recorded at estimated fair value at the end of each period with unrealised gains and losses recorded in the consolidated statement  
of comprehensive income. 

Interest rate swaps are used to manage interest rate exposure, portfolio duration or capitalise on anticipated changes in interest rate volatility 
without investing directly in the underlying securities. Interest rate swap agreements entail the exchange of commitments to pay or receive interest, 
such as an exchange of floating rate payments for fixed rate payments, with respect to a notional amount of principal. These agreements involve 
elements of credit and market risk. Such risks include the possibility that there may not be a liquid market, that the counterparty may default on  
its obligation to perform, or that there may be unfavourable movements in interest rates. These risks are mitigated through defining a minimum 
counterparty credit quality and a maximum notional exposure to interest rate swaps as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair 
value. The notional amount of interest rate swaps held in the investment portfolio is not material as at 31 December 2014 and 2013. The notional 
amount of interest rate swaps held internally for the purposes of hedging the interest rate exposure on the Group’s subordinated loan notes as at  
31 December 2014 is $252.3 million (31 December 2013 – $259.8 million) 

The Group uses credit default swaps as a way to add or reduce credit risk to an individual issuer, or a basket of issuers, without investing 
directly in their securities. As at 31 December 2014, the maximum amount of loss the Group could incur on its open credit default swaps 
was the notional value of $nil (31 December 2013 – $4.1 million). 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

117 
117

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

E. SWAPTIONS 
The Group uses swaptions, options on interest rate swaps, to manage interest rate risk exposure and portfolio and yield curve duration. 
The Group, as the purchaser of a swaption, is subject to the credit risk of the counterparty but is only subject to market risk to the extent 
of the premium paid. As a swaption writer, the Group is not subject to credit risk but is subject to market risk, due to its obligation to make 
payments under the terms of the contract. These risks are mitigated through maximum allowable notional exposures as a percentage of 
the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value. The estimated fair value of these instruments is $nil as at 31 December 2014 (31 December 
2013 – $4.9 million).  

III. DEBT RISK 
The Group has issued long-term debt as described in note 22. The LHL issued subordinated loan notes due in 2035 bear interest at 
 a floating rate that is reset on a quarterly basis, plus a fixed margin of 3.70 per cent. The Group is subject to interest rate risk on the 
coupon payments of these subordinated loan notes. The Group has mitigated the interest rate risk by entering into interest rate swap 
contracts as follows: 

Subordinated loan notes $97.0 million 

Subordinated loan notes €24.0 million 

Maturity date

Interest hedged

15 December 2035

15 June 2035

100%

100%

The interest rate swaps expire on 15 December 2020, therefore the Group currently has no interest rate risk on the LHL issued 
subordinated loan notes due in 2035. 

The senior unsecured notes maturing 1 October 2022 bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.70 per cent and therefore the Group is not exposed 
to interest rate risk on this long-term debt. 

On the acquisition of Cathedral, the Group assumed subordinated loan notes as described in note 22. The Group is subject to  
interest rate risk on the coupon payment of this long-term debt. An increase of 100 basis points on the EURIBOR and LIBOR three 
 month deposit rates would result in an increase in the interest expense on long term debt for the Group of approximately $0.8 million  
on an annual basis. 

IV. CURRENCY RISK 
The Group underwrites from two locations, Bermuda and London, although risks are assumed on a worldwide basis. Risks assumed  
are predominantly denominated in U.S. dollars.  

The Group is exposed to currency risk to the extent its assets are denominated in different currencies to its liabilities. The Group is also 
exposed to non-retranslation risk on non-monetary assets such as unearned premiums and deferred acquisition costs. Exchange gains  
and losses can impact income. 

The Group hedges non-U.S. dollar liabilities primarily with non-U.S. dollar assets, but may also use derivatives to mitigate foreign  
currency exposures. The Group’s main foreign currency exposure relates to its insurance obligations, cash holdings, investments, 
premiums receivable, dividends payable and the euro denominated subordinated loan notes long-term debt liabilities discussed in  
note 22. These positions may not be hedged depending on the currency outlook. See page 117 for a listing of the Group’s open  
forward foreign currency contracts. 

118 
118 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
The Group’s assets and liabilities, categorised by currency at their translated carrying amount are as follows: 

Assets 

Cash and cash equivalents  

Accrued interest receivable  

Investments 

Reinsurance assets 

Deferred acquisition costs 

Other receivables  

Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and 
cedants 

Corporation tax receivable 

Investment in associates 

Property, plant and equipment  

Intangible assets 

Total assets as at 31 December 2014 

Liabilities  

Losses and loss adjustment expenses  

Unearned premiums  

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Deferred acquisition costs ceded 

Other payables 

Deferred tax liability 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total liabilities as at 31 December 2014 

U.S. $ 
$m

173.4

7.7

1,885.7

119.8

81.8

10.8

263.5

–

52.7

0.3

153.8

2,749.5

U.S. $ 
$m

550.1

379.6

34.8

30.0

0.1

46.5

17.4

1.6

284.4

1,344.5

Sterling 
$m

42.8

–

18.8

15.3

4.8

25.1

15.9

4.3

–

8.8

–

 Euro 
$m

27.2

–

41.2

3.9

10.9

–

27.6

–

–

–

–

Japanese Yen  
$m 

28.6 

– 

– 

– 

0.6 

– 

0.2 

– 

– 

– 

– 

Other 
$m

31.5

–

41.2

3.4

6.5

0.7

9.0

–

–

–

–

135.8

110.8

29.4 

92.3

Sterling 
$m

51.9

20.2

1.4

2.4

–

36.8

21.3

–

–

134.0

 Euro 
$m

65.6

48.4

2.2

1.0

–

0.1

–

3.3

42.2

162.8

Japanese Yen  
$m 

43.3 

4.8 

0.3 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

Other 
$m

41.7

26.1

2.1

0.8

–

0.1

–

–

–

48.4 

70.8

 Total 
$m

303.5

7.7

1,986.9

142.4

104.6

36.6

316.2

4.3

52.7

9.1

153.8

3,117.8

 Total 
$m

752.6

479.1

40.8

34.2

0.1

83.5

38.7

4.9

326.6

1,760.5

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

119 
119

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

Assets 

Cash and cash equivalents  

Accrued interest receivable  

Investments 

Reinsurance assets 

Deferred acquisition costs 

Other receivables  

Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and 
cedants 

Corporation tax receivable 

Investment in associates 

Property, plant and equipment  

Intangible assets 

U.S. $ 
$m

227.6

8.7

1,897.6

170.3

57.4

8.7

232.1

–

64.7

1.0

177.2

Sterling 
$m

63.8

0.1

39.8

34.6

2.2

10.0

18.0

5.6

–

1.8

–

 Euro
 $m

44.9

0.1

45.9

2.3

7.1

–

26.7

–

–

–

–

Japanese Yen  
$m 

39.4 

– 

– 

0.3 

0.8 

– 

0.6 

– 

– 

– 

– 

Other 
$m

27.3

–

32.7

1.2

6.3

–

11.0

–

–

–

–

 Total 
$m

403.0

8.9

2,016.0

208.7

73.8

18.7

288.4

5.6

64.7

2.8

177.2

Total assets as at 31 December 2013 

2,845.3

175.9

127.0

41.1 

78.5

3,267.8

Liabilities  

Losses and loss adjustment expenses  

Unearned premiums  

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Deferred acquisition costs ceded 

Other payables 

Deferred tax liability 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total liabilities as at 31 December 2013 

U.S. $ 
$m

569.9

348.4

24.2

25.3

0.1

47.7

19.4

(1.4)

284.4

1,318.0

Sterling 
$m

74.1

22.8

0.1

5.2

–

32.9

17.2

–

–

152.3

 Euro 
$m

91.1

35.3

2.6

0.3

–

0.1

–

1.6

47.9

178.9

Japanese Yen  
$m 

77.7 

7.4 

– 

– 

0.1 

– 

– 

– 

– 

Other 
$m

40.6

28.2

2.0

0.1

–

–

2.1

–

–

85.2 

73.0

 Total 
$m

853.4

442.1

28.9

30.9

0.2

80.7

38.7

0.2

332.3

1,807.4

The impact on net income of a proportional foreign exchange movement of 10.0 per cent up and 10.0 per cent down against the  
U.S. dollar at the year end spot rates would be an increase or decrease of $3.8 million (2013 – $2.3 million). 

The 31 December 2014 losses and loss adjustment expenses include the equivalent of $21.0 million (2013 – $57.2 million) of Japanese  
Yen denominated insurance liabilities that are contained within the Group’s outwards reinsurance programme which limits the Group’s 
net liability to $30.0 million. The Group has therefore not hedged the foreign currency exposure in relation to these losses. 

The Group uses forward foreign currency contracts for the purposes of managing currency exposures. See page 117 for details  
of the Group’s open forward foreign currency contracts.  

120 
120 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
C. LIQUIDITY RISK 
Liquidity risk is the risk that cash may not be available to pay obligations when they are due without incurring an unreasonable cost.  
The Group’s main exposures to liquidity risk are with respect to its insurance and investment activities. The Group is exposed if proceeds 
from financial assets are not sufficient to fund obligations arising from its insurance contracts. The Group can be exposed to daily calls  
on its available investment assets, principally to settle insurance claims. 

Exposures in relation to insurance activities are as follows: 

  large catastrophic events, or multiple medium-sized events in quick succession, resulting in a requirement to pay a large value of  

claims within a relatively short time frame; 

  failure of insureds or cedants to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of premiums in a timely manner; and 

  failure of reinsurers to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of claims in a timely manner.  

Exposures in relation to investment activities are as follows: 

  adverse market movements and/or a duration mismatch to obligations, resulting in investments being disposed of at a significant 

realised loss; and 

  an inability to liquidate investments due to market conditions. 

The maturity dates of the Group’s fixed income portfolio are as follows: 

As at 31 December 2014 

Less than one year 

Between one and two years 

Between two and three years 

Between three and four years 

Between four and five years 

Over five years 

Asset backed and mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed income securities 

As at 31 December 2013 

Less than one year 

Between one and two years 

Between two and three years 

Between three and four years 

Between four and five years 

Over five years 

Asset backed and mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed income securities 

Core 
$m

Core plus  
$m 

103.7

168.1

200.0

20.9

21.9

5.9

143.8

664.3

Core
 $m

265.9

162.2

123.4

30.7

15.1

3.6

118.4

719.3

58.9 

117.1 

80.6 

19.6 

29.1 

9.5 

89.3 

404.1 

Core plus  
$m 

153.2 

68.7 

30.2 

34.3 

23.2 

13.2 

116.4 

439.2 

Surplus 
$m

43.6

42.4

75.5

65.3

97.5

243.8

181.8

749.9

Surplus
 $m

56.7

101.5

57.6

153.5

54.3

194.1

219.5

837.2

Total 
$m

206.2

327.6

356.1

105.8

148.5

259.2

414.9

1,818.3

Total 
$m

475.8

332.4

211.2

218.5

92.6

210.9

454.3

1,995.7

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

121 
121

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The maturity profile of the financial liabilities of the Group is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2014 

Losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Other payables 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total  

As at 31 December 2013 

Losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Other payables 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total  

Years until liability becomes due – undiscounted values 

Balance sheet 
$m

Less than one 
$m

One to three 
$m

Three to five  
$m 

752.6

40.8

34.2

83.5

4.9

326.6

1,242.6

299.0

30.5

34.2

83.5

2.5

13.2

462.9

270.0

9.6

–

–

2.2

35.3

317.1

102.2 

0.7 

– 

– 

0.4 

38.0 

141.3 

Years until liability becomes due – undiscounted values 

Balance sheet 
$m

Less than one 
$m

One to three 
$m

Three to five  
$m 

853.4

28.9

30.9

80.7

0.2

332.3

1,326.4

381.2

26.6

30.9

80.7

2.5

13.3

535.2

312.4

1.5

–

–

3.5

34.0

351.4

96.7 

0.8 

– 

– 

(1.2)

41.8 

138.1 

Over five 
$m

81.4

–

–

–

(0.2)

546.6

627.8

Over five 
$m

63.1

–

–

–

(4.6)

629.7

688.2

Total 
$m

752.6

40.8

34.2

83.5

4.9

633.1

1,549.1

Total 
$m

853.4

28.9

30.9

80.7

0.2

718.8

1,712.9

Actual maturities of the above may differ from contractual maturities because certain borrowers have the right to call or prepay certain 
obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. The prepayment options for the Group’s long-term debt are discussed in note 22. 
While the estimation of the ultimate liability for losses and loss adjustment expenses is complex and incorporates a significant amount of 
judgement, the timing of payment of losses and loss adjustment expenses is also uncertain and cannot be predicted as simply as for other 
financial liabilities. Actuarial and statistical techniques, past experience and management's judgement have been used to determine a 
likely settlement pattern. 

The Group manages its liquidity risks via its investment strategy to hold high quality, highly liquid securities, sufficient to meet its 
insurance liabilities and other near-term liquidity requirements. The creation of the core portfolio with its subset of guidelines aims to 
ensure funds are readily available to meet potential insurance liabilities in an extreme event plus other near-term liquidity requirements. 
In addition, the Group has established asset allocation and maturity parameters within the investment guidelines such that the majority  
of the investments are in high quality assets which could be converted into cash promptly and at minimal expense. The Group monitors 
market changes and outlooks and reallocates assets as deemed necessary. 

122 
122 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
 
D. CREDIT RISK 
Credit risk is the risk that a counterparty may fail to pay, or repay, a debt or obligation. The Group is exposed to credit risk on its  
fixed income investment portfolio and derivative instruments, its inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants, and on  
any amounts recoverable from reinsurers.  

Credit risk on the fixed income portfolio is mitigated through the Group’s policy to invest in instruments of high credit quality issuers  
and to limit the amounts of credit exposure with respect to particular ratings categories and any one issuer. Securities rated below an  
S&P or equivalent rating of BBB-/Baa3 may comprise no more than 10.0 per cent of shareholders’ equity. In addition, no one issuer,  
with the exception of U.S. government and agency securities, other G10 government guaranteed securities (excluding Italy) and 
Australian sovereign debt should exceed 5.0 per cent of shareholders’ equity. The Group is therefore not exposed to any significant  
credit concentration risk on its investment portfolio, except for fixed income securities issued by the U.S. government and government 
agencies and other highly rated governments.  

Credit risk on exchange-traded derivative instruments is mitigated by the use of clearing houses to reduce counterparty credit risk,  
require the posting of margins and settle unrealised gains and losses daily. Credit risk on OTC derivatives is mitigated by monitoring  
the creditworthiness of the counterparties and by requiring collateral to be posted for positions which have accrued gains by amounts 
exceeding predetermined thresholds. 

Credit risk on inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants is managed by conducting business with reputable broking 
organisations, with whom the Group has established relationships, and by rigorous cash collection procedures. The Group also has a 
broker approval process in place. Binding authorities are subject to standard market controls including credit control. Credit risk from 
reinsurance recoverables is primarily managed by the review and approval of reinsurer security by the RRC, as discussed on page 108.  

The table below presents an analysis of the Group’s major exposures to counterparty credit risk, based on their rating. The table includes 
amounts due from policyholders and unsettled investment trades. The quality of these receivables is not graded but, based on 
management’s historical experience, there is limited default risk associated with these amounts.  

As at 31 December 2014 

AAA 

AA+, AA, AA- 

A+, A, A- 

BBB+, BBB, BBB- 
Other1 

Total 

(1) Reinsurance recoveries classified as “other” include $4.2 million of reserves that are fully collateralised. 

As at 31 December 2013 

AAA 

AA+, AA, AA- 

A+, A, A- 

BBB+, BBB, BBB- 
Other1 

Total 

Other investments
 $m

Cash and  
fixed income  
securities  
$m 

Inwards
 premiums 
receivable and 
other receivables 
$m

–

–

0.7

–

–

0.7

385.9 

765.8 

642.4 

193.1 

134.6 

2,121.8 

–

–

85.0

–

273.1

358.1

Other investments
 $m

Cash and  
fixed income  
securities  
$m 

Inwards 
premiums
 receivable and 
other receivables 
$m

–

–

4.9

(0.2)

–

4.7

568.8 

865.9 

665.8 

186.8 

111.4 

2,398.7 

–

–

97.0

–

220.9

317.9

Reinsurance 
recoveries 
$m

–

–

103.0

0.1

9.3

112.4

Reinsurance
 recoveries
 $m

–

–

148.1

0.3

34.6

183.0

(1) Reinsurance recoveries classified as “other” include $33.2 million of reserves that are fully collateralised; $26.8 million of these are with ARL. 

The two counterparties to the Group’s long-term debt interest rate swaps are currently rated A+ and A- by S&P respectively. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

123 
123

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The following table shows inwards premiums receivable that are past due but not impaired: 

Less than 90 days past due 

Between 91 and 180 days past due 

Over 180 days past due 

Total 

2014 
$m

23.6

6.7

3.2

33.5

2013 
$m

13.5

2.2

3.6

19.3

Provisions of $1.2 million (2013 – $0.2 million) have been made for impaired or irrecoverable balances and $1.0 million (2013 – $0.3 
million) was released from the consolidated statement of comprehensive income in respect of bad debts. No provisions have been made 
against balances recoverable from reinsurers. 

E. OPERATIONAL RISK 
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes or systems. The Group and its subsidiaries have 
identified and evaluated their key operational risks and these are incorporated in the risk registers and modeled directly within BLAST. 
The Group has also established, and monitors compliance with, internal operational risk tolerances. The RRC reviews operational risk  
on at least an annual basis and operational risk is covered in the CRO’s quarterly report to the LHL and Entity Boards and the Cathedral 
Risk Committee reporting. 

In order to manage operational risks, the Group has implemented a robust governance framework. Policies and procedures are 
documented and identify the key risks and controls within processes. The Group’s Internal Audit function provides independent  
feedback with regard to the accuracy and completeness of key risks and controls, and independently verifies the effective operation  
of these through substantive testing. All higher risk areas are subject to an annual audit while compliance with tax operating guidelines  
is audited quarterly. Frequency of audits for all other areas varies from quarterly at the most frequent to a minimum of once every three 
years, on a rotational basis.  

F. STRATEGIC RISK 
The Group has identified several strategic risks. These include: 

  the risks that either the poor execution of the business plan or an inappropriate business plan in itself results in a strategy that  

fails to adequately reflect the trading environment, resulting in an inability to optimise performance, including reputational risk;  

  the risks of the failure to maintain adequate capital, accessing capital at an inflated cost or the inability to access capital. This includes 
unanticipated changes in vendor, regulatory and/or rating agency models that could result in an increase in capital requirements or  
a change in the type of capital required; and 

  the risks of succession planning, staff retention and key man risks as strategic risks.  

The Group has maintained elevated risk scores in the risk register relating to the integration of Cathedral into the Group’s financial  
and actuarial reporting, but these will be reviewed in 2015. 

I. BUSINESS PLAN RISKS 
The Group addresses the risks associated with the planning and execution of the business plan through a combination of the following: 

  an iterative annual forward-looking business planning process with cross departmental involvement, including the Cathedral team; 

  evaluation of and approval of the annual business plan by the Board of Directors; 

  regular monitoring of actual versus planned results;  

  periodic review and re-forecasting as market conditions change; and 

  feedback to senior management via the daily UMCC and fortnightly RRC meetings. 

124 
124 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
II. CAPITAL MANAGEMENT RISK  
The total capital of the Group is as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Shareholders’ equity  

Long-term debt 

Total capital 

Intangible assets 

Total tangible capital 

2014 
$m

1,356.8

326.6

1,683.4

(153.8)

1,529.6

2013 
$m

1,459.7

332.3

1,792.0

(177.2)

1,614.8

Risks associated with the effectiveness of the Group’s capital management, are mitigated as follows: 

  regular monitoring of current and prospective regulatory and rating agency capital requirements; 

  regular discussion with the Cathedral management team regarding Lloyd’s capital requirements;  

  oversight of capital requirements by the Board of Directors;  

  ability to purchase sufficient, cost effective reinsurance; 

  maintaining contact with vendors, regulators and rating agencies in order to stay abreast of upcoming developments; and  

  participation in industry groups such as the International Underwriters Association, the Association of Bermuda Insurers and  

Reinsurers and the Lloyd’s Market Association. 

The Group reviews the level and composition of capital on an ongoing basis with a view to: 

  maintaining sufficient capital for underwriting opportunities and to meet obligations to policyholders; 

  maximising the risk-adjusted return to shareholders within predetermined risk tolerances;  

  maintaining adequate financial strength ratings; and  

  meeting internal and regulatory capital requirements. 

Capital is increased or returned as appropriate. The retention of earnings generated leads to an increase in capital. Capital raising  
can include debt or equity and returns of capital may be made through dividends, share repurchases, a redemption of debt or any 
combination thereof. Other capital management tools and products available to the Group may also be utilised. All capital actions  
require approval by the Board of Directors. 

Internal methods have been developed to review the profitability of classes of business and their estimated capital requirements plus  
the capital requirements of the combination of a wide range of other risk categories. These approaches are used by management in 
decision making. The operating entities also conduct capital requirement assessments under internal measures and local regulatory 
requirements. Refer to note 30 for a discussion of the regulatory capital requirements of the Group’s operating entities. 

The Group’s aim is to provide its shareholders with an RoE of 13.0 per cent in excess of a risk-free rate over the insurance cycle. The 
return is generated within a broad framework of risk parameters. The return is measured by management in terms of the IRR of the 
increase in FCBVS in the period adjusted for dividends accrued. This aim is a long-term goal, acknowledging that management expects 
both higher and lower results in the shorter term. The cyclicality and volatility of the insurance market is expected to be the largest  
driver of this pattern. Management monitors these peaks and troughs – adjusting the Group’s portfolio to make the most effective use  
of available capital and seeking to maximise the risk-adjusted return. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

125 
125

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

IRR achieved is as follows: 

31 December 20051 

31 December 2006  

31 December 2007 

31 December 2008 

31 December 2009 

31 December 2010 

31 December 2011 

31 December 2012 

31 December 2013 

31 December 2014 

(1) The returns shown are for the period from the date of incorporation, 12 October 2005, to 31 December 2005. 

IRR achieved in excess of the three-month treasury yield is as follows: 

31 December 20051 

31 December 2006  

31 December 2007 

31 December 2008 

31 December 2009 

31 December 2010 

31 December 2011 

31 December 2012 

31 December 2013 

31 December 2014 

Annual  
return  
% 

(3.2)

17.8 

31.4 

7.8 

26.5 

23.3 

13.4 

16.7 

18.9 

13.9 

Annual 
return  
% 

(3.4)

13.0 

26.9 

6.4 

26.4 

23.2 

13.3 

16.6 

18.9 

13.9 

Compound 
annual return 
%

Inception to 
date return
 %

n/a

14.0

22.4

17.9

19.8

20.3

19.5

19.2

19.2

18.9

(3.2)

14.0

50.3

63.7

105.8

152.4

191.2

242.7

308.0

375.3

Compound 
annual return 
%

Inception to 
date return 
%

n/a

9.2

17.8

14.3

17.1

18.2

17.7

17.7

17.9

17.7

(3.4)

9.2

40.8

52.7

 94.6

141.1

179.9

231.3

296.6

363.8

(1) The returns shown are for the period from the date of incorporation, 12 October 2005, to 31 December 2005. 

III. RETENTION RISKS 
Risks associated with succession planning, staff retention and key man risks are mitigated through a combination of resource  
planning processes and controls, including: 

  the identification of key personnel with appropriate succession plans; 

  identification of key team profit generators and function holders with targeted retention packages;  

  documented recruitment procedures, position descriptions and employment contracts; and 

  resource monitoring and the provision of appropriate compensation, including equity based compensation which vests over  

a defined time horizon, and training schemes. 

126 
126 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS 

1. GENERAL INFORMATION 
The Group is a provider of global specialty insurance and reinsurance products with operations in the United Kingdom, Bermuda  
and Canada. LHL was incorporated under the laws of Bermuda on 12 October 2005. On 16 March 2009, LHL was added to the official  
list and its common shares were admitted to trading on the main market of the LSE; previously LHL’s shares were listed on AIM, a 
subsidiary market of the LSE. Since 21 May 2007, LHL’s shares have had a secondary listing on the BSX. LHL’s registered office is  
Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. LHL’s head office is at Level 29, 20 Fenchurch Street, London, EC3M  
3BY, United Kingdom.  

The consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2014 include the Group’s subsidiary companies, the Group’s 
interest in associates, and the Group’s share of syndicate assets and liabilities and income and expenses. A full listing of the Group’s 
related parties can be found in note 27. 

2. SEGMENTAL REPORTING 
Management and the Board of Directors review the Group's business primarily by its five principal segments: Property, Energy, Marine, 
Aviation and Lloyd’s. These segments are therefore deemed to be the Group’s operating segments for the purposes of segment reporting. 
Further sub-classes of business are underwritten within each operating segment. The nature of these individual sub-classes is discussed 
further in the risk disclosures section on pages 104 to 107. Operating segment performance is measured by the net underwriting profit  
or loss and the combined ratio.  

All amounts reported are transactions with external parties and associates. There are no inter-segmental transactions and there are  
no significant insurance or reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in Bermuda, the Group’s country of domicile. Results 
included in the Lloyd’s segment are from the date of completion of the Cathedral acquisition. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

127 
127

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

2. SEGMENTAL REPORTING CONTINUED 
REVENUE AND EXPENSE BY OPERATING SEGMENT 

For the year ended 31 December 2014 

Gross premium written by geographical region 

Worldwide offshore 

Europe 

U.S. and Canada 

Far East 

Middle East 
Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1 
Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2 

Rest of world 

Total 

Outwards reinsurance premiums  

Change in unearned premiums 

Change in unearned premiums ceded 

Net premiums earned 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 
recoverable 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Net underwriting profit 

Net unallocated income and expenses 

Profit before tax 

Net loss ratio 

Net acquisition cost ratio 

Expense ratio 

Combined ratio 

Property 
$m

Energy 
$m

Marine 
$m

Aviation  
$m 

Lloyd’s 
$m

Total 
$m

0.1

92.3

33.4

34.6

33.8

14.4

8.0

46.4

263.0

(34.3)

(9.9)

2.7

221.5

(12.0)

(9.6)

(26.7)

0.5

173.7

9.8%

11.8%

–

21.6%

220.2

67.0

12.5

3.7

0.9

(0.1)

0.4

0.5

1.3

239.4

(47.8)

(22.5)

0.6

169.7

(55.2)

13.3

(53.1)

0.7

75.4

–

–

–

–

–

–

0.7

67.7

(9.7)

(0.3)

–

57.7

(27.6)

–

(17.9)

0.2

12.4

0.1 

– 

53.1 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

53.2 

(8.1)

4.7 

2.8 

52.6 

(32.9)

– 

(9.7)

0.1 

10.1 

–

116.9

82.3

24.1

9.0

8.4

1.0

42.6

284.3

(64.9)

(9.0)

3.7

214.1

(110.2)

7.7

(47.7)

0.2

64.1

24.7%

30.9%

–

47.8%

30.7%

–

62.5% 

18.3% 

– 

47.9%

22.2%

–

55.6%

78.5%

80.8% 

70.1%

287.4

221.7

172.5

59.6

42.7

23.2

9.5

91.0

907.6

(164.8)

(37.0)

9.8

715.6

(237.9)

11.4

(155.1)

1.7

335.7

(109.2)

226.5

31.7%

21.4%

15.6%

68.7%

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.  

(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada.  

128 
128 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
 
Property 
$m

Energy 
$m

Marine
 $m

Aviation  
$m 

Lloyd’s 
$m

Total 
$m

REVENUE AND EXPENSE BY OPERATING SEGMENT 

For the year ended 31 December 2013 

Gross premium written by geographical region 

Worldwide offshore 

Europe 

U.S. and Canada 

Far East 

Middle East 
Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1 
Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2 

Rest of world 

Total 

Outwards reinsurance premiums  

Change in unearned premiums 

Change in unearned premiums ceded 

Net premiums earned 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

–

36.4

84.9

39.1

16.5
16.5

85.4

18.7

52.4

333.4

(66.9)

(39.9)

(7.8)

218.8

(47.1)

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable

16.9

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Net underwriting profit 

Net unallocated income and expenses 

Profit before tax 

Net loss ratio 

Net acquisition cost ratio 

Expense ratio 

Combined ratio 

(37.8)

8.4

159.2

13.8%

13.4%

–

27.2%

191.9

0.4

6.5

0.3

0.2
0.2

7.2

0.4

3.0

209.9

(38.5)

27.8

3.9

203.1

(63.2)

9.3

(56.9)

0.7

93.0

61.3

0.1

–

–

–
–

0.9

–

0.7

63.0

(11.2)

9.9

–

61.7

(99.2)

34.2

(21.7)

0.2

(24.8)

0.1 

– 

– 

– 

– 
– 

48.8 

– 

– 

48.9 

(3.8)

(0.4)

– 

44.7 

(20.0)

– 

(10.1)

– 

14.6 

–

1.5

10.1

0.5

–
–

8.7

0.3

3.4

24.5

(1.7)

26.9

(9.9)

39.8

(20.5)

1.5

(8.6)

–

12.2

26.5%

27.7%

–

105.3%

34.8%

–

54.2%

140.1%

44.7% 

22.6% 

– 

67.3% 

47.7%

21.6%

–

69.3%

253.3

38.4

101.5

39.9

16.7
16.7

151.0

19.4

59.5

679.7

(122.1)

24.3

(13.8)

568.1

(250.0)

61.9

(135.1)

9.3

254.2

(36.1)

218.1

33.1%

22.1%

15.0%

70.2%

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.  

(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

129 
129

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

3. INVESTMENT RETURN 
The total investment return for the Group is as follows: 

For the year ended 31 December 2014 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Cash and cash equivalents 

Total investment return 

For the year ended 31 December 2013 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Other investments 

Cash and cash equivalents 

Total investment return 

Net investment 
income
 and net other 
investment income
 $m

Net realised 
gains (losses) 
and impairments
 $m

Net change 
in unrealised 
gains /losses 
$m

Total investment 
 return excluding 
 foreign exchange  
$m 

Foreign exchange
 gains (losses) 
$m

Total investment
return including 
foreign exchange 
$m

27.7

1.6

0.5

2.1

(2.3)

0.4

30.0

2.7

–

(0.4)

–

(8.2)

–

(5.9)

(1.8)

–

(0.4)

–

–

–

(2.2)

28.6 

1.6 

(0.3)

2.1 

(10.5)

0.4 

21.9 

(9.5)

–

–

–

1.9

(0.6)

(8.2)

19.1

1.6

(0.3)

2.1

(8.6)

(0.2)

13.7

Net investment 
income
 and net other
investment income
$m

Net realised 
gains (losses)
 and impairments 
$m

Net change 
in unrealised 
gains /losses 
$m

Total investment 
return excluding  
foreign exchange  
$m 

Foreign exchange
 gains (losses) 
$m

Total investment
return including 
foreign exchange 
$m

24.5

(0.4)

0.1

1.8

0.8

26.8

7.6

–

–

5.0

–

12.6

(33.8)

–

0.5

–

–

(33.3)

(1.7)

(0.4)

0.6 

6.8 

0.8 

6.1 

(3.1)

–

–

2.6

(0.1)

(0.6)

(4.8)

(0.4)

0.6

9.4

0.7

5.5

Net realised gains (losses) and impairments includes impairment losses of $0.1 million (2013 – $nil) recognised on fixed income securities 
and $0.2 million (2013 – $nil) recognised on equity securities held by the Group. 

Refer to page 116 in the risk disclosures section for the estimated fair values of the Group’s derivative instruments. Realised gains and 
losses on futures and options contracts are included in net realised gains (losses) and impairments. The net impact of TBAs is $nil for  
all reporting periods.  

Included in investment income is $5.7 million (2013 – $5.5 million) of investment management, accounting and custodian fees. 

4. NET INSURANCE ACQUISITION EXPENSES 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Amortisation of value of in-force business acquired 

Changes in deferred insurance acquisition expenses  

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Changes in deferred insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Total net insurance acquisition expenses 

2014 
$m

177.6

15.0

(30.8)

(8.3)

(0.1)

153.4

2013 
$m

132.4

8.5

(5.8)

(8.7)

(0.6)

125.8

A portion of the amortisation expense relating to the value of in-force business acquired has been allocated to insurance acquisition 
expenses, in line with the run-off profile of that business. 

130 
130 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
5. RESULTS OF OPERATING ACTIVITIES 
Results of operating activities are stated after charging the following amounts: 

Depreciation on owned assets  

Operating lease charges  

Amortisation of value of in-force business 

Auditors’ remuneration 

– Group audit fees 

– Other services  

Total  

2014 
$m

2.1

3.8

8.4

1.7

0.3

16.3

2013 
$m

1.4

2.4

4.7

1.3

0.3

10.1

During 2014, EY provided non-audit services in relation to taxation services, capital management projects, Cathedral group restructuring 
and services pursuant to the KCML subscription and shareholders’ agreement. All fees paid to the Group’s auditors for non-audit services 
are approved by the Group’s Audit Committee. 

In addition to the auditors’ remuneration above, $0.5 million of fees were paid to the Group’s auditors during the year ended 31 
December 2013 in relation to their work performed in their role as Reporting Accountant for LHL’s share issuance on 7 August 2013.  
The share issuance is discussed further in note 23. These fees are included in the Group’s consolidated balance sheet as a deduction  
to share premium.  

6. EMPLOYEE BENEFITS 

Wages and salaries 

Pension costs 

Bonus and other benefits 

Total cash compensation 

RSS – ordinary 

RSS – bonus deferral 

RSS – Cathedral acquisition grant 

Total equity based compensation 

Total employee benefits 

2014 
$m

27.4

3.0

23.7

54.1

12.6

3.2

7.5

23.3

77.4

2013 
$m

19.8

1.8

21.1

42.7

13.9

2.8

–

16.7

59.4

EQUITY BASED COMPENSATION 
The Group’s primary equity based compensation scheme is its RSS. Previously the Group also issued options to employees pursuant  
to an LTIP, which has been closed to further issues, and also authorised and issued warrants at its formation in 2005 and 2006. Further 
details of the warrants can be found in note 24.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

131 
131

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

6. EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CONTINUED 
RSS 
On 22 December 2010, LHL’s shareholders, in a Special General Meeting, voted in favour of the LHL Board’s proposal to modify  
the existing RSS awards programme to a nil-cost options programme. The modification introduced an exercise period of ten years from 
the grant date for all outstanding and future RSS grants. Previously, all awards were automatically converted to shares on the vesting date.  

The fair value of any TSR component of the nil-cost options is estimated using a stochastic model. For all other components the  
Black-Scholes model is used to estimate the fair value. 

The following table lists the assumptions used in the stochastic model for the RSS awards granted during the years ended 31 December 
2014 and 2013: 

Assumptions 

Dividend yield 
Expected volatility1 
Risk-free interest rate2 

Expected average life of options  

Share price 

2014

0.0%

22.0%

1.0%

3 years

$12.16

2013

0.0%

23.2%

0.40%

3 years

$13.79

(1)  The expected volatility of LHL and comparator companies’ share prices are calculated based on the movement in the share prices over a period prior to the grant date, equal in length to the expected life  

of the award.  

(2) The risk-free interest rate is consistent with 3 year UK government bond yields on the date of grant. 

The calculation of the equity based compensation expense assumes forfeitures due to employee turnover of 10.0 per cent per annum 
prior to vesting, with subsequent adjustments to reflect actual experience. 

RSS – ORDINARY 
The ordinary RSS options vest after a three-year period and are dependent on certain performance criteria. A maximum of 75.0 per cent 
of the ordinary RSS options will vest only on the achievement of an LHL RoE in excess of a required amount. A maximum of 25.0 per cent 
of the ordinary RSS options will vest only on the achievement of an LHL TSR in excess of the 75th percentile of the TSR of a predefined 
comparator group. For all RSS options issued in 2012 and earlier the performance criteria was split as 50.0 per cent relating to RoE and 
50.0 per cent relating to TSR. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is 
paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of RSS options that vest.  

Outstanding as at 31 December 2012 

Granted  

Exercised 

Forfeited  

Lapsed 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 

Granted  
Exercised1 

Forfeited  
Lapsed1 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2014 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2014 

Number of 
employee  
restricted stock  

Number of 
non-employee 
restricted stock 

Total number of 
restricted stock 

4,914,823 

1,236,971 

561,327

–

5,476,150

1,236,971

(1,443,649)

(150,975)

(1,594,624)

(369,810)

(17,574)

4,320,761 

1,157,761 

–

(1,525)

(369,810)

(19,099)

408,827

4,729,588

–

1,157,761

(1,894,668)

(186,994)

(2,081,662)

(166,857)

(262,781)

3,154,216 

1,316,281 

–

–

221,833

221,833

(166,857)

(262,781)

3,376,049

1,538,114

(1)  Richard Brindle, the Group’s former CEO, retired on 30 April 2014. He was treated as a good leaver and in line with RSS plan rules his outstanding unvested performance awards were tested for performance 
at cessation. Based on the agreed upon vesting conditions 406,129 awards vested and 262,781 lapsed. Mr Brindle exercised these awards plus an additional 138,086 vested awards and opted to receive 
payment in cash. These vested awards have been treated as cash-settled under IFRS 2. 

132 
132 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
2014 

2013 

Employee 
restricted stock

Non-employee 
restricted stock

Total 
restricted stock

Employee  
restricted stock 

Non-employee 
restricted stock

Total 
restricted stock

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

7.9 years

6.8 years

7.9 years

7.9 years 

7.5 years

7.9 years

Weighted average fair value at date of grant during 
the year 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise 
during the year 

$12.25

–

$12.25

$11.80 

–

$11.80

$11.35

$10.66

$11.29

$12.80 

$12.44

$12.76

RSS – BONUS DEFERRAL 
The bonus deferral RSS options vesting periods range from one to three years from the date of grant and do not have associated 
performance criteria for vesting. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues  
and is paid at the time of exercise. 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2012 

Granted  

Exercised 

Forfeited 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 

Granted  
Exercised1 

Forfeited 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2014 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2014 

Number of 
employee  
restricted stock  

Number of 
non-employee 
restricted stock 

Total number of 
restricted stock 

657,343 

179,633 

103,639

7,664

760,982

187,297

(470,410)

(86,382)

(556,792)

(11,345)

355,221 

278,608 

(266,228)

(3,991)

363,610 

74,079 

–

(11,345)

24,921

–

380,142

278,608

(11,183)

(277,411)

–

(3,991)

13,738

–

377,348

74,079

(1)  Richard Brindle, the Group’s former CEO, retired on 30 April 2014. He was treated as a good leaver and in line with RSS plan rules his 132,643 outstanding bonus deferral awards vested in full at cessation.  

Mr Brindle exercised these awards plus an additional 40,568 vested awards and opted to receive payment in cash. These vested awards have been treated as cash-settled under IFRS 2. 

2014 

2013 

Employee 
restricted stock

Non-employee 
restricted stock

Total 
restricted stock

Employee  
restricted stock 

Non-employee 
restricted stock

Total 
restricted stock

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

8.4 years

7.6 years

8.4 years

8.4 years 

8.5 years

8.4 years

Weighted average fair value at date of grant during 
the year 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise 
during the year 

$12.14

–

$12.14

$13.84 

$12.71

$13.85

$11.40

$11.08

$11.39

$12.59 

$12.48

$12.57

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

133 
133

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

6. EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CONTINUED  
RSS – CATHEDRAL ACQUISITION 
The Cathedral acquisition RSS options vesting periods range from three to five years and are dependent on certain performance criteria. 
A maximum of 75.0 per cent of the Cathedral acquisition RSS options will vest only on the achievement of a Cathedral combined ratio 
below a required amount. A maximum of 25.0 per cent of the Cathedral acquisition RSS options will vest only on the achievement of  
an LHL RoE in excess of a required amount. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise  
date accrues and is paid at the time of exercise. The awards are not exercisable as at 31 December 2014. 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2012 

Granted  

Outstanding as at 31 December 2014 and 2013 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average fair value at date of grant  

Total number of 
restricted stock 

–

2,307,157

2,307,157

Total restricted stock 

8.9 years

$13.01

LTIP 
The LTIP plan was closed on 4 January 2008. 25.0 per cent of LTIP options vested on each of the first, second, third and fourth 
anniversary of the grant date. There were no associated performance criteria. All outstanding LTIP options were exercised during 2013. 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 and 2012 

Exercised  

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2014 and 2013 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Number

Weighted average 
exercise price 

133,836

(133,836)

–

2014

–

–

$0.98

$0.80

–

2013

–

$13.23

As approved by the Remuneration Committee on 18 November 2009, all option exercise prices were automatically adjusted on  
the dividend record date to neutralise the devaluing impact of dividends payments. 

134 
134 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MANAGEMENT TEAM ORDINARY WARRANTS  
Ordinary warrants were all fully vested by 31 December 2008. All ordinary warrants will expire ten years from the date of issue. The fair 
value of all ordinary warrants granted was $2.62 per warrant. Ordinary warrants granted and outstanding are: 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 and 2012 

Exercised  

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2014 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Number

Weighted average 
exercise price 

6,184,399

(5,625,217)

559,182

$4.64

$4.63

$4.72

2014

2013

1.0 year

$10.55

2.0 years

–

MANAGEMENT TEAM PERFORMANCE WARRANTS  
Performance warrants were all fully vested by 31 December 2009. All performance warrants will expire ten years from the date of  
issue. Vesting was dependent on achieving certain performance criteria. The fair value of all warrants granted was $2.62 per warrant.  
The exercise price of warrants was automatically adjusted for dividends declared prior to their vesting dates. 

Performance warrants granted and outstanding are: 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 and 2012 

Exercised  

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2014 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Refer to note 24 for further disclosure on non-management warrants outstanding.  

7. FINANCING COSTS 

Interest expense on long-term debt 

Net losses (gains) on interest rate swaps 

Other financing costs 

Total  

Refer to note 22 for details of long-term debt and financing arrangements. 

Number

Weighted average 
exercise price 

859,445

(741,965)

117,480

$3.62

$3.62

$3.62

2014

2013

1.0 year

$11.07

2.0 years

–

2014 $m

2013 $m

15.5

7.4

0.9

23.8

13.2

(5.2)

0.9

8.9

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

135 
135

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

8. TAX CHARGE 
BERMUDA 
LHL, LICL and LUK have received an undertaking from the Bermuda government exempting them from all Bermuda local  
income, withholding and capital gains taxes until 28 March 2035. At the present time no such taxes are levied in Bermuda. 

UNITED KINGDOM  
LHL and its UK subsidiaries are subject to normal UK corporation tax on all their taxable profits.  

Tax charge 

Corporation tax charge (credit) for the period 

Adjustments in respect of prior period corporation tax 

Deferred tax (credit) charge for the period 

Tax rate change adjustment 

Adjustments in respect of prior period deferred tax 

Total tax credit 

Tax reconciliation 

Profit before tax 

UK corporation tax at 21.5% (2013 – 23.3%) 

Non-taxable income 

Adjustments in respect of prior period 

Differences related to equity based compensation 

Other expense permanent differences 

Tax rate change adjustment 

Unused tax losses not recognised for deferred tax 

Total tax credit 

2014 
$m

0.4

0.2

(2.9)

(0.8)

–

(3.1)

2014 
$m

226.5

48.7

(59.8)

0.2

(8.5)

2.2

(0.8)

14.9

(3.1)

2013 
$m

(2.6)

(1.1)

3.8

(2.9)

(1.0)

(3.8)

2013 
$m

218.1

50.7

(51.0)

(2.1)

0.1

1.4

(2.9)

–

(3.8)

Due to the different taxpaying jurisdictions throughout the Group, the current tax charge as a percentage of the Group’s profit before  
tax is 0.3 per cent (2013 – negative 1.7 per cent).  

A corporation tax credit of $nil (2013 – $1.1 million) was recognised in other reserves which relates to tax deductions for equity based 
compensation award exercises in excess of the cumulative expense at the reporting date. Refer to note 16 for further details of tax credits 
included in other reserves. 

Refer to note 10 for details of the tax expense related to the net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments that is included  
in accumulated other comprehensive income within shareholders’ equity.  

The UK corporation tax rate as at 31 December 2014 was 21.0 per cent (effective from 1 April 2014). Until 1 April 2014 the UK 
corporation tax rate of 23.0 per cent applied. On 17 July 2013 reductions to 21.0 per cent from 1 April 2014 and to 20.0 per cent  
from 1 April 2015 were enacted. These rates have been reflected in the closing deferred tax position on the balance sheet. 

136 
136 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
9. CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS 

Cash at bank and in hand  

Cash equivalents  

Total cash and cash equivalents 

2014 
$m

210.6

92.9

303.5

2013 
$m

297.2

105.8

403.0

Cash equivalents have an original maturity of three months or less. The carrying amount of these assets approximates their fair  
value. Refer to note 22 for the cash and cash equivalent balances on deposit as collateral.  

10. INVESTMENTS 

As at 31 December 2014 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

– Short-term investments 

– Fixed income funds 

– U.S. treasuries 

– Other government bonds 

– U.S. municipal bonds 

– U.S. government agency debt 

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Bank loans  

– Corporate bonds 

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Total investments 

Cost or 
amortised cost 
$m

Gross  
unrealised gain  
$m 

Gross 
unrealised loss 
$m

Estimated 
fair value 
$m

30.4

17.1

363.0

88.5

28.6

17.3

185.1

165.9

20.9

2.4

39.0

131.2

707.0

1,796.4

30.0

15.8

150.0

–

1,992.2

– 

0.5 

1.0 

0.8 

0.4 

0.3 

0.3 

2.8 

0.3 

– 

0.6 

0.1 

3.4 

10.5 

1.2 

2.0 

4.3 

0.7 

18.7 

–

(2.2)

(1.0)

(5.3)

(0.1)

(0.1)

(1.3)

(0.7)

(0.4)

–

–

(3.4)

(5.3)

(19.8)

–

(2.0)

(2.2)

–

30.4

15.4

363.0

84.0

28.9

17.5

184.1

168.0

20.8

2.4

39.6

127.9

705.1

1,787.1

31.2

15.8

152.1

0.7

(24.0)

1,986.9

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

137 
137

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

10. INVESTMENTS CONTINUED  

As at 31 December 2013 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

– Short-term investments 

– Fixed income funds 

– U.S. treasuries 

– Other government bonds 

– U.S. municipal bonds 

– U.S. government agency debt 

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Bank loans  

– Corporate bonds 

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Other investments 

Total investments 

Cost or 
amortised cost 
$m

Gross  
unrealised gain  
$m 

Gross 
unrealised loss 
$m

Estimated
 fair value 
$m

231.0

26.4

218.5

111.1

21.3

99.0

150.4

252.5

8.7

4.1

36.9

107.3

698.0

1,965.2

30.0

15.1

2.6

2,012.9

0.1 

0.4 

0.1 

0.8 

0.3 

– 

1.1 

3.5 

0.1 

0.1 

1.0 

0.6 

6.0 

14.1 

– 

0.8 

3.5 

18.4 

(0.1)

(0.5)

(1.3)

(4.0)

(0.2)

(0.8)

(0.1)

(4.0)

–

–

–

(0.1)

(2.1)

(13.2)

(0.4)

(0.3)

(1.4)

(15.3)

231.0

26.3

217.3

107.9

21.4

98.2

151.4

252.0

8.8

4.2

37.9

107.8

701.9

1,966.1

29.6

15.6

4.7

2,016.0

2013 
$m

14.9

(13.5)

1.8

(0.3)

2.9

Accumulated other comprehensive income is in relation to the Group’s AFS fixed income and equity securities and is as follows: 

Gross unrealised gains  

Gross unrealised losses  

Net foreign exchange losses on fixed income – AFS 

Tax provision 

Accumulated other comprehensive income 

2014 
$m

12.5

(21.8)

10.3

(0.2)

0.8

Fixed income maturities are presented in the risk disclosures section on page 121. Refer to note 22 for the investment balances in trusts  
in favour of ceding companies and on deposit as collateral.  

The fair value of securities in the Group’s investment portfolio is estimated using the following techniques: 

LEVEL (I) 
Level (i) investments are securities with quoted prices in active markets. A financial instrument is regarded as quoted in an active market  
if quoted prices are readily and regularly available from an exchange, dealer, broker, industry group, pricing service or regulatory agency 
and those prices represent actual and regularly occurring market transactions on an arm’s length basis. The Group determines securities 
classified as level (i) to include highly liquid U.S. treasuries, certain highly liquid short-term investments and quoted equity securities.  

138 
138 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
LEVEL (II) 
Level (ii) investments are securities with quoted prices in active markets for similar assets or liabilities or other valuation techniques  
for which all significant inputs are based on observable market data. Instruments included in level (ii) are valued via independent  
external sources using modeled or other valuation methods. Such methods are typically industry accepted standard and include: 

  broker-dealer quotes; 

  pricing models or matrix pricing; 

  present values; 

  future cash flows; 

  yield curves; 

  interest rates; 

  prepayment speeds; and 

  default rates.  

Other similar quoted instruments or market transactions may be used.  

The Group determines securities classified as level (ii) to include short-term and fixed maturity investments such as: 

  Non-U.S. government bonds; 

  U.S. municipal bonds; 

  U.S. government agency debt; 

  Asset backed securities;  

  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities; 

  Non-agency mortgage backed securities; 

  Bank loans; 

  Corporate bonds; and 

  OTC derivatives, including futures, options, forward foreign exchange contracts, interest rate swaps, credit default swaps and swaptions. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

139 
139

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

10. INVESTMENTS CONTINUED 
LEVEL (III) 
Level (iii) investments are securities for which valuation techniques are not based on observable market data. The Group classifies  
hedge funds as Level (iii) assets as the valuation technique incorporates both observable and unobservable inputs.  

The estimated fair values of the Group’s hedge funds are determined using a combination of the most recent NAVs provided by each 
fund’s independent administrator and the estimated performance provided by each hedge fund manager. Independent administrators 
provide monthly reported NAVs with up to a one-month delay in valuation. The most recent NAV available for each hedge fund is 
adjusted for the estimated performance, as provided by the fund manager, between the NAV date and the reporting date. Estimated  
fair values incorporating these performance estimates have not been significantly different from subsequent NAVs. Given the Group’s 
knowledge of the underlying investments and the size of the Group’s investment therein, we would not anticipate any material variance 
between estimated valuations. 

The Group determines the estimated fair value of each individual security utilising the highest level inputs available. Prices for the Group’s 
investment portfolio are provided by a third-party investment accounting firm whose pricing processes and the controls thereon are 
subject to an annual audit on both the operation, and the effectiveness, of those controls. The audit reports are available to clients of  
the firm and the report is reviewed annually by management. In accordance with their pricing policy, various recognised reputable  
pricing sources are used including index providers, broker-dealers and pricing vendors. The pricing sources use bid prices where 
available, otherwise indicative prices are quoted based on observable market trade data. The prices provided are compared to the 
investment managers’ and custodian’s pricing. The Group has not made any adjustments to any pricing provided by independent  
pricing services or its third-party investment managers for either year ending 31 December. 

The Group determines whether transfers have occurred between levels of the fair value hierarchy by re-assessing the categorisation  
at the end of each reporting period based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement as a whole.  

The fair value hierarchy of the Group’s investment holdings is as follows:  

Level (i) 
$m 

 Level (ii)  
$m  

 Level (iii)
 $m

Total 
$m 

30.3

–

363.0

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

0.1 

15.4 

– 

84.0 

28.9 

17.5 

184.1 

168.0 

20.8 

2.4 

39.6 

127.9 

705.1 

393.3

1,393.8 

–

–

–

–

31.2 

15.8 

– 

0.7 

393.3

1,441.5 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

152.1

–

152.1

30.4

15.4

363.0

84.0

28.9

17.5

184.1

168.0

20.8

2.4

39.6

127.9

705.1

1,787.1

31.2

15.8

152.1

0.7

1,986.9

As at 31 December 2014 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

– Short-term investments 

– Fixed income funds 

– U.S. treasuries  

– Other government bonds 

– U.S. municipal bonds 

– U.S. government agency debt 

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Bank loans 

– Corporate bonds  

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Other investments  

Total investments 

140 
140 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
As at 31 December 2013 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

– Short-term investments 

– Fixed income funds 

– U.S. treasuries  

– Other government bonds 

– U.S. municipal bonds 

– U.S. government agency debt 

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Bank loans 

– Corporate bonds  

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Other investments  

Total investments 

Level (i) 
$m 

 Level (ii)  
$m  

 Level (iii)
 $m

Total 
$m 

153.5

–

217.3

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

77.5 

26.3 

– 

107.9 

21.4 

98.2 

151.4 

252.0 

8.8 

4.2 

37.9 

107.8 

701.9 

370.8

1,595.3 

–

15.6

–

29.6 

– 

4.7 

386.4

1,629.6 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

231.0

26.3

217.3

107.9

21.4

98.2

151.4

252.0

8.8

4.2

37.9

107.8

701.9

1,966.1

29.6

15.6

4.7

2,016.0

2014 
$m

–

150.0

2.1

152.1

There have been no transfers between Levels (i) and (ii), therefore no reconciliations have been presented. 

The table below analyses the movements in assets classified as Level (iii) investments during the year ended 31 December 2014: 

As at 31 December 2013  

Purchases  

Total net gains recognised in other investment income in profit or loss 

As at 31 December 2014 

During the year ended 31 December 2014, the Group recognised $4.3 million of unrealised gains in other investment income in profit  
or loss for Level (iii) investments held at the reporting date. During the year ended 31 December 2013, the Group did not hold any  
Level (iii) investments. 

11. INTERESTS IN STRUCTURED ENTITIES 
A. CONSOLIDATED STRUCTURED ENTITIES 
The Group’s only consolidated structured entity is the EBT. The Group provides capital contributions to the EBT to enable it to meet  
its obligations to employees under the equity based compensation plans. The Group has a contractual agreement which may require  
it to provide financial support to the EBT. 

B. UNCONSOLIDATED STRUCTURED ENTITIES IN WHICH THE GROUP HAS AN INTEREST 
As part of its investment activities, the Group invests in unconsolidated structured entities. As at December 2014, the Group’s total interest 
in unconsolidated structured entities was $619.7 million. The Group does not sponsor any of the unconsolidated structured entities. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

141 
141

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

11. INTERESTS IN STRUCTURED ENTITIES CONTINUED 
As at 31 December 2014, a summary of the Group’s interest in unconsolidated structured entities is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2014 

Fixed income securities  

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed income securities  

Investment funds 

– Hedge funds  

Total investment funds 

Specialised investment vehicles 

– KHL (see note 17) 

Total 

Investments  
$m 

Interest in associates
$m

Total 
$m

184.1 

168.0 

20.8 

2.4 

39.6 

414.9 

152.1 

152.1 

– 

567.0 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

52.7

52.7

184.1

168.0

20.8

2.4

39.6

414.9

152.1

152.1

52.7

619.7

The fixed income securities structured entities are created to meet specific investment needs of borrowers and investors which cannot  
be met from standardised financial instruments available in the capital markets. As such, they provide liquidity to the borrowers in these 
markets and provide investors with an opportunity to diversify risk away from standard fixed income securities. Whilst individual securities 
may differ in structure, the principles of the instruments are broadly the same and it is appropriate to aggregate the investments into the 
categories detailed above. 

The risk that the Group faces in respect of the investments in structured entities is similar to the risk it faces in respect of other financial 
investments held on the balance sheet in that fair value is determined by market supply and demand. This is in turn driven by investor 
evaluation of the credit risk of the structure and changes in term structure of interest rates which change investors expectation of the  
cash flows associated with the instrument and, therefore, its value in the market. Risk management disclosure for these financial 
instruments and other investments is provided on pages 111 to 123. The total assets of these entities are not considered meaningful  
for the purpose of understanding the related risks and therefore have not been presented. 

The maximum exposure to loss in respect of these structured entities would be the carrying value of the instruments that the Group  
holds as at 31 December 2014. Generally, default rates would have to increase substantially from their current level before the Group 
would suffer a loss and this assessment is made prior to investing and continually through the holding period for the security.  

The Group has not provided any other financial or other support in relation to any other to that described above as at the reporting  
date, and there are no intentions to provide support in relation to any other unconsolidated structured entities in the foreseeable future. 

12. REINSURANCE ASSETS AND LIABILITIES 

As at 31 December 2012 

Acquired in the Cathedral acquisition 
Net deferral for prior years1 

Net deferral for current year 

Other 

As at 31 December 2013 

Net deferral for prior years  

Net deferral for current year 

Other 

As at 31 December 2014 

(1) Includes movement in deferral for reinsurance assets and liabilities acquired in the acquisition of Cathedral. 

142 
142 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Unearned 
premiums ceded 
$m

Amounts payable  
to reinsurers 
 $m 

Other 
receivables 
$m

11.5

17.2

(23.3)

9.5

–

14.9

(14.9)

24.7

–

24.7

(30.6)

(22.0)

– 

– 

21.7 

(30.9)

– 

– 

(3.3)

(34.2)

4.5

13.7

–

–

(7.4)

10.8

–

–

(5.5)

5.3

Total 
$m

(14.6)

8.9

(23.3)

9.5

14.3

(5.2)

(14.9)

24.7

(8.8)

(4.2)

 
 
 
 
 
13. LOSSES AND LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES 

As at 31 December 2012 

Assumed in the Cathedral acquisition 

Net incurred losses for: 

Prior years 

Current year 

Exchange adjustments 

Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Net paid losses for: 

Prior years 

Current year 

Paid losses and loss adjustment expenses 

As at 31 December 2013 

Net incurred losses for: 

Prior years 

Current year 

Exchange adjustments 

Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Net paid losses for: 

Prior years 

Current year 

Paid losses and loss adjustment expenses 

As at 31 December 2014 

 Losses and  
loss adjustment 
expenses  
$m 

537.4 

331.5 

41.9 

208.1 

(13.6)

236.4 

200.3 

51.6 

251.9 

853.4 

(40.8)

278.7 

(11.8)

226.1 

265.8 

61.1 

326.9 

752.6 

Reinsurance 
recoveries 
$m

(73.0)

(107.3)

(57.8)

(4.1)

(0.7)

(62.6)

(59.8)

(0.1)

(59.9)

(183.0)

6.4

(17.8)

0.8

(10.6)

(76.4)

(4.8)

(81.2)

(112.4)

Net losses and 
loss adjustment 
expenses 
$m

464.4

224.2

(15.9)

204.0

(14.3)

173.8

140.5

51.5

192.0

670.4

(34.4)

260.9

(11.0)

215.5

189.4

56.3

245.7

640.2

Further information on the calculation of loss reserves and the risks associated with them is provided in the risk disclosures section from 
page 108. The risks associated with general insurance contracts are complex and do not readily lend themselves to meaningful sensitivity 
analysis. The impact of an unreported event could lead to a significant increase in the Group’s loss reserves. The Group believes that the 
loss reserves established are adequate, however a 20.0 per cent increase in estimated losses would lead to a $150.5 million (2013 – $170.7 
million) increase in gross loss reserves. There was no change to the Group’s reserving methodology during the year. The split of losses and 
loss adjustment expenses between notified outstanding losses, additional case reserves assessed by management and IBNR is shown below:  

As at 31 December 

Outstanding losses 

Additional case reserves 

Losses incurred but not reported 

Total  

2014 

 $m

369.3

159.7

223.6

752.6

% 

49.1 

21.2 

29.7 

100.0 

2013 

$m

501.1

115.0

237.3

853.4

%

58.7

13.5

27.8

100.0

The Group’s reserve for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses as at 31 December 2014 and 2013 had an estimated duration  
of approximately two years.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

143 
143

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

13. LOSSES AND LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES CONTINUED 
CLAIMS DEVELOPMENT 
The development of insurance liabilities is indicative of the Group’s ability to estimate the ultimate value of its insurance liabilities. The 
Group began writing insurance and reinsurance business in December 2005. With the acquisition of Cathedral, the Group has assumed 
loss reserves relating to 2001 and subsequent years.  

Accident year 

Group gross losses1 
Estimate of ultimate liability2 

At end of accident year 

One year later 

Two years later 

Three years later 

Four years later 

Five years later 

Six years later 

Seven years later 

Eight years later 

2006  
and prior  
$m 

39.1 

34.7 

32.0 

27.6 

27.2 

24.4 

24.0 

60.6 

58.6 

2007 
$m

2008 
$m

2009 
$m

2010 
$m

2011
 $m

2012  
$m 

2013 
 $m 

2014
$m

Total 
$m

274.8

280.0 

259.8 

250.3 

350.4 

338.8 

397.0

371.9

447.0

450.4

297.4

209.4

204.2

235.8

229.4

163.3

107.8

73.1

66.0

89.1

81.7

444.6

417.4

377.5

345.1

340.8

355.6

350.9

154.8

131.2

103.5

94.8

83.5

81.0

87.6

87.8

Current estimate of cumulative liability  

58.6 

87.8

350.9

81.7

229.4

450.4

338.8 

259.8 

274.8

2,132.2

Payments made 

(26.0)

(78.9)

(337.6)

(57.0)

(188.6)

(262.1)

(233.3)

(135.0) 

(61.1) (1,379.6)

Total Group gross liability 

32.6 

8.9

13.3

24.7

40.8

188.3

105.5 

124.8 

213.7

752.6

(1)  Balances at 31 December 2013 include the addition of losses assumed in the Cathedral acquisition on 7 November 2013. 

(2) Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2014. 

Accident year 

Reinsurance1  
Estimate of ultimate recovery2 

At end of accident year 

One year later 

Two years later 

Three years later 

Four years later 

Five years later 

Six years later 

Seven years later 

Eight years later 

Current estimate of cumulative recovery  

Payments made 

Total Group gross recovery 

2006  
and prior  
$m 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

25.1 

25.1 

25.1 

(2.3)

22.8 

2007 
$m

2008 
$m

2009 
$m

2010 
$m

2011 
$m

2012  
$m 

2013  
$m 

2014
$m

Total 
$m

17.8

9.9 

8.9 

48.9 

121.8 

122.0 

56.2

52.6

92.4

88.9

33.8

23.6

24.1

33.5

34.4

1.6

1.3

0.7

0.7

10.0

7.0

40.7

47.1

43.1

40.9

38.1

40.7

39.8

3.6

6.2

4.0

3.5

3.3

3.1

4.0

4.1

4.1

39.8

7.0

34.4

88.9

122.0 

8.9 

17.8

348.0

(3.5)

(38.7)

(1.9)

(28.0)

(42.2)

(110.6)

(3.6) 

(4.8)

(235.6)

0.6

1.1

5.1

6.4

46.7

11.4 

5.3 

13.0

112.4

(1)  Balances at 31 December 2013 include the addition of losses assumed in the Cathedral acquisition on 7 November 2013. 

(2) Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2014. 

144 
144 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accident year 

Net Group losses1 
Estimate of ultimate liability2 

At end of accident year 

One year later 

Two years later 

Three years later 

Four years later 

Five years later 

Six years later 

Seven years later 

Eight years later 

2006  
and prior  
$m 

39.1 

34.7 

32.0 

27.6 

27.2 

24.4 

24.0 

35.5 

33.5 

2007 
$m

2008 
$m

2009 
$m

2010
 $m

2011 
$m

2012 
 $m 

2013 
$m

2014 
$m

Total 
$m

257.0

270.1

250.9

201.4 

228.6 

216.8 

340.8

319.3

354.6

361.5

263.6

185.8

180.1

202.3

195.0

161.7

106.5

72.4

65.3

79.1

74.7

403.9

370.3

334.4

304.2

302.7

314.9

311.1

151.2

125.0

99.5

91.3

80.2

77.9

83.6

83.7

Current estimate of cumulative liability  

33.5 

83.7

311.1

74.7

195.0

361.5

216.8 

250.9

257.0

1,784.2

Payments made 

(23.7)

(75.4)

(298.9)

(55.1)

(160.6)

(219.9)

(122.7)

(131.4)

(56.3) (1,144.0)

Total Group net liability 

9.8 

8.3

12.2

19.6

34.4

141.6

94.1 

119.5

200.7

640.2

(1) Balances at 31 December 2013 include the addition of losses assumed in the Cathedral acquisition on 7 November 2013. 

(2) Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2014. 

The inherent uncertainty in reserving gives rise to favourable or adverse development on the established reserves. The total favourable 
development on net losses and loss adjustment expenses, excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, was as follows: 

2006 accident year and prior 

2007 accident year 

2008 accident year 

2009 accident year 

2010 accident year 

2011 accident year 

2012 accident year 

2013 accident year 

Total favourable development 

2014 
$m

1.8

(0.3)

3.6

4.3

5.7

(6.1)

11.1

14.3

34.4

2013 
$m

(0.7)

(0.9)

(4.1)

2.0

1.4

(4.1)

22.3

–

15.9

The favourable prior year development in 2014 arose primarily from IBNR releases due to lower than expected reported losses and 
releases on settlement of outstanding losses, offset by adverse development on prior accident year mid-sized marine and energy claims. 
The favourable prior year development in 2013 arose primarily from IBNR releases due to fewer than expected reported losses, a benefit 
from the settlement on our North East ILW in relation to Sandy and releases on the settlement of outstanding losses. This favourable 
development was offset to an extent by unfavourable development of $33.5 million after reinsurance on the Costa Concordia marine loss.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

145 
145

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

13. LOSSES AND LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES CONTINUED 
During 2012 the Group was impacted by significant losses in relation to the total loss of the Costa Concordia. Management’s current best 
estimate of the ultimate net loss in relation to this event is $100.7 million. The 90th percentile of the loss distribution for this estimate is 
$103.3 million with the 95th percentile being $104.2 million. Significant uncertainty exists on the eventual ultimate loss in relation to  
this event. 

During 2012 the Group was also impacted by significant losses in relation to Sandy. Management’s current best estimate of the ultimate 
net loss in relation to this event is $24.7 million. The 90th percentile of the loss distribution for this estimate is $48.7 million with the  
95th percentile being $50.6 million. Significant uncertainty exists on the eventual ultimate loss. 

The Group’s estimated ultimate net losses, after reinstatement premiums, for these significant events are as follows: 

Costa Concordia 
$m

59.2

–

67.7

(34.2)

4.4

97.1

3.9

–

(0.3)

100.7

Net 
$m

67.2

123.7

(117.3)

73.6

169.3

(138.4)

104.5

Net ultimate losses as at 31 December 2012 

Assumed in the Cathedral acquisition  

Change in insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Change in insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 

Change in reinstatement premium 

Net ultimate losses as at 31 December 2013 

Change in insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Change in insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 

Change in reinstatement premium 

Net ultimate losses as at 31 December 2014 

Sandy 
$m

44.5

6.8

3.4

(23.6)

(0.4)

30.7

(6.3)

–

0.3

24.7

14. INSURANCE, REINSURANCE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES 
All receivables are considered current other than $71.3 million (2013 – $52.1 million) of inwards premiums receivable related  
to multi-year contracts. The carrying value approximates fair value due to the short-term nature of the receivables. There are  
no significant concentrations of credit risk within the Group’s receivables. 

15. DEFERRED ACQUISITION COSTS AND DEFERRED ACQUISITION COSTS CEDED 
The reconciliation between opening and closing deferred acquisition costs incurred and ceded is shown below: 

As at 31 December 2012 

Net deferral during the year 

(Expense) income for the year 

As at 31 December 2013 

Net deferral during the year 

(Expense) income for the year 

As at 31 December 2014 

Incurred  
$m 

68.0 

132.4 

(126.6)

73.8 

177.6 

(146.8)

104.6 

Ceded 
$m

(0.8)

(8.7)

9.3

(0.2)

(8.3)

8.4

(0.1)

146 
146 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
16. PROVISION FOR DEFERRED TAX 

Equity based compensation 

Claims equalisation reserves  

Syndicate underwriting profits 

Syndicate participation rights 

Other temporary differences 

Tax losses carried forward 

Net deferred tax liability  

2014 
$m

3.2

(15.1)

(13.3)

(16.0)

(0.2)

2.7

(38.7)

2013  
$m 

8.5 
(16.7) 
(11.2) 
(16.4) 
(5.1) 
2.2 
(38.7) 

A deferred tax charge of $4.4 million (2013 – $0.5 million credit) was recognised in other reserves which relates to deferred tax credits  
for unexercised equity based compensation awards where the estimated market value is in excess of the cumulative expense at the 
reporting date. 

Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through future taxable profits is likely. It is 
anticipated that sufficient taxable profits will be available within the Group in 2015 and subsequent years to utilise the deferred tax  
assets recognised when the underlying temporary differences reverse.  

A deferred tax asset of $18.7 million (2013 – $3.2 million) has not been recognised in relation to unused tax losses carried forward  
in LHL, as at present the related tax benefit is not expected to be realised through future taxable profits. 

All deferred tax assets and liabilities are classified as non-current. 

17. INVESTMENT IN ASSOCIATES 
KHL 
The Group holds a 10.0 per cent interest in the preference shares of each segregated account of KHL, a company incorporated  
in Bermuda. KHL’s operating subsidiary, KRL, is authorised by the BMA as a Special Purpose Insurer. KRL commenced writing  
insurance business on 1 January 2014. As at 31 December 2014, the carrying value of the Group’s investment in KHL was $52.7 million  
(31 December 2013 – $20.1 million). The Group’s share of comprehensive income for KHL for the period was $4.7 million  
(31 December 2013 – $nil). Key financial information for KHL is as follows: 

Assets 

Liabilities 

Shareholders’ equity 

Gross premium earned 

Comprehensive income 

(1) From the date of incorporation, 4 June 2013. 

2014
$m

551.2

24.6

526.6

79.8

47.0

20131 
$m 

201.2 
– 
201.2 
– 
– 

The Group has the power to participate in operational and financial policy decisions of KHL and KRL through the provision  
of essential technical information by KCML and has therefore classified its investment in KHL as an investment in associate. 

Refer to note 27 for details of transactions between the Group, KHL, KRL and KCML. 

During the year ended 31 December 2014, AHL, ARL, SHL and SRL were placed in member’s voluntary liquidation. As at 31 December 
2014, remaining assets and liabilities in AHL, ARL, SHL and SRL were negligible. As at 31 December 2014, the carrying value of the 
Group’s investment in AHL is $nil (31 December 2013 – $32.4 million). As at 31 December 2014, the carrying value of the Group’s 
investment in SHL is $nil (31 December 2013 – $12.2 million). The Group’s share of comprehensive income for AHL for the year  
ended was $1.1 million (31 December 2013 – $6.6 million). The Group’s share of comprehensive income for SHL for the year ended  
was $0.1 million (31 December 2013 – $2.6 million). 

Refer to note 27 for details of transactions between the Group, AHL, ARL, SHL and SRL. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

147 
147

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

18. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT  

Cost 

Accumulated depreciation 

Net book value 

19. INTANGIBLE ASSETS 

Net book value at 1 January 2013 

Acquired in the Cathedral acquisition 

Amortisation charge for the year through insurance acquisition expenses 

Amortisation charge for the year through other operating expenses 

Net book value at 31 December 2013 

Amortisation charge for the year through insurance acquisition expenses 

Amortisation charge for the year through other operating expenses 

Net book value at 31 December 2014 

2014 
$m

19.3

(10.2)

9.1

Value of 
in-force business 
$m

 Syndicate 
participation 
 rights  
$m 

Goodwill 
$m

–

36.6

(8.5)

(4.7)

23.4

(15.0)

(8.4)

–

– 

82.6 

– 

– 

82.6 

– 

– 

82.6 

–

71.2

–

–

71.2

–

–

71.2

2013
 $m

14.3

(11.5)

2.8

Total 
$m

–

190.4

(8.5)

(4.7)

177.2

(15.0)

(8.4)

153.8

Syndicate participation rights and goodwill are deemed to have indefinite life as they are expected to have value in use that does not 
diminish over the course of time. Consequently, the carrying value is not amortised but tested annually for impairment. The value of  
in-force business was amortised over the remaining life of the acquired insurance contracts, which was approximately one year. 

For the purpose of impairment testing, intangible assets are allocated to the Group’s CGUs, in accordance with the manner in which 
management operates and monitors the business. The syndicate participation rights and goodwill have therefore been allocated to the 
Lloyd’s CGU. 

When testing for impairment, the recoverable amount of the Lloyd’s CGU is determined based on value in use. Value in use is calculated using 
projected cash flows based on the financial projections of the CGU. These are approved by management and cover a 3 year period. The most 
significant assumptions used to derive the projected cash flows include an assessment of business prospects, projected loss ratios, outwards 
reinsurance expenditure and investment returns. A discount rate of 8.0 per cent has been used to discount the projected post tax cash flows, which 
reflects a combination of factors including the Group’s expected cost of equity and cost of borrowing. The growth rate used to extrapolate the cash 
flows of the unit beyond the 3 year period is 2.0 per cent based on historical growth rates and management’s best estimate of future growth rates. 

The results of this exercise indicate that the recoverable amount exceeds the intangible asset’s carrying value for both the syndicate 
participation rights and goodwill and would not be sensitive to any reasonably possible changes in assumptions. Therefore no impairment 
has been recognised during the year ended 31 December 2014 (2013 – $nil). 

20. INSURANCE LIABILITIES 

As at 31 December 2012 

Acquired in the Cathedral acquisition 
Net deferral for prior years1 

Net deferral for current year 

Other 

As at 31 December 2013 

Net deferral for prior years 

Net deferral for current year 

Other 

As at 31 December 2014 

(1) Includes movement in deferral for insurance liabilities acquired in the Cathedral acquisition. 

148 
148 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 Unearned  
premiums  
$m 

343.3 

123.1 

(275.9)

251.6 

– 

442.1 

(330.5)

367.5 

– 

479.1 

Other payables 
$m

23.5

6.3

–

–

(0.9)

28.9

–

–

11.9

40.8

Total 
$m

366.8

129.4

(275.9)

251.6

(0.9)

471.0

(330.5)

367.5

11.9

519.9

 
 
 
21. INSURANCE, REINSURANCE AND OTHER PAYABLES 

Other payables 

Accrued interest payable 

Total other payables 

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers  

Total payables  

2014 
$m

81.2

2.3

83.5

40.8

34.2

2013 
$m

78.5

2.2

80.7

28.9

30.9

158.5

140.5

Other payables include unsettled investment trades, accrued interest and other accruals. Insurance payables relate to amounts due  
to policyholders for profit commission, return premiums and claims payable. All payables are considered current. The carrying value 
approximates fair value due to the short-term nature of the payables. 

22. LONG-TERM DEBT AND FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS 
LONG-TERM DEBT 
On 5 October 2012, the Group issued U.S. $130.0 million 5.70 per cent senior unsecured notes due 2022 pursuant to a private offering  
to U.S. Qualified Institutional Buyers. Interest on the principal is payable semi-annually. The notes were listed and admitted to trading  
on the LSE on 16 October 2012.  

On 15 December 2005, the Group issued $97.0 million and €24.0 million in aggregate principal amount of floating rate subordinated  
loan notes. The U.S. dollar subordinated loan notes are repayable on 15 December 2035. Interest on the principal is based on a set 
margin, 3.70 per cent, above the three month LIBOR rate and is payable quarterly. The loan notes were issued via a trust company.  
The Euro subordinated loan notes are repayable on 15 June 2035. Interest on the principal is based on a set margin, 3.70 per cent,  
above the EURIBOR rate and is payable quarterly. On 21 October 2011, the Cayman Islands Stock Exchange admitted to the official  
list the Group’s U.S. dollar and Euro subordinated loan notes due 2035.  

In 2013, the Group assumed loan notes, issued by CCHL and listed on the ISE, as part of the Cathedral acquisition. The loan notes 
acquired are set out as follows: 

  €12.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 18 November 2004 and repayable in September 2034, paying interest 

quarterly based on a set margin, 3.75 per cent, above three month EURIBOR; 

  $10.0 million floating rate subordinated note loan issued on 26 November 2004 and repayable in September 2034, paying interest 

quarterly based on a set margin, 3.75 per cent, above three month LIBOR;  

  $25.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 13 May 2005 and repayable in June 2035, paying interest quarterly based  

on a set margin, 3.25 per cent, above three month LIBOR; and 

  $25.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 18 November 2005 and repayable in December 2035, paying interest 

quarterly based on a set margin, 3.25 per cent, above three month LIBOR. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

149 
149

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

22. LONG-TERM DEBT AND FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS CONTINUED 
The Group has the option to redeem its senior unsecured notes and all of its subordinated loan notes, in whole or in part, prior to  
the respective maturity dates. 

The carrying values of the notes are shown below: 

As at 31 December 

Long-term debt $130.0 million 

Long-term debt $97.0 million  

Long-term debt €24.0 million  

Long-term debt €12.0 million 

Long-term debt $10.0 million 

Long-term debt $25.0 million 

Long-term debt $25.0 million 

Carrying value 

2014 
$m

130.0

97.0

29.2

13.0

10.0

23.7

23.7

2013 
$m

130.0

97.0

33.0

14.9

10.0

23.7

23.7

326.6

332.3

The Group is exposed to cash flow interest rate risk and currency risk on its long-term debt. Further information is provided in the  
risk disclosures section on page 118. 

The fair value of the long-term debt is estimated as $347.2 million (2013 – $341.2 million). The fair value measurement is classified within 
Level (ii) of the fair value hierarchy. The fair value is estimated by reference to similar financial instruments quoted in active markets. 

The interest accrued on the long-term debt was $2.3 million (2013 – $2.2 million) at the balance sheet date and is included  
in other payables.  

Refer to note 7 for details of the interest expense for the year included in financing costs. 

INTEREST RATE SWAPS 
The Group hedges a portion of its floating rate borrowings using interest rate swaps to transfer floating to fixed rate. These instruments 
are held at estimated fair value. Refer to the risk disclosures section from page 117 for further details. The Group has the right to net  
settle these instruments.  

The net fair value position owed by the Group on the swap agreements is a $4.9 million liability. Further information is provided on  
pages 115 and 117. The Group has the right to net settle these instruments. Cash settlements are completed on a quarterly basis and the 
total of the next cash settlement in the first quarter of 2015 on these instruments is $0.7 million. The net impact from cash settlement and 
changes in estimated fair value is included in financing costs. 

The interest rate swaps are held at estimated fair value, priced using observable market inputs, and are therefore classified as Level (ii) 
securities in the fair value hierarchy. 

Refer to note 7 for the net impact from cash settlement and changes in estimated fair value included in financing costs. 

150 
150 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
LETTERS OF CREDIT 
As both LICL and LUK are non-admitted insurers or reinsurers throughout the U.S., the terms of certain contracts require them  
to provide LOCs to policyholders as collateral. LHL and LICL have the following facilities in place as at 31 December 2014:  

(i)  a $350.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility with a $75.0 million loan sub-limit that has been in place since 5 April 2012  

and will expire on 5 April 2017. There was no outstanding debt under this facility as at 31 December 2014 and 2013; and 

(ii) a $50.0 million bi-lateral uncommitted LOC facility with Citibank Europe PLC.  

The facilities are available for the issue of LOCs to ceding companies. The facilities are also available for LICL to issue LOCs to LUK  
to collateralise certain insurance balances.  

The terms of the $350.0 million LOC facility include standard default and cross-default provisions which require certain covenants  
to be adhered to. These include the following: 

(i)  an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B++; and 

(ii) a maximum debt to capital ratio of 30.0 per cent, where the subordinated loan notes are excluded from this calculation.  

As at all reporting dates the Group was in compliance with all covenants under these facilities. The $50.0 million bi-lateral uncommitted 
LOC facility does not contain default provisions or covenants. 

The following LOCs have been issued: 

As at 31 December  

Issued to third parties  

LOCs are required to be fully collateralised.  

2014 
$m

31.8

2013 
$m

20.1

SYNDICATE BANK FACILITIES 
As at 31 December 2014, Syndicate 2010 had in place an $80.0 million catastrophe facility with Barclays Bank plc. The facility is available  
to assist in paying claims and the gross funding of catastrophes for Syndicate 2010. Up to $50.0 million can be utilised by way of an LOC  
to assist Syndicate 2010’s gross funding requirements. 

As at 31 December 2014, Syndicate 3010 had in place a $40.0 million catastrophe facility with Barclays Bank plc. The facility is available  
to assist in paying claims and the gross funding of catastrophes for Syndicate 3010. Up to $20.0 million can be utilised by way of an LOC  
to assist gross funding requirements of Syndicate 3010. 

There are no balances outstanding under either of the syndicate bank facilities as at 31 December 2014 or 2013. The syndicate bank 
facilities are not available to the Group other than through its participation on the syndicates it supports. 

TRUSTS AND RESTRICTED BALANCES 
The Group has several trust arrangements in place in favour of policyholders and ceding companies in order to comply with the security 
requirements of certain reinsurance contracts and/or the regulatory requirements of certain jurisdictions.  

In 2012, LICL entered into an MBRT to collateralise its reinsurance liabilities associated with U.S. domiciled clients. As at 31 December 
2014, LICL had been granted authorised or trusteed reinsurer status in all States (31 December 2013 – 45 States). The MBRT is subject  
to the rules and regulations of the aforementioned States and the respective deed of trust. These rules and regulations include minimum 
capital funding requirements, investment guidelines, capital distribution restrictions and regulatory reporting requirements. 

As at and for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2013, the Group was in compliance with all covenants under its trust facilities. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

151 
151

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

22. LONG-TERM DEBT AND FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS CONTINUED 
The Group is required to hold a portion of its assets as FAL to support the underwriting capacity of Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010. FAL are 
restricted in their use and are only drawn down to pay cash calls to syndicates supported by the Group. FAL requirements are formally assessed  
twice a year and any funds surplus to requirements may be released at that time. See note 30 for more information regarding FAL requirements. 

In addition to the FAL, certain cash and investments held by Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 are only available for paying claims and expenses  
of the syndicate to their policyholders. See note 30 for more information regarding capital requirements for Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010. 

The following cash and cash equivalents and investment balances were held in trust, other collateral accounts in favour of third parties  
or are otherwise restricted: 

As at 31 December 

MBRT accounts 

In various other trust accounts for policyholders 

In favour of LOCs 

In favour of derivative contracts 

FAL 

Syndicate accounts 

Total 

23. SHARE CAPITAL 
Authorised ordinary shares of $0.50 each 

As at 31 December 2014 and 2013 

Cash and cash 
equivalents 
$m

2014 

Fixed income 
securities 
$m

Equity
securities
$m

Cash and cash 
equivalents  
$m 

0.3

0.7

8.0

1.5

6.9

6.9

24.3

31.3

22.9

25.3

1.7

167.5

89.6

338.3

–

–

–

–

15.8

–

15.8

1.0 

3.8 

6.3 

0.7 

14.2 

16.4 

42.4 

2013 

Fixed income 
securities 
$m

20.0

9.7

20.0

0.8

152.6

123.9

327.0

Equity
securities
 $m

–

–

–

–

14.9

–

14.9

Number

$m

3,000,000,000

1,500.0

Allocated, called up and fully paid  

As at 31 December 2012 

Shares issued 

As at 31 December 2013 

Shares issued 

As at 31 December 2014 

Own shares 

As at 31 December 2012 

Shares distributed 

Shares donated to trust  

As at 31 December 2013 

Shares distributed 

Shares repurchased 

Shares donated to trust  

Number

168,602,427

16,843,382

185,445,809

6,666,789

192,112,598

Number held
 in treasury

5,810,583

(435,120)

(1,862,138)

3,513,325

(666,434)

2,498,433

(2,394,377)

$m

40.7

(3.0)

(13.1)

24.6

Number held
 in trust

1,320,486

(2,276,285)

1,862,138

906,339

$m 

16.4 

(30.1)

25.9 

12.2 

Total number 
of own shares

7,131,069

(2,711,405)

–

4,419,664

(5.0)

(1,643,647)

(21.6)

(2,310,081)

25.0

–

– 

2,498,433

(16.8)

2,394,377

24.9 

–

$m

84.3

8.4

92.7

3.4

96.1

$m

57.1

(33.1)

12.8

36.8

(26.6)

25.0

8.1

As at 31 December 2014 
The number of common shares in issue with voting rights (allocated share capital less shares held in treasury) as at 31 December 2014  
was 189,161,651 (31 December 2013 – 181,932,484). 

4,608,016

2,950,947

1,657,069

15.5 

27.8

43.3

152 
152 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
 
 
 
 
On 7 August 2013, LHL issued 16,843,382 new common shares. As a result of these shares being issued, a total of $203.5 million  
was raised, $8.4 million of which was included in share capital and $195.1 million of which was included in share premium, net of  
$5.3 million of offering expenses. 

During 2014, the Group issued new common shares to satisfy the cashless exercises of warrants as follows: 

Shares issued 

23 May 2014 

13 June 2014 

3 July 2014 

Total 

Number of shares 
issued

2,077,605

1,759,974

2,829,210

6,666,789

$m

1.1

0.9

1.4

3.4

Of the shares issued on 23 May 2014 and 13 June 2014, per the table above 3,837,579 were issued to satisfy Richard Brindle’s  
warrant exercises (refer to note 27 for further information on related party transactions). 

SHARE REPURCHASES 
At the AGM held on 30 April 2014, the Group’s shareholders approved a renewal of the Repurchase Programme authorising the 
repurchase of a maximum of 18,544,580 shares, with such authority to expire on the conclusion of the 2015 AGM or, if earlier,  
fifteen months from the date the resolution approving the Repurchase Programme was passed.  

Shares have been repurchased by the Group under share repurchase authorisation as follows: 

Own shares 

As at 31 December 2012 

Shares distributed 

Shares donated to trust 

As at 31 December 2013 

Repurchased 

Shares distributed 

Shares donated to trust 

As at 31 December 2014 

Number of shares 
cancelled

Number of shares 
transferred to 
treasury shares 

Weighted average 
share price

27,541,552

5,810,583 

–

–

(435,120)

(1,862,138)

27,541,552

3,513,325 

–

–

–

2,498,433 

(666,434)

(2,394,377)

27,541,552

2,950,947 

£4.30

£4.30

£4.27

£4.31

£6.27

£4.77

£4.61

£4.43

At the balance sheet date $nil (31 December 2013 – $nil) remained to be settled. 

In 2014, the trustees of the EBT acquired nil shares (2013 – nil) in accordance with the terms of the trust and distributed 1,643,647  
(2013 – 2,276,285). There were no unsettled balances in relation to EBT purchases at either balance sheet date.  

DIVIDENDS 
The Board of Directors have authorised the following dividends: 

$m

244.5

(3.0)

(13.1)

228.4

25.0

(5.0)

(16.8)

231.6

$m

19.2

201.4

10.5

94.5

21.1

42.1

10.4

Per share amount

Record date 

Payment date

$0.10

$1.05

$0.05

$0.45

$0.10

$0.20

$0.05

22 Mar 2013 

17 Apr 2013

22 Mar 2013 

17 Apr 2013

23 Aug 2013 

25 Sep 2013

29 Nov 2013 

20 Dec 2013

21 Mar 2014 

16 Apr 2014

21 Mar 2014 

16 Apr 2014

29 Aug 2014 

24 Sep 2014

$1.20

28 Nov 2014 

19 Dec 2014

247.4

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

153 
153

Type 

Final  

Special 

Interim  

Special 

Final  

Special 

Interim 

Special 

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

24. OTHER RESERVES 
Other reserves represent the Group’s restricted shares, options and warrants. Changes in the number of restricted shares, options  
and management warrants held by employees are disclosed in note 6. The changes in the number of warrants held by non-employees  
are as follows: 

Outstanding at 31 December 2012 

Exercised 

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2013 

Exercised 

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2014 

Weighted average exercise price as at 31 December 2014 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Number of  
Founder warrants 

Number of 
Lancashire 
Foundation warrants

Number of 
ordinary 
warrants

19,803,572 

648,143

2,350,000

(728,785)

–

–

19,074,787 

648,143

2,350,000

(4,042,108)

–

–

15,032,679 

648,143

2,350,000

$5.00 

$4.73

$5.00

2014

2013

1.0 year

$11.25

2.0 years

$12.17

The fair value of all warrants granted was $2.62 per warrant. The exercise price of the Lancashire Foundation warrants was automatically 
adjusted for dividends declared prior to the vesting date. Refer to note 6 for further details. This did not apply to the Founder warrants  
as they were fully vested at the date of grant and exercisable upon issuance. 

25. LEASE COMMITMENTS 
The Group has payment obligations in respect of operating leases for certain items of office equipment and office space. Operating lease 
expenses for the year were $3.8 million (2013 – $2.4 million). Future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases  
are as follows: 

Due in less than one year  

Due between one and five years 

Due in more than five years 

Total 

2014 
$m

1.1

11.4

41.2

53.7

2013 
$m

2.9

6.9

–

9.8

During 2014, the Group entered into a new lease agreement for larger office premises in the UK and assigned the leases in relation to the 
existing office premises in the UK to a third party who assumed responsibility for payments. Under the terms of the lease assignment the 
Group retains liability for lease payments in the event that the assignee and the assignee’s guarantor fail to meet their obligations under 
the assignment agreements. The new lease agreement contains a break date of April 2029 and is guaranteed by the Group. 

26. EARNINGS PER SHARE 
The following reflects the profit and share data used in the basic and diluted earnings per share computations: 

Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders of LHL 

Basic weighted average number of shares 

Dilutive effect of RSS 

Dilutive effect of warrants 

Diluted weighted average number of shares 

154 
154 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

2014 
$m

229.3

2014 
Number
 of shares

2013 
$m

222.5

2013 
Number 
of shares

185,558,086

169,270,681

2,442,255

3,431,739

10,112,990

17,788,368

198,113,331

190,490,788

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings per share 

Basic 

Diluted 

2014

$1.24

$1.16

2013

$1.31

$1.17

Equity based compensation awards are only treated as dilutive when their conversion to common shares would decrease earnings per 
share or increase loss per share from continuing operations. Unvested restricted shares without performance criteria are therefore 
included in the number of potentially dilutive shares. Incremental shares from ordinary restricted share options where relevant 
performance criteria have not been met are not included in the calculation of dilutive shares. In addition, where options are anti-dilutive, 
they are not included in the number of potentially dilutive shares.  

27. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES  
The consolidated financial statements include LHL and the entities listed below: 

Name 

Subsidiaries1 

LICL 
SML2 
KCML3 
Lutine4 

KCMMSL 

LIHL 

LIMSL 

LISL 

LUK 

LMSCL 
CCIL5 

CCHL 

CCL 

CCL 1998 

CCL 1999 
CCL 20005 
CCML5 

CCSL 

CUL 

Associates 
AHL6 
AHL II7 
SHL8 

KHL 

Other controlled entities 

LHFT 

EBT 

Principal Business 

Domicile 

General insurance business 

Insurance management services 

Insurance management services 

Non trading 

Support services 

Holding company 

Insurance mediation activities 

Support services 

General insurance business 

Support services 

Holding company 

Investment company 

Holding company 

Lloyd’s corporate member 

Non trading 

Holding company 

Non trading 

Support services 

Lloyd’s managing agent 

Holding company 

Holding company 

Holding company 

Holding company 

Trust 

Trust 

Bermuda 

Bermuda 

Bermuda 

Bermuda 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

Canada 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

Bermuda 

Bermuda 

Bermuda 

Bermuda 

United States 

Jersey 

(1)  Unless otherwise stated, the Group owns 100 per cent of the ordinary share capital and voting rights in its subsidiaries listed. 

(2) SML was liquidated on 12 August 2014. 

(3) 92.68 per cent owned by the Group. 

(4) Lutine was dissolved on 29 May 2014. 

(5) The entities were formally placed in members’ voluntary liquidation on 11 December 2014. 

(6) AHL was liquidated on 15 October 2014. 

(7) AHL II was liquidated on 25 November 2014. 

(8) SHL was liquidated on 15 October 2014. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

155 
155

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

27. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES CONTINUED  
The Group has issued subordinated loan notes via a trust vehicle – LHFT, refer to note 22. The Group effectively has 100.0 per cent  
of the voting rights in LHFT. These rights are subject to the property trustee’s obligations to seek the approval of the holders of LHFT’s 
preferred securities in case of default and other limited circumstances where the property trustee would enforce its rights. While the 
ability of the Group to influence the actions of LHFT is limited by the trust agreement, LHFT was set up by the Group with the sole 
purpose of issuing the subordinated loan notes, is in essence controlled by the Group, and is therefore consolidated. 

The EBT was established to assist in the administration of the Group’s employee equity based compensation schemes. While the Group 
does not have legal ownership of the EBT and the ability of the Group to influence the actions of the EBT is limited by the trust deed,  
the EBT was set up by the Group with the sole purpose of assisting in the administration of these schemes, is in essence controlled by  
the Group, and is therefore consolidated. 

The Group has a Loan Facility Agreement (the ‘Facility‘) with RBC Cees Trustee Limited, the trustees of the EBT. The Facility is an 
interest free revolving credit facility under which the Trustee can request advances on demand, within the terms of the facility, up to a 
maximum aggregate of $60.0 million. The Facility may only be used by the Trustees for the purpose of achieving the objectives of the  
EBT. During the year ended 31 December 2014, the Group had made advances of $5.0 million (2013 – $10.7 million) to the EBT under 
the terms of the Facility.  

During the year ended 31 December 2014, the Group donated 2,394,377 (2013 – 1,862,138) treasury shares to the EBT at the prevailing 
market rate. The total value of the treasury share donation was $24.9 million (2013 – $25.9 million). 

LICL holds $346.1 million (2013 – $302.8 million) of cash and cash equivalents and fixed income securities in trust for the benefit of  
LUK relating to intra-group reinsurance agreements.  

In 2013, members of the Group’s senior management team contributed 12.57 per cent of the share capital in KCML. During 2014, LHL 
and the Group’s senior management team purchased shares in KCML from Richard Brindle (see other transactions below). The senior 
management team shareholding now represents a minority interest of 7.32 per cent. This investment represents the non-controlling 
interest listed in the Group’s consolidated balance sheet. 

KEY MANAGEMENT COMPENSATION 
Remuneration for key management, the Group’s Executive and Non-Executive Directors, was as follows:  

For the year ended 31 December 

Short-term compensation1 

Equity based compensation 

Directors' fees and expenses 

Total 

2014 
$m

3.3

7.5

2.2

13.0

2013 
$m

8.1

6.7

2.1

16.9

(1) Includes a credit of $2.3 million relating to the decrease in the UK National Insurance contribution provision in respect of Richard Brindle’s warrants. This is a result of the reduction in the Group’s share price 
prior to the exercise of his warrants during 2014. 

The table above includes short-term compensation of $1.8 million and an equity based compensation charge of $3.5 million relating to 
the retirement of Richard Brindle, the Group’s former CEO. His retirement package also included a cash settlement of RSS awards 
amounting to $8.2 million. Dividend equivalents that have been accrued on the RSS awards amounted to $1.6 million. The settlement of 
the RSS awards and the dividend equivalent payment are reflected in contributed surplus within shareholders’ equity.  

The Directors’ fees and expenses includes $0.4 million (2013 – $0.4 million) paid to significant founding shareholders. Non-Executive 
Directors do not receive any benefits in addition to their agreed fees and expenses and do not participate in any of the Group’s incentive, 
performance or pension plans. Neil McConachie left the Company as an employee on 30 June 2012, relinquishing his executive 
responsibilities and became a Non-Executive Director effective 1 July 2012. He subsequently relinquished his role as a Non-Executive 
Director on 30 April 2014. He is able to exercise previously granted RSS awards when they have vested, subject to the performance 
conditions being met. 

TRANSACTIONS WITH LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION  
Cash donations to the Lancashire Foundation have been approved by the Board of Directors as follows: 

Date 

23 May 2013 

5 November 2013 

156 
156 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

$m

1.4

2.0

 
 
TRANSACTIONS WITH ASSOCIATES 
In relation to transactions with ARL, the following amounts were included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income  
and the consolidated balance sheet: 

As at 31 December 

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income 

Outwards reinsurance premiums 

Insurance loss and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Consolidated balance sheet 

Reinsurance recoveries 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

2014 
$m

0.6

(6.9)

6.8

–

–

2013 
$m

47.9

9.1

7.1

26.8

(5.5)

During 2014, AHL returned $33.5 million of capital to the Group and ARL paid a final profit commission to the Group in the amount  
of $6.7 million following a commutation of the Group’s quota share agreement with ARL. 

During 2014, SHL returned $12.2 million of capital to the Group and SRL paid a final profit commission to the Group in the amount  
of $3.0 million and was placed in to run-off and subsequently liquidated. 

During 2014, the Group committed an additional $27.8 million of capital to KHL. 

In 2013, KCML entered into an underwriting services agreement with KRL and KHL to provide various services relating to underwriting, 
actuarial, premium payments and relevant deductions, acquisition expenses and receipt of claims. For the year ended 31 December 2014, 
the Group recognised $6.2 million (31 December 2013 – $nil) of service fees in other income in relation to this agreement. Contingent 
profit commission may be payable to KCML on the ultimate performance of KRL. 

Refer to note 17 for further details on the Group’s investment in associates. 

OTHER TRANSACTIONS 
On 2 June 2014, Richard Brindle sold his shares in KCML to LHL and certain of the minority shareholders of KCML (being members of 
the Group’s senior management team) for an amount of $1.2 million, of which $1.1 million was received from LHL. The sale was a direct 
result of the provisions outlined in the subscription and shareholders’ agreement of KCML and the valuation was externally determined 
by a valuation expert. 

28. BUSINESS COMBINATIONS 
On 7 November 2013, LHL acquired the entire issued share capital of Cathedral together with manager and investor loan notes and 
preference shares issued by CCIL and CCL respectively. The acquisition has enabled the Group to benefit from direct participation  
in Lloyd’s, the world’s leading specialist insurance market. 

Total consideration paid for the entire issued share capital of Cathedral 

Net assets acquired at fair value 

Excess of total consideration over net fair value of assets acquired allocated to goodwill 

Notes

19

$m

230.4

159.2

71.2

Intangible assets recognised on the acquisition of Cathedral relate to syndicate participation rights and the value of in-force business. 
These are discussed further in note 19. The goodwill recognised arose from the premium paid for strengthening the Group’s market 
position and acquiring a skilled workforce with an existing book of business and long standing business relationships. The goodwill is  
not deductible for tax purposes. 

29. NON-CASH TRANSACTIONS  
On 25 June 2014, following shareholder approval on 30 April 2014, LHL transferred $192.2 million from share premium to contributed 
surplus. During 2014, the Group issued new common shares to satisfy the cashless exercises of warrants in the amount of $3.4 million. 
Refer to note 23 for further details. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

157 
157

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

30. STATUTORY REQUIREMENTS AND DIVIDEND RESTRICTIONS 
The primary source of capital used by the Group is equity shareholders’ funds and borrowings. As a holding company, LHL relies on 
dividends from its operating entities to provide the cash flow required for debt service and dividends to shareholders. The operating 
entities’ ability to pay dividends and make capital distributions is subject to the legal and regulatory restrictions of the jurisdictions in 
which they operate.  

For LICL and LUK, these regulatory restrictions are based principally on the amount of premiums written and reserves for losses and loss 
adjustment expenses, subject to overall minimum solvency requirements. LICL and LUK’s statutory capital and surplus are different from 
shareholder’s equity due to certain items that are capitalised under IFRS but expensed or have a different valuation basis for regulatory 
reporting, or are not admitted under insurance regulations. 

Annual statutory capital and surplus reported to regulatory authorities by LICL and LUK is as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Statutory capital and surplus 

Minimum required statutory capital and surplus 

2014 

LICL 
$m

1,009.5

233.7

LUK  
£m 

117.3 

23.9 

2013 

LICL 
$m

1,210.2

235.5

LUK 
£m

118.9

23.9

LICL is required to maintain a minimum liquidity ratio, whereby relevant assets, as defined in the regulations, must exceed 75.0 per cent 
of relevant liabilities. As at 31 December 2014 and 2013 the liquidity ratio was met. LICL is also required to perform various capital 
calculations under the BMA’s regulatory framework. An assessment is made of LICL’s capital needs and a target capital amount is 
determined. The BMA may require a further capital loading on the target capital amount in certain circumstances. The BMA considers 
that a decrease in capital below the target level represents a regulatory intervention point.  

For LUK, various capital calculations are performed and an ICA is presented to the PRA. The PRA then considers the capital calculations 
and issues an ICG, reflecting the PRA’s own view as to the level of capital required. The PRA considers that a decrease in an insurance 
company’s capital below the level of its ICG represents a regulatory intervention point. As the Solvency II regime is adopted by the PRA 
the capital measures will change, but the principles and restrictions on capital release will remain. 

The Group’s underwriting capacity as a member of Lloyd’s must be supported by providing a deposit in the form of cash, securities or 
LOCs, which are referred to as FAL. The capital framework at Lloyd’s requires each managing agent to calculate the capital requirement 
for each syndicate they manage, a process known as ICA. Solvency II internal models and the uSCR have been used to determine capital 
requirements for Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010. The uSCR of each syndicate at Lloyd’s is regarded as the minimum regulatory capital 
requirement for the business. Lloyd’s has the discretion to take into account other factors at member level to uplift the calculated uSCR, 
including the need to maintain the market’s overall security rating. Any uplift by Lloyd’s is added to the uSCR to produce the ECA. 

Lloyd’s then uses each syndicate’s ECA as a basis for determining member level ECR. For the 2015 calendar year the Group’s initial  
FAL requirement was set at 53.9 per cent (2014 – 61.0 per cent) of underwriting capacity supported. Further adjustments can be made  
by Lloyd’s to allow for open year profits and losses of the syndicates on which the corporate member participates. The Group has sufficient 
capital to meet its FAL requirement of £149.3 million as at 31 December 2014 (31 December 2013 – £115.1 million).  

As at 31 December 2014 and 2013 the capital requirements of all the regulatory jurisdictions were met.  

31. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS 
DIVIDEND 
On 11 February 2015 the Board of Directors declared the payment of an ordinary dividend of $0.10 per common share and a special 
dividend of $0.50 per share to shareholders of record on 20 March 2015, with a settlement date of 15 April 2015. The ordinary dividend 
payable will be approximately $20.6 million and the special dividend payable will be approximately $102.8 million. An amount equivalent 
to the dividend accrues on all RSS options and is paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of RSS options that vest. 

158 
158 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

 
SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION 

ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 
The Company’s AGM is scheduled for 29 April 2015. Notice of this 
year’s AGM and the form of proxy accompany this Annual Report.  
If you have any queries regarding the notice or return of the proxy  
please contact Chris Head, Company Secretary, at Lancashire  
Holdings Limited, 29th Floor, 20 Fenchurch Street, London  
EC3M 3BY, United Kingdom, Tel: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000 and  
email: chris.head@lancashiregroup.com.  

FURTHER INFORMATION 
Lancashire Holdings Limited is registered in Bermuda under  
company number EC 37415 and has its registered office at Power 
House, 7 Par-la-Ville Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. 

Further information about the Group including this Annual Report, 
press releases and the Company’s share price is available on our  
website at www.lancashiregroup.com. Please address any enquiries  
to info@lancashiregroup.com. 

NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS 
Some of the statements in this document include forward-looking 
statements which reflect the Directors’ current views with respect  
to financial performance, business strategy, plans and objectives of 
management for future operations (including development plans 
relating to the Group’s products and services). These statements 
include forward-looking statements both with respect to the Group  
and the sectors and industries in which the Group operates. Statements 
containing the words “believes”, “anticipates”, “plans”, “projects”, 
“forecasts”, “guidance”, “intends”, “expects”, “estimates”, “predicts”, 
“may”, “can”, “will”, “seeks”, “should” or, in each case, their negative  
or comparable terminology and similar statements are of a future or 
forward-looking nature. All forward-looking statements address matters 
that involve risks and uncertainties. Accordingly, there are or will be 
important factors that could cause the actual results, performance  
or achievements of the Group to be materially different from future 
results, performance or achievements expressed or implied by such 
forward-looking statements.  

These factors include, but are not limited to: the Group’s ability to 
integrate its business and personnel, the successful retention and 
motivation of the Group’s key management, the increased regulatory 
burden facing the Group, the number and type of insurance and 
reinsurance contracts that the Group writes or the Group may write; 
the Group’s ability to successfully implement its business strategy 
during “soft” as well as “hard” markets; the premium rates which may 
be available at the time of such renewals within its targeted business 
lines; the possible low frequency of large events; potentially unusual  
loss frequency; the impact that the Group’s future operating results, 
capital position and rating agency and other considerations may have 
on the execution of any capital management initiatives or dividends; 
the possibility of greater frequency or severity of claims and loss activity  

than the Group’s underwriting, reserving or investment practices  
have anticipated; the reliability of, and changes in assumptions to, 
catastrophe pricing, accumulation and estimated loss models; 
increased competition from existing alternative capital providers  
and insurance linked funds and collateralised special purpose insurers 
and the related demand and supply dynamics as contracts come up  
for renewal; the effectiveness of its loss limitation methods; the 
potential loss of key personnel; a decline in the Group’s operating 
subsidiaries’ rating with A.M.Best, Standard & Poor’s, Moody’s or other 
rating agencies; increased competition on the basis of pricing, capacity, 
coverage terms or other factors; cyclical downturns of the industry;  
the impact of a deteriorating credit environment for issuers of fixed 
income investments; the impact of swings in market interest rates  
and securities prices; a rating downgrade of, or a market decline  
in, securities in its investment portfolio; changes in governmental 
regulations or tax laws in jurisdictions where the Group conducts 
business; Lancashire or its Bermudian subsidiaries becoming subject 
to income taxes in the United States or the Bermudian subsidiaries 
becoming subject to income taxes in the United Kingdom; the 
inapplicability to the Group of suitable exclusions from the UK CFC 
regime; any change in the UK government or the UK government 
policy which impacts the CFC regime or other tax changes; and the 
negative impact in any material way of the change in tax residence  
of the Company on its stakeholders. Any estimates relating to loss 
events involve the exercise of considerable judgement and reflect a 
combination of ground-up evaluations, information available to date 
from brokers and insureds, market intelligence, initial and/or tentative 
loss reports and other sources. Judgements in relation to loss arising 
from natural catastrophe and man-made events are influenced by 
complex factors. The Group cautions as to the preliminary nature  
of the information used to prepare such estimates as subsequently 
available information may contribute to an increase in these types  
of losses. 

These forward-looking statements speak only as at the date of this 
document. The Company expressly disclaims any obligation or 
undertaking (save as required to comply with any legal or regulatory 
obligations including the rules of the LSE) to disseminate any updates 
or revisions to any forward-looking statements to reflect any changes  
in the Group’s expectations or circumstances on which any such 
statement is based. All subsequent written and oral forward-looking 
statements attributable to the Group or individuals acting on behalf  
of the Group are expressly qualified in their entirety by this paragraph. 
Prospective investors should specifically consider the factors identified 
in this document which could cause actual results to differ before 
making an investment decision. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

159 
159

 
GLOSSARY 

ABS 
Asset backed securities 

CATHEDRAL; CATHEDRAL GROUP 
Refers to CCL and all direct and indirect subsidiaries of CCL 

ACTIVE UNDERWRITER 
The individual at a Lloyd’s syndicate with principal authority to 
accept insurance and reinsurance risk on behalf of the syndicate 

ADDITIONAL CASE RESERVES (ACR) 
Additional reserves deemed necessary by management 

AFS 
Available for sale 

AGGREGATE 
Accumulations of insurance loss exposures which result from 
underwriting multiple risks that are exposed to common causes  
of loss 

AGM 
Annual General Meeting 

AHL 
Accordion Holdings Limited 

AHL II 
Accordion Holdings II Limited  

AIM 
A sub-market of the LSE 

AIR 
AIR Worldwide 

A.M. BEST COMPANY (A.M. BEST)  
A.M. Best is a full-service credit rating organisation dedicated  
to serving the financial services industries, focusing on the 
insurance sector  

ARL (ACCORDION) 
Accordion Reinsurance Limited 

BAM 
Bathwater aggregate model 

BEST LANCASHIRE ASSESSMENT OF SOLVENCY OVER TIME (BLAST) 
The Group’s economic internal capital model  

BMA 
Bermuda Monetary Authority 

BOARD OF DIRECTORS 
Unless otherwise stated refers to the LHL Board of Directors 

BOOK VALUE PER SHARE (BVS) 
Calculated by dividing the value of the total shareholders’ equity  
by the sum of all common voting shares outstanding 

BSX 
Bermuda Stock Exchange 

CATASTROPHE REINSURANCE 
A form of excess of loss reinsurance which, subject to a specified 
limit, indemnifies the reinsured company for the amount of loss  
in excess of a specified retention with respect to an accumulation  
of losses resulting from a catastrophic event or series of events 

160 
160 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

CCHL 
Cathedral Capital Holdings Limited 

CCIL 
Cathedral Capital (Investments) Limited 

CCL 
Cathedral Capital Limited 

CCL 1998 
Cathedral Capital (1998) Limited 

CCL 1999 
Cathedral Capital (1999) Limited 

CCL 2000 
Cathedral Capital (2000) Limited 

CCML 
Cathedral Capital Management Limited 

CCSL 
Cathedral Capital Services Limited 

CEDED 
To transfer insurance risk from a direct insurer to a reinsurer 
and/or from a reinsurer to a retrocessionaire 

CEO 
Chief Executive Officer 

CFC 
Controlled Foreign Company 

CFO 
Chief Financial Officer 

CGU 
Cash generating unit 

CMBS 
Commercial mortgage backed securities 

THE CODE 
UK Corporate Governance Code published by the UK Financial 
Reporting Council 

COMBINED RATIO 
Ratio, in per cent, of the sum of net insurance losses, net 
acquisition expenses and other operating expenses to net 
premiums earned 

COVERHOLDER AT LLOYD’S 
A coverholder is a company or partnership authorised by a 
managing agent to enter into a contract or contracts of insurance  
to be underwritten by the members of a syndicate managed by  
it in accordance with the terms of a binding authority 

CRO 
Chief Risk Officer 

CUL 
Cathedral Underwriting Limited 

GLOSSARY 

ABS 

Asset backed securities 

ACTIVE UNDERWRITER 

AFS 

Available for sale 

AGGREGATE 

Annual General Meeting 

Accordion Holdings Limited 

Accordion Holdings II Limited  

A sub-market of the LSE 

AIR Worldwide 

insurance sector  

ARL (ACCORDION) 

Accordion Reinsurance Limited 

Bathwater aggregate model 

of loss 

AGM 

AHL 

AHL II 

AIM 

AIR 

BAM 

BMA 

Bermuda Monetary Authority 

BOARD OF DIRECTORS 

BSX 

Bermuda Stock Exchange 

CATASTROPHE REINSURANCE 

CCHL 

CCIL 

CCL 

CCL 1998 

CCL 1999 

CCL 2000 

CCML 

CCSL 

CEDED 

CEO 

CFC 

CFO 

CGU 

CMBS 

Cathedral Capital Limited 

Cathedral Capital (1998) Limited 

Cathedral Capital (1999) Limited 

Cathedral Capital (2000) Limited 

Cathedral Capital Management Limited 

Cathedral Capital Services Limited 

Chief Executive Officer 

Controlled Foreign Company 

Chief Financial Officer 

Cash generating unit 

To transfer insurance risk from a direct insurer to a reinsurer 

and/or from a reinsurer to a retrocessionaire 

A.M. BEST COMPANY (A.M. BEST)  

A.M. Best is a full-service credit rating organisation dedicated  

to serving the financial services industries, focusing on the 

BEST LANCASHIRE ASSESSMENT OF SOLVENCY OVER TIME (BLAST) 

The Group’s economic internal capital model  

THE CODE 

Commercial mortgage backed securities 

UK Corporate Governance Code published by the UK Financial 

Reporting Council 

COMBINED RATIO 

Unless otherwise stated refers to the LHL Board of Directors 

Ratio, in per cent, of the sum of net insurance losses, net 

acquisition expenses and other operating expenses to net 

BOOK VALUE PER SHARE (BVS) 

Calculated by dividing the value of the total shareholders’ equity  

by the sum of all common voting shares outstanding 

premiums earned 

COVERHOLDER AT LLOYD’S 

A coverholder is a company or partnership authorised by a 

managing agent to enter into a contract or contracts of insurance  

to be underwritten by the members of a syndicate managed by  

it in accordance with the terms of a binding authority 

A form of excess of loss reinsurance which, subject to a specified 

CRO 

limit, indemnifies the reinsured company for the amount of loss  

Chief Risk Officer 

in excess of a specified retention with respect to an accumulation  

of losses resulting from a catastrophic event or series of events 

CUL 

Cathedral Underwriting Limited 

160 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

CATHEDRAL; CATHEDRAL GROUP 

Refers to CCL and all direct and indirect subsidiaries of CCL 

CUO 
Chief Underwriting Officer 

The individual at a Lloyd’s syndicate with principal authority to 

Cathedral Capital Holdings Limited 

accept insurance and reinsurance risk on behalf of the syndicate 

ADDITIONAL CASE RESERVES (ACR) 

Cathedral Capital (Investments) Limited 

Additional reserves deemed necessary by management 

Accumulations of insurance loss exposures which result from 

underwriting multiple risks that are exposed to common causes  

DEFERRED ACQUISITION COSTS  
Costs incurred for the acquisition or the renewal of insurance 
policies (e.g. brokerage and premium taxes) which are deferred  
and amortised over the term of the insurance contracts to which 
they relate 

DILUTED EARNINGS PER SHARE 
Calculated by dividing the net profit for the year attributable to 
shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares 
outstanding during the year plus the weighted average number  
of common shares that would be issued on the conversion of  
all potentially dilutive equity based compensation awards into 
common shares under the treasury stock method 

FACULTATIVE REINSURANCE 
A reinsurance risk that is placed by means of a separately 
negotiated contract as opposed to one that is ceded under a 
reinsurance treaty 

FAL 
Funds at Lloyd’s 

FCA 
Financial Conduct Authority 

FDIC CORPORATE BONDS 
Corporate bonds protected by the Federal Deposit Insurance 
Corporation, an agency of the U.S. government 

FPSO 
Floating production storage and offloading 

DIVIDEND YIELD 
Calculated by dividing the annual dividends per share by the share 
price on the last day of the given year 

FSMA 
The Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (as amended from 
time to time) 

DURATION 
Duration is the weighted average maturity of a security’s cash flows, 
where the present values of the cash flows serve as the weights.  

The effect of the convexity, or sensitivity, of the portfolio’s response 
to changes in interest rates is also factored in to the calculation 

FULLY CONVERTED BOOK VALUE PER SHARE (FCBVS) 
Calculated by dividing the value of the total shareholders’ equity 
plus the proceeds that would be received from the exercise of all 
dilutive equity compensation awards, by the sum of all shares, 
including equity compensation awards assuming all are exercised 

EARNINGS PER SHARE (EPS)  
Calculated by dividing net profit for the year attributable to 
shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares 
outstanding during the year, excluding treasury shares and shares 
held by the EBT 

EBT 
Lancashire Holdings Employee Benefit Trust 

ECA 
Economic Capital Assessment 

ECR 
Economic Capital Requirement 

EMD 
Emerging Market Debt 

ERM 
Enterprise Risk Management 

EURIBOR 
The Euro Interbank Offered Rate 

EXCESS OF LOSS  
Reinsurance or insurance that indemnifies the reinsured  
or insured against all or a specified portion of losses on an 
underlying insurance policy in excess of a specified amount 

EXPENSE RATIO 
Ratio, in per cent, of other operating expenses to net  
premiums earned 

EY 
Ernst & Young LLP 

FVTPL 
Fair value through profit or loss 

G10 
Belgium, Canada, Germany, France, Italy, Japan, the Netherlands, 
Sweden, the United Kingdom, and the United States 

GROSS PREMIUMS WRITTEN 
Amounts payable by the insured, excluding any taxes or duties 
levied on the premium, including any brokerage and commission 
deducted by intermediaries  

THE GROUP  
LHL and its subsidiaries 

HMRC 
Her Majesty's Revenue & Customs 

ICA 
Individual capital assessment 

ICSA 
Institute of Chartered Secretaries and Administrators 

ICG 
Individual capital guidance 

IFRIC 
International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee 

IFRS 
International Financial Reporting Standard(s) 

INCURRED BUT NOT REPORTED (IBNR)  
These are anticipated or likely losses that may result from insured 
events which have taken place, but for which no losses have yet 
been reported. IBNR also includes a reserve for possible adverse 
development of previously reported losses 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

161 
161

 
GLOSSARY CONTINUED 

INDUSTRY LOSS WARRANTY (ILW) 
A type of reinsurance or derivative contract through which one 
party will purchase protection based on the total loss arising  
from an event to the entire insurance industry rather than their 
own losses. 

INTERNAL AUDIT CHARTER 
Is a formal written document that sets out the mission, scope, 
responsibilities, authority, professional standards and the 
relationship with the external auditors / regulatory bodies of  
the internal audit function (“internal audit”) with the company  
and its subsidiaries 

INTERNATIONAL ACCOUNTING STANDARD(S) (IAS) 
Standards, created by the IASB, for the preparation and 
presentation of financial statements 

INTERNATIONAL ACCOUNTING STANDARDS BOARD (IASB)  
An international panel of accounting experts responsible for 
developing IAS and IFRS 

IRR 
Internal rate of return 

IRRC 
Investment Risk and Return Committee 

ISE 
Irish Stock Exchange 

KCML 
Kinesis Capital Management Limited 

KCMMSL 
KCM Marketing Services Limited  

KHL (KINESIS HOLDINGS) 
Kinesis Holdings I Limited 

KINESIS 
The Group’s third party capital management division 
encompassing KCML, KCMMSL and the management of KHL  
and KRL 

KRL (KINESIS RE) 
Kinesis Reinsurance I Limited 

LANCASHIRE COMPANIES 
Refers to the Group excluding Cathedral and Kinesis 

LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION OR FOUNDATION 
The Lancashire Foundation is a charity registered in England  
and Wales 

LANCASHIRE UK GROUP OF COMPANIES 
Includes LHL, LUK, LIHL, LISL and LIMSL 

LHFT 
Lancashire Holdings Financing Trust I 

LHL 
Lancashire Holdings Limited 

LIBOR 
London Interbank Offered Rate 

162 
162 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

LICL 
Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 

LIHL 
Lancashire Insurance Holdings (UK) Limited 

LIMSL 
Lancashire Insurance Marketing Services Limited 

LISL 
Lancashire Insurance Services Limited 

LISTING RULES  
The listing rules made by the FCA under part VI of FSMA  
(as amended from time to time) 

LLOYD’S 
The Society of Lloyd’s 

LMSCL 
Lancashire Management Services (Canada) Limited 

LOC 
Letter of credit 

LOSSES 
Demand by an insured for indemnity under an insurance contract 

LSE 
London Stock Exchange 

LUK 
Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited 

LUTINE 
Lutine Limited 

MBRT 
Multi-beneficiary reinsurance trust 

MBS 
Mortgage backed securities 

MGA’S 
Managing general agents 

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICES (MOODY’S) 
Moody's Corporation is the parent company of Moody's Investors 
Service, which provides credit ratings and research covering debt 
instruments and securities, and Moody's Analytics, which offers 
software, advisory services and research for credit and economic 
analysis and financial risk management. 

NAV 
Net asset value 

NBS 
New Bridge Street (a trading name of Aon Hewitt Limited) 

NET ACQUISITION COST RATIO 
Ratio, in per cent, of net acquisition expenses to net  
premiums earned 

NET LOSS RATIO 
Ratio, in per cent, of net insurance losses to net premiums earned 

GLOSSARY CONTINUED 

INDUSTRY LOSS WARRANTY (ILW) 

A type of reinsurance or derivative contract through which one 

Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 

party will purchase protection based on the total loss arising  

from an event to the entire insurance industry rather than their 

own losses. 

INTERNAL AUDIT CHARTER 

Is a formal written document that sets out the mission, scope, 

responsibilities, authority, professional standards and the 

LISL 

Lancashire Insurance Holdings (UK) Limited 

Lancashire Insurance Marketing Services Limited 

LICL 

LIHL 

LIMSL 

relationship with the external auditors / regulatory bodies of  

Lancashire Insurance Services Limited 

the internal audit function (“internal audit”) with the company  

and its subsidiaries 

LISTING RULES  

The listing rules made by the FCA under part VI of FSMA  

INTERNATIONAL ACCOUNTING STANDARD(S) (IAS) 

(as amended from time to time) 

Standards, created by the IASB, for the preparation and 

presentation of financial statements 

LLOYD’S 

The Society of Lloyd’s 

INTERNATIONAL ACCOUNTING STANDARDS BOARD (IASB)  

An international panel of accounting experts responsible for 

LMSCL 

Lancashire Management Services (Canada) Limited 

Investment Risk and Return Committee 

Demand by an insured for indemnity under an insurance contract 

developing IAS and IFRS 

Internal rate of return 

Irish Stock Exchange 

Kinesis Capital Management Limited 

KCMMSL 

KCM Marketing Services Limited  

KHL (KINESIS HOLDINGS) 

Kinesis Holdings I Limited 

IRR 

IRRC 

ISE 

KCML 

KINESIS 

and KRL 

London Stock Exchange 

Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited 

LOC 

Letter of credit 

LOSSES 

LSE 

LUK 

MBRT 

MBS 

LUTINE 

Lutine Limited 

Multi-beneficiary reinsurance trust 

Mortgage backed securities 

Managing general agents 

The Group’s third party capital management division 

encompassing KCML, KCMMSL and the management of KHL  

MGA’S 

KRL (KINESIS RE) 

Kinesis Reinsurance I Limited 

LANCASHIRE COMPANIES 

Refers to the Group excluding Cathedral and Kinesis 

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICES (MOODY’S) 

Moody's Corporation is the parent company of Moody's Investors 

Service, which provides credit ratings and research covering debt 

instruments and securities, and Moody's Analytics, which offers 

software, advisory services and research for credit and economic 

LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION OR FOUNDATION 

analysis and financial risk management. 

The Lancashire Foundation is a charity registered in England  

and Wales 

LANCASHIRE UK GROUP OF COMPANIES 

Includes LHL, LUK, LIHL, LISL and LIMSL 

Lancashire Holdings Financing Trust I 

LHFT 

LHL 

LIBOR 

Lancashire Holdings Limited 

London Interbank Offered Rate 

162 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

Net asset value 

NAV 

NBS 

premiums earned 

NET LOSS RATIO 

New Bridge Street (a trading name of Aon Hewitt Limited) 

NET ACQUISITION COST RATIO 

Ratio, in per cent, of net acquisition expenses to net  

Ratio, in per cent, of net insurance losses to net premiums earned 

NET OPERATING PROFIT 
Profit before tax excluding realised gains and losses and foreign 
exchange gains and losses  

NET PREMIUMS WRITTEN 
Net premiums written is equal to gross premiums written less 
outwards reinsurance premiums written  

ORSA 
Own Risk and Solvency Assessment 

OTC 
Over the counter 

PML 
Probable maximum loss 

PRA 
Prudential Regulation Authority 

SML 
Saltire Management Limited 

SRL 
Saltire Re I Limited 

STANDARD & POOR’S (S&P) 
Standard & Poor’s is a worldwide insurance rating and information 
agency whose ratings are recognised as an ideal benchmark for 
assessing the financial strength of insurance related organisations 

SYNDICATE 2010 
Lloyd’s Syndicate 2010, managed by CUL. The group provides 
capital to support 57.8 per cent of the stamp 

SYNDICATE 3010 
Lloyd’s Syndicate 3010, managed by CUL. The group provides 
capital to support 100.0 per cent of the stamp 

PRO-RATA/PROPORTIONAL  
Reinsurance or insurance where the reinsured or insured shares a 
proportional part of the original premiums and losses of the 
reinsured or insured 

THE SYNDICATES 
Syndicate 2010 and 3010 

TBAS 
Mortgage backed “to be announced” securities 

RDS 
Realistic Disaster Scenarios 

RETROCESSION 
The reinsurance of a reinsurance account  

RETURN ON EQUITY (RoE) 
The IRR of the change in FCBVS in the period plus accrued 
dividends 

RMBS 
Residential mortgage backed securities 

RMS 
Risk Management Solutions 

RPI 
Renewal Price Index 

RRC 
Risk and Return Committee 

RSS 
Restricted share scheme 

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN (TSR) 
The IRR of the increase in share price in the period, measured in 
U.S. dollars, adjusted for dividends 

TREATY REINSURANCE 
A reinsurance contract under which the reinsurer agrees to offer  
and to accept all risks of a certain size within a defined class 

UMCC 
Underwriting and Marketing Conference Call 

UNEARNED PREMIUMS  
The portion of premium income that is attributable to periods  
after the balance sheet date that is deferred and amortised to 
future accounting periods 

UNL 
Ultimate net loss 

USCR 
Ultimate solvency capital requirement 

U.S. GAAP 
Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States 

SATEC 
SATEC Underwriting, a privately owned insurance underwriting 
agency operating at national and international level in specialty 
classes of business. SATEC Underwriting is a coverholder at Lloyd’s 

VALUE AT RISK (VAR) 
A measure of the risk of loss of a specific portfolio of  
financial assets 

SHARP 
Lancashire’s in house aggregation system 

SHL 
Saltire Holdings I Limited 

SIDECAR 
A specialty reinsurance company designed to provide additional 
capital to another (re)insurance company. Investors invest  
in a sidecar to reinsure specific risks for a specific  
(re)insurance company 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

163 
163

 
 
KINESIS 
Kinesis Capital Management Limited  
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

LEGAL COUNSEL TO THE COMPANY 
AS TO ENGLISH AND U.S. LAW: 
Willkie Farr & Gallagher (UK) LLP 
CityPoint 
1 Ropemaker Street 
London EC2Y 9AW 
United Kingdom 

AS TO BERMUDA LAW: 
Conyers Dill & Pearman Limited 
Clarendon House 
2 Church Street 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

AUDITORS 
Ernst & Young LLP 
1 More London Place 
London SE1 2AF 
United Kingdom 

REGISTRAR 
Capita Registrars (Jersey) Limited 
PO Box 532 
St Helier  
Jersey JE4 5UW 
Channel Islands 

DEPOSITARY 
Capita IRG Trustees Limited 
The Registry 
34 Beckenham Road 
Beckenham 
Kent BR3 4TU 
United Kingdom 

CONTACT INFORMATION 

HEAD OFFICE 
Lancashire Holdings Limited 
29th Floor  
20 Fenchurch Street  
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4077 

REGISTERED OFFICE  
Lancashire Holdings Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

BERMUDA OFFICE 
Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

UK OFFICE 
Lancashire Insurance Company  
(UK) Limited 
29th Floor 
20 Fenchurch Street  
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4077 

CATHEDRAL 
Cathedral Capital Limited  
29th Floor 
20 Fenchurch Street 
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7170 9000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7170 9001 

164 
164 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014

Visit our corporate website for more information: 
http://www.lancashiregroup.com

This report is printed on Heaven 42 and Essential 
Offset which have been independently certified by 
the Forest Stewardship Council® and manufactured 
using materials from sustainable sources.

The inks used are all vegetable oil based.

Designed and produced by Black Sun Plc.

Printed at Principal Colour Ltd. ISO 14001 certified, 
Alcohol Free and FSC® Chain of Custody certified.

www.lancashiregroup.com